1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.98"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
79 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
80 . --- table (but without the split capability).
83 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
87 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
98 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
113 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
114 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
115 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
117 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
118 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
122 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
128 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
130 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
135 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
141 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
142 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
143 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
145 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
149 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
150 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
151 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
155 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
159 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
167 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
168 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
169 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
170 . --- ID that ties them together.
171 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
172 . --- head, or list-item.
175 &<indexterm role="concept">&
176 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
178 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
184 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
185 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
187 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
193 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
197 &<indexterm role="option">&
198 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
200 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
205 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
206 . --- head, or varlist item.
209 &<indexterm role="variable">&
210 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
212 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
218 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
222 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
224 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
225 .cindex "header lines" $1
227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
231 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
237 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
238 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
242 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
243 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
244 <revhistory><revision>
246 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
247 </revision></revhistory>
250 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
255 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
256 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
257 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
258 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
259 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
261 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
265 <indexterm role="$2">
266 <primary>$3</primary>
268 <secondary>$5</secondary>
270 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
275 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
277 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
280 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
283 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
284 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
285 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
286 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
287 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
288 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
289 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
290 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
291 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
292 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
293 .see concept fallover fallback
294 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
295 .see concept headers "header lines"
296 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
297 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
298 .seealso concept maximum limit
299 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
300 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
301 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
302 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
303 .see concept "process id" pid
304 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
305 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
306 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
307 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
309 .see concept string expansion expansion
310 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
311 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
312 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
315 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
316 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
317 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
318 . chapter "Introduction"
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
321 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
322 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
323 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
324 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
326 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
327 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
328 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
329 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
330 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
331 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
332 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
334 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
335 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
336 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
338 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
339 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
340 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
342 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
343 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
344 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
345 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
346 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
348 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
349 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
350 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
351 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
352 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
354 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
355 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
356 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
357 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
361 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
362 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
365 .cindex "documentation"
366 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
367 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
368 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
369 capable of showing a change indicator.
372 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
373 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
374 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
375 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
376 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
377 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
378 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
381 .cindex "books about Exim"
382 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
383 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
384 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
385 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
387 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
388 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
389 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
390 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
392 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
393 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
394 Debian-specific features in the file
395 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
396 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
399 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
400 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
402 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
403 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
404 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
405 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
406 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
408 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
409 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
410 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
411 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
413 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
414 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
416 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
417 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
418 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
422 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
423 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
424 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
425 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
426 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
427 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
428 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
429 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
432 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
433 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
434 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
441 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
442 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
443 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
447 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
448 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
449 online information is &url(https://wiki.exim.org,the Exim wiki),
450 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
451 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
452 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
453 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
456 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
457 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
458 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
459 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
462 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
463 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
464 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
467 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
468 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
469 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
470 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
471 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
474 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
475 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
476 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
477 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
478 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
481 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
483 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
486 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
487 .cindex "bug reports"
488 .cindex "reporting bugs"
489 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
490 via &url(https://bugs.exim.org,the Bugzilla). However, if you are unsure
491 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
492 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
496 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
498 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
499 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
500 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
501 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
503 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
505 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
506 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
508 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
509 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
510 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
512 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
513 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
514 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
515 here are top-level directories.
517 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
518 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
521 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
522 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
523 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
532 most portable to old systems.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
538 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
539 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
540 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
541 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
542 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
543 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
544 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
546 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
547 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
548 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
549 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
551 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
554 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
557 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
558 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
559 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
561 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
562 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
563 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
564 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
566 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
571 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
572 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
575 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
577 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
578 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
579 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
580 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
581 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
582 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
583 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
584 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
586 .cindex "domainless addresses"
587 .cindex "address" "without domain"
588 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
589 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
590 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
591 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
594 .cindex "transport" "external"
595 .cindex "external transports"
596 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
597 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
598 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
599 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
600 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
601 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
603 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
604 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
605 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
608 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
609 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
610 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
611 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
612 a number of common scanners are provided.
616 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
617 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
618 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
619 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
620 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
621 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
624 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
625 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
626 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
627 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
628 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
629 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
630 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
631 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
632 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
633 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
634 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
635 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
637 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
638 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
639 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
640 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
644 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
645 .cindex "terminology definitions"
646 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
647 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
648 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
649 below) by a blank line.
651 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
652 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
653 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
654 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
655 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
656 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
657 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
658 rise to further bounce messages.
660 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
661 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
662 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
665 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
666 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
667 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
670 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
671 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
672 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
674 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
675 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
676 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
677 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
678 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
679 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
680 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
681 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
683 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
684 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
685 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
686 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
687 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
688 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
691 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
692 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
693 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from
694 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822), is used to refer to the
695 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
696 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
698 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
699 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
700 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
701 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
702 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
703 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
705 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
706 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
709 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
710 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
711 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
712 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
713 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
715 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
717 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
718 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
719 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
721 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
722 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
723 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
724 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
725 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
726 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
736 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
737 .cindex "incorporated code"
738 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
741 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
744 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
745 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
746 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
747 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
748 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
749 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
751 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
752 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
753 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
754 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
755 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
756 following statements:
759 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
761 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
762 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
763 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
765 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
766 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
767 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
768 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
769 restrictions applied to it).
772 .cindex "SPA authentication"
773 .cindex "Samba project"
774 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
775 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
776 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
777 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
781 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
782 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
783 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
784 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
785 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
786 conditions expressed therein.
789 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
791 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
792 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
796 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
797 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
799 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
800 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
801 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
804 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
805 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
806 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
807 details, please contact
809 Office of Technology Transfer
810 Carnegie Mellon University
812 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
813 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
814 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
817 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
820 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
821 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
823 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
824 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
825 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
826 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
827 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
828 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
829 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
834 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
837 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
838 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
839 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
840 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
843 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
844 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
848 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
849 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
850 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
851 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
852 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
853 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
854 software without specific, written prior permission.
856 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
857 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
858 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
859 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
860 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
861 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
866 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
867 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
868 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
869 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
870 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
874 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
875 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
876 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
886 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
887 "Receiving and delivering mail"
890 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
891 .cindex "design philosophy"
892 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
893 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
894 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
895 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
896 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
897 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
900 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
901 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
902 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
903 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
904 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
905 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
906 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
909 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
910 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
911 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
912 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
913 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
914 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
915 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
916 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
917 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
920 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
921 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
923 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
924 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
925 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
926 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
928 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
929 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
930 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
931 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
932 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
934 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
935 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
936 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
938 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
939 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
940 runs at the start of every delivery process.
945 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
946 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
947 .cindex "Sieve filter"
948 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
949 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
950 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
951 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
952 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
953 of filtering are available:
956 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
957 by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
959 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
960 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
963 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
967 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
968 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
969 .cindex "format" "of message id"
970 .cindex "id of message"
975 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
976 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
977 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
978 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
979 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
980 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
981 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
982 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
983 not always case-sensitive.
985 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
986 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
987 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
988 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
989 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
990 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
994 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
995 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
996 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
997 way of representing the date and time of day).
999 After the first hyphen, the next
1001 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1003 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1005 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1006 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1007 time of reception, normally in units of
1010 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1011 systems), the units are
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1015 500000 (250000) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1027 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1031 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1032 .cindex "receiving mail"
1033 .cindex "message" "reception"
1034 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1035 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1036 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1037 there are several possibilities:
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1041 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1042 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1044 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1045 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1046 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1047 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1048 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1049 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1051 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1052 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1053 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1054 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1055 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1057 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1058 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1059 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1060 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1064 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1065 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1066 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1067 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1068 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1069 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1070 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1071 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1072 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1073 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1074 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1075 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1076 users to change sender addresses.
1078 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1079 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1080 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1081 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1082 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1083 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1084 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1086 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1087 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1088 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1089 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1090 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1091 message is received.
1097 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1098 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1099 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1100 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1101 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1102 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1103 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1104 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1106 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1107 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1108 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1109 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1110 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1111 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1112 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1113 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1114 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1115 affect file system performance.
1117 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1118 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1119 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1120 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1121 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1123 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1124 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1125 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1126 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1127 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1128 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1129 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1130 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1131 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1132 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1133 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1134 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1138 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1139 .cindex "message" "life of"
1140 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1141 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1142 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1143 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1144 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1145 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1146 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1148 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1149 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1150 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1151 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1152 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1155 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1156 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1157 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1158 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1159 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1161 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1162 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1163 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1164 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1165 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1166 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1167 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1168 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1169 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1170 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1173 .cindex "journal file"
1174 .cindex "file" "journal"
1175 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1176 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1177 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1178 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1179 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1180 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1181 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1182 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1184 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1185 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1186 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1187 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1188 deliveries caused by crashes.
1192 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1193 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1194 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1195 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1196 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1197 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1198 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1199 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1200 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1202 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1203 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1204 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1205 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1206 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1207 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1208 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1209 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1210 the driver's features in general.
1212 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1213 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1214 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1215 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1218 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1219 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1220 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1221 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1222 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1223 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1225 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1226 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1227 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1228 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1229 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1230 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1232 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1233 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1234 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1237 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1238 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1239 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1240 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1241 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1242 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1243 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1244 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1245 configured to fail the address.
1247 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1248 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1249 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1250 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1251 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1252 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1254 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1255 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1256 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1257 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1258 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1259 the address is bounced.
1263 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1264 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1265 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1266 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1267 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1268 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1269 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1270 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1272 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1273 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1274 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1275 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1276 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1277 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1278 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1279 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1284 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1285 .cindex "router" "running details"
1286 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1287 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1288 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1289 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1290 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1291 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1295 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1296 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1297 original address ceases
1298 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1299 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1300 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1301 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1302 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1305 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1306 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1307 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1308 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1309 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1311 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1312 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1313 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1314 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1315 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1317 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1318 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1319 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1320 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1321 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1323 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1324 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1325 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1327 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1328 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1329 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1330 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1332 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1333 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1336 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1337 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1338 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1339 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1340 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1342 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1343 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1344 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1345 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1346 facility for this purpose.
1349 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1350 .cindex "case of local parts"
1351 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1352 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1353 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1354 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1355 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1356 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1357 routed addresses are shown.
1361 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1362 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1363 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1364 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1365 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1366 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1369 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1370 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1371 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1372 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1373 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1374 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1375 of any other conditions.
1377 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1378 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1379 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1381 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1382 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1383 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1384 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1385 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1387 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1388 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1389 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1390 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1391 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1393 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1394 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1395 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1397 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1398 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1401 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1402 of domains that it defines.
1403 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1404 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
1405 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1406 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1407 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1408 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1409 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1411 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1412 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1415 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1416 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1417 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1418 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1419 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1420 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1421 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1422 the set of local parts that it defines.
1423 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1424 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1425 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1426 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1427 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1429 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1430 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1432 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1433 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1434 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1435 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1436 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1437 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1438 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1441 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1442 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1444 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1445 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1446 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1447 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1448 remaining preconditions.
1451 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1452 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1453 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1454 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1455 could lead to confusion.
1458 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1459 set of addresses that it defines.
1462 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1463 specified files is tested.
1466 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1467 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1468 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1469 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1471 Note that while using
1472 this option for address matching technically works,
1473 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1474 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1475 for transport options.
1476 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1477 convenient way to obtain them.
1481 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1482 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1483 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1484 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1485 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1486 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1487 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1491 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1492 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1493 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1496 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1497 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1498 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1499 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1500 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1502 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1503 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1505 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1506 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1507 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1508 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1509 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1510 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1513 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1514 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1515 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1516 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1517 processed entirely independently of each other.
1519 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1520 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1521 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1522 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1523 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1524 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1525 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1526 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1527 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1529 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1530 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1531 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1532 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1533 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1534 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1535 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1536 addresses to the same domain.
1538 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1539 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1540 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1541 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1542 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1543 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1544 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1545 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1547 .cindex "queue runner"
1548 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1549 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1550 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1551 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1552 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1553 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1554 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1555 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1556 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1558 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1559 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1560 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1561 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1562 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1563 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1565 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1566 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1567 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1568 messages to other addresses.
1570 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1571 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1572 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1575 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1576 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1577 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1583 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1584 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1585 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1586 .cindex "queue runner"
1587 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1588 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1589 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1590 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1591 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1592 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1593 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1594 passed its retry time.
1595 You can run several queue runners at once.
1597 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1598 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1599 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1600 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1601 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1606 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1607 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1608 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1609 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1610 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1611 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1612 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1613 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1614 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1617 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1618 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1619 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1621 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1622 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1623 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1624 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1625 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1630 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1631 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1632 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1633 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1634 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1635 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1636 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1637 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1638 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1639 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1640 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1642 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1643 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1644 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1647 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1648 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1649 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1650 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1651 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1652 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1653 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1658 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1659 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1660 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1661 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1662 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1663 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1664 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1665 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1674 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1675 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1677 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1678 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1679 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1680 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1683 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1684 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1686 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1687 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1688 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1689 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1693 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1694 following subdirectories are created:
1697 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1698 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1699 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1700 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1701 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1702 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1703 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1706 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1707 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1708 that may be useful to some sites.
1711 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1712 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1713 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1714 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1715 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1716 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1718 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1719 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1720 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1721 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1722 overridden if necessary.
1723 .cindex compiler requirements
1724 .cindex compiler version
1725 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1728 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1729 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1730 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1731 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1732 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1733 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1734 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1735 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1736 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1737 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1738 If your operating system has no
1739 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1740 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1741 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1743 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1744 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1745 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1746 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1747 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1748 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1749 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1751 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1752 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1753 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1754 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1755 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1756 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1757 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1758 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1760 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1761 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1762 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1763 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1764 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1765 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1766 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1767 Berkeley DB library.
1770 Ownership of the Berkeley DB library has moved to a major corporation;
1771 development seems to have stalled and documentation is not freely available.
1772 This is probably not tenable for the long term use by Exim.
1775 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1776 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1780 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1781 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1783 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1784 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1785 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1786 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1787 filename is used unmodified.
1789 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1790 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1791 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1792 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1794 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1795 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1796 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1798 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1799 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1800 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1801 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1802 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1803 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1804 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1805 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1806 page with far newer versions listed.
1807 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1808 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1809 suited to Exim's usage model.
1811 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1812 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1813 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1814 operates on a single file.
1816 It is possible to use &url(https://www.sqlite.org/index.html,sqlite3)
1817 for the DBM library.
1821 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1822 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1823 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1824 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1825 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1829 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, for tdb you set USE_TDB,
1830 and for sqlite3 you set USE_SQLITE.
1831 An error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1832 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1834 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1835 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1836 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1837 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1838 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1839 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1841 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1842 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1843 in one of these lines:
1848 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1850 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1851 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1852 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1853 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1854 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1857 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1858 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1860 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1861 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1864 When moving from one DBM library to another,
1865 for the hints databases it suffices to just remove all the files in the
1866 directory named &"db/"& under the spool directory.
1867 This is because hints are only for optimisation and will be rebuilt
1868 during normal operations.
1869 Non-hints DBM databases (used by &"dbm"& lookups in the configuration)
1870 will need individual rebuilds for the new DBM library.
1871 This is not done automatically
1876 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1877 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1878 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1879 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1880 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1881 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1882 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1883 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1884 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1885 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1886 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1887 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1889 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1890 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1891 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1892 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1893 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1894 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1896 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1897 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1898 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1899 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1900 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1901 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1904 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1905 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1906 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1907 facilities, you need to set
1909 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1911 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1912 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1915 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1916 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1917 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1918 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1919 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1920 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1921 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1923 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1924 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1925 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1926 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1927 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1932 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1933 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1935 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1936 described in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
1937 This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1938 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1939 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1940 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1941 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1942 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1944 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1945 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1946 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1947 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1948 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1952 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1956 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1957 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1958 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1959 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1960 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1961 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1962 command as per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 2487).
1963 It can also support clients that expect to
1964 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1965 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1968 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1969 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1972 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1976 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1978 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1981 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1983 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1984 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1987 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1988 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1990 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1991 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1994 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1996 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1997 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
2000 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2002 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
2003 library and include files. For example:
2006 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2007 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2009 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
2010 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2013 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
2016 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
2017 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
2018 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2023 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2025 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2026 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2027 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2028 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2029 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2030 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2031 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2032 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2033 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2034 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2035 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2036 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2039 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2040 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2041 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2043 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2044 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2046 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2048 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2049 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2050 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2051 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2052 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2053 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2057 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2058 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2059 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2060 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2061 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2062 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2065 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2066 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2067 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2068 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2069 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2071 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2076 .section "Dynamically loaded module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2077 .cindex "lookup modules"
2078 .cindex "router modules"
2079 .cindex "transport modules"
2080 .cindex "authenticator modules"
2081 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2082 .cindex ".so building"
2083 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2084 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2086 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2087 library dependencies without requiring all systems to install all of those
2090 Any combination of lookup types can be built this way.
2091 Lookup types that provide several variants will be loaded as
2093 Types that provide only one method are not loaded until used by
2094 the runtime configuration.
2098 set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2099 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2100 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2101 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2102 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2103 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2105 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2106 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2107 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2108 only if each is installed:
2114 Set also &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>&` INCLUDE`& and
2115 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>`_LIBS if needed for each lookup type,
2116 ensuring that duplicates are not present in more global values.
2119 Similarly, authenticator, router and transport drivers can be built
2120 as external modules.
2121 Modules will be searched for as demanded by the runtime configuration,
2122 permitting a smaller Exim binary.
2124 For building, as above but using
2125 &`AUTH_*`&, &`ROUTER_*`& and &`TRANSPORT_*`& instead of &`LOOKUP_*`&,
2129 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2130 .cindex "build directory"
2131 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2132 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2133 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2134 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2135 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2136 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2137 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2139 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2140 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2141 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2142 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2143 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2144 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2145 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2146 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2148 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2149 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2150 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2154 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2155 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2156 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2157 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2158 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2159 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2160 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2164 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2165 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2166 given in addition to the short output.
2170 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2171 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2172 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2173 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2174 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2175 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2176 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2179 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2180 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2182 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2183 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2184 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2185 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2187 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2188 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2189 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2190 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2191 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2192 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2193 and are often not needed.
2195 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2196 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2197 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2198 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2199 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2200 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2201 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2202 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2203 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2206 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2207 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2208 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2209 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2213 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2214 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2215 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2216 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2217 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2218 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2219 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2220 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2221 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2222 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2223 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2224 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2225 containing the lines
2230 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2231 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2233 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2234 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2235 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2238 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2239 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2240 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2241 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2242 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2243 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2244 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2245 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2246 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2247 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2253 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2254 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2255 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2256 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2257 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2258 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2259 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2260 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2263 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2264 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2265 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2266 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2267 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2268 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2269 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2270 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2271 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2272 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2273 syntax. For instance:
2276 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2278 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2279 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2280 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2283 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2284 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2285 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2289 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2290 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2292 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2293 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2294 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2295 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2296 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2297 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2300 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2301 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2303 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2304 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2307 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2308 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2310 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2311 definition of all three of these variables into your
2312 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2315 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2316 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2317 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2318 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2320 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2321 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2322 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2323 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2324 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2327 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2328 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2329 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2330 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2331 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2334 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2336 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2337 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2338 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2339 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2340 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2341 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2345 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2346 .cindex "building Eximon"
2347 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2348 where the files that are involved are
2350 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2351 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2352 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2353 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2354 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2355 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2357 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2358 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2359 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2360 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2361 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2362 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2363 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2367 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2368 .cindex "installing Exim"
2369 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2370 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2371 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2372 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2373 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2374 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2375 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2376 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2377 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2378 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2379 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2380 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2382 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2383 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2384 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2385 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2386 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2387 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2388 alternative files, no default is installed.
2390 .cindex "system aliases file"
2391 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2392 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2393 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2394 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2395 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2396 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2397 and outputs a comment to the user.
2399 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2400 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2401 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2402 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2403 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2405 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2406 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2407 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2408 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2409 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2412 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2413 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2416 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2418 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2419 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2420 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2421 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2422 but this usage is deprecated.
2424 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2425 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2426 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2427 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2428 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2429 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2431 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2432 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2433 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2434 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2435 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2436 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2437 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2439 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2440 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2441 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2444 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2446 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2447 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2448 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2449 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2452 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2454 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2455 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2458 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2459 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2461 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2465 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2467 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2469 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2470 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2471 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2473 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2478 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2479 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2480 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2481 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2482 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2485 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2486 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2487 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2491 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2492 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2493 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2494 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2495 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2501 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2502 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2503 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2504 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2505 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2509 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2510 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2511 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2512 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2513 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2516 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2518 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2520 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2522 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2523 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2524 user agent. For example:
2526 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2527 From: user@your.domain.example
2528 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2529 Subject: Testing Exim
2531 This is a test message.
2534 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2535 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2536 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2538 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2539 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2540 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2541 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2542 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2543 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2545 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2547 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2548 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2549 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2550 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2551 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2553 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2554 .cindex "lock files"
2555 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2556 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2557 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2558 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2559 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2560 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2561 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2562 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2563 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2564 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2565 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2566 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2568 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2569 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2570 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2571 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2572 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2575 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2576 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2577 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2578 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2582 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2583 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2584 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2585 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2586 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2587 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2588 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2589 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2590 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2591 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2592 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2593 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2594 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2596 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2597 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2598 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2599 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2600 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2601 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2604 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2605 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2606 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2607 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2609 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2610 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2611 favourite user agent.
2613 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2614 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2615 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2616 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2617 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2618 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2622 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2623 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2627 This starts a daemon which
2629 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2632 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2633 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2635 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2636 they will run in parallel.
2637 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2638 defined in the configuration.
2641 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2642 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2643 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2644 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2645 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2646 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2647 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2648 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2649 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2650 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2656 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2657 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2658 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2660 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2662 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2663 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2664 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2665 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2666 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2668 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2670 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2672 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2673 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2674 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2679 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2680 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2682 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2683 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2684 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2685 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2686 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2687 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2688 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2689 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2690 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2693 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2695 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2696 were present before any other options.
2697 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2699 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2700 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2701 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2704 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2705 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2706 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2710 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2711 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2712 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2715 .cindex "queue runner"
2716 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2717 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2718 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2720 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2721 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2722 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2723 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2724 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2725 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2726 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2727 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2730 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2731 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2732 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2733 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2734 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2735 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2738 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2739 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2740 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2741 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2742 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2743 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2745 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2746 .cindex "envelope from"
2747 .cindex "envelope sender"
2748 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2749 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2750 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2751 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2752 users to set envelope senders.
2756 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2757 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2758 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2760 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2761 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2762 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2763 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2764 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2765 that are available to trusted users.
2767 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2768 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2769 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2770 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2771 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2773 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2774 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2775 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2776 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2778 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2779 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2780 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2781 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2783 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2784 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2789 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2790 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2791 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2797 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2798 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2799 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2800 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2801 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2802 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2803 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2804 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2807 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2808 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2809 . creates a man page for the options.
2810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2813 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2819 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2820 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2821 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2822 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2825 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2826 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2830 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2837 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2841 .cmdopt -atrn <&'host'&> <&'domainlist'&>
2842 This option requests an ODMR customer connection.
2843 See &<<SECTODMRCUST>>& for details.
2846 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2848 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2849 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2850 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2851 clean; it ignores this option.
2855 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2856 .cindex "queue runner"
2857 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2858 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2859 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2861 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2862 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2863 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2864 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2866 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2867 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2868 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2869 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2871 When a listening daemon
2872 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2873 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2874 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2875 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2876 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2877 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2880 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2881 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2882 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2886 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2887 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2888 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2889 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2890 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2891 .cindex reload configuration
2892 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2893 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2894 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2895 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2896 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2897 because these are reread each time they are used.
2899 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2900 to cleanly shut down.
2901 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2902 or for scanning the queue,
2903 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2906 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2907 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2910 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2911 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2912 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2913 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2914 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2915 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2917 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2918 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2919 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2920 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2921 test data. A line history is supported.
2923 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2924 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2925 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2926 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2927 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2928 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2929 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2931 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2932 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2933 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2934 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2936 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2937 defined and macros will be expanded.
2938 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2939 available to admin users.
2941 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2942 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2943 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2944 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2945 the value is marked as tainted.
2946 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2948 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2949 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2950 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2951 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2952 of a file. For example:
2954 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2956 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2957 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2958 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2959 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2960 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2961 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2962 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2965 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2966 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2967 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2968 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2969 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2970 system filters are recognized.
2972 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2973 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2974 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2975 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2976 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2977 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2978 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2979 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2980 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2983 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2984 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2985 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2987 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2989 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2990 variables that are used by the user filter.
2992 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2997 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2998 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2999 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
3002 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
3003 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
3004 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
3005 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
3007 When testing a filter file,
3008 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3009 .cindex "envelope from"
3010 .cindex "envelope sender"
3011 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
3012 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
3013 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
3014 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
3015 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
3018 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
3019 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
3020 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3021 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
3024 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
3025 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3026 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
3027 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
3028 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
3029 actually being delivered.
3031 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
3032 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3033 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3034 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3037 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
3038 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3039 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3040 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3043 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
3044 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
3045 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
3046 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
3047 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
3048 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
3049 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
3050 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
3051 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3052 after a full stop. For example:
3054 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3055 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3057 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3058 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3059 conversion to the canonical form is
3060 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3062 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3063 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3064 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3065 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3066 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3070 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident
3071 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 1413))
3072 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3073 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3076 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3077 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3078 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3080 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3081 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3082 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3083 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3084 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3085 session were authenticated.
3087 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3088 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3089 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3091 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3092 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3093 specialized SMTP test program such as
3094 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks,swaks).
3096 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3097 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3098 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3099 updating the callout cache database.
3102 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3103 .cindex "building alias file"
3104 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3105 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3106 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3107 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3108 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3111 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3112 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3113 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3114 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3115 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3116 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3119 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3121 .cindex "querying exim information"
3122 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3123 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3124 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3125 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3126 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3129 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3130 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3131 recognised DSCP names.
3134 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3135 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3136 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3137 useful for ManageSieve
3138 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc5804.html,RFC 5804))
3139 implementations, in providing that protocol's
3140 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3141 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3142 way to guarantee a correct response.
3145 .cindex "local message reception"
3146 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3147 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3148 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3149 argument can be a comma-separated list of
3150 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) addresses.
3152 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3153 if no other conflicting option is present.
3155 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3156 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3157 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3158 suppressing this for special cases.
3160 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3161 the non-SMTP ACL. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for details.
3163 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3164 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3165 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3168 .cindex "message" "format"
3169 .cindex "format" "message"
3170 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3171 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3172 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3173 of the message must be as defined in
3174 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
3176 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3178 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3179 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3181 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3182 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3183 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3184 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3185 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3187 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3188 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3189 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3190 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3191 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3193 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3194 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3195 .cindex "malware scan test"
3196 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3197 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3198 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3199 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3200 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3201 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3202 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3204 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3205 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3206 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3207 This option requires admin privileges.
3209 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3210 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3211 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3214 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3215 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3216 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3217 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3218 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3219 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3220 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3222 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3223 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3224 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3225 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3226 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3228 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3229 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3230 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3231 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3235 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3236 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3237 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3238 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3239 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3240 arguments, for example:
3242 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3244 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3245 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3246 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3247 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3248 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3249 users, the output is as in this example:
3251 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3253 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3254 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3256 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3257 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3258 backward compatibility.)
3259 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3260 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3262 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3263 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3264 name will not be output.
3266 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3267 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3268 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3269 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3270 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3271 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3272 written directly into the spool directory.
3274 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3276 exim -bP +local_domains
3278 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3279 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3281 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3282 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3283 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3284 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3285 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3286 that driver are output. For example:
3288 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3290 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3291 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3292 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3293 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3294 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3297 .cindex "environment"
3298 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3299 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3302 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3303 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3304 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3305 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3306 The output format is one item per line.
3307 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3308 the exit status will be nonzero.
3311 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3312 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3313 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3314 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3315 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3316 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3317 to allow any user to see the queue.
3319 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3321 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3322 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3325 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3326 .cindex "size" "of message"
3327 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3328 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3329 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3330 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3331 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3332 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3333 before the sender address.
3335 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3336 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3337 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3339 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3340 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3341 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3342 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3343 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3348 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3349 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3350 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3355 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3356 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3357 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3358 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3362 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3363 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3368 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3369 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3370 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3371 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3374 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3377 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3380 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3384 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3385 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3386 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3387 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3391 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3392 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3393 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3394 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3395 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3397 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3398 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3400 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3401 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3402 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3403 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3404 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3405 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3406 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3407 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3408 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3410 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3411 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3415 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3416 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3417 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3418 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3419 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3420 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3421 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3424 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3425 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3426 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3427 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3428 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3429 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3430 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3431 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3432 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3434 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3435 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3436 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3438 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3439 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see section &<<SECnonSMTP>>&).
3440 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3441 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3443 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3444 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, ATRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3445 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3447 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3448 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3449 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3450 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3451 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3453 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3454 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3457 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3458 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3459 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3460 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3461 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3462 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3463 messages to the MTA.
3466 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3467 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3468 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3469 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3470 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3471 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3472 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3476 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3477 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3478 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3479 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3480 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3481 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3482 the listening daemon.
3485 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3486 .cindex "address" "testing"
3487 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3488 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3489 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3490 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3491 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3493 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3494 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3496 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3497 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3500 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3501 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3502 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3503 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3504 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3507 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3508 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3509 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3510 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3512 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3513 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3514 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3515 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3518 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3519 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3521 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3522 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3523 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3524 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3525 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3526 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3530 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3531 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3532 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3533 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3534 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3535 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3537 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3538 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3539 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3540 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3541 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3542 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3543 dynamic testing facilities.
3546 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3547 .cindex "address" "verification"
3548 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3549 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3550 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3551 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3552 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3553 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3555 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3556 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3557 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3559 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3560 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3562 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3563 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3566 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3567 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3568 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3569 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3570 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3572 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3573 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3574 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3575 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3576 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3577 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3580 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3581 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3582 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3585 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3586 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3587 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3588 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3590 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3591 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3592 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3593 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3596 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3597 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3603 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3604 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3605 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3606 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3608 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3609 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3610 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3611 each port only when the first connection is received.
3613 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3614 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3616 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3617 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3618 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3619 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3620 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3621 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3622 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3623 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3624 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3625 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3627 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3628 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3629 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3630 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3631 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3632 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3633 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3634 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3635 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3637 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3638 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3639 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3640 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3641 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3642 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3643 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3645 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3646 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3647 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3648 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3649 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3650 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3651 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3653 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3654 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3655 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3658 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3659 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3660 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3661 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3662 specified by this option.
3665 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3667 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3668 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3669 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3670 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3671 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3672 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3674 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3675 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3676 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3677 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3678 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3679 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3680 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3682 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3683 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3684 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3690 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3691 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3694 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3696 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3697 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3700 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3702 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3703 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3704 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3705 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3706 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3707 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3708 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3711 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3712 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3713 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3714 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3715 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3716 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3717 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3719 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3720 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3721 .irow auth "authenticators"
3722 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3723 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3724 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3725 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3726 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3727 .irow filter "filter handling"
3728 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3729 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3730 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3731 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3732 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3733 .irow load "system load checks"
3734 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3735 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3736 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3737 .irow memory "memory handling"
3738 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3739 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3740 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3741 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3742 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3743 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3744 .irow retry "retry handling"
3745 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3746 .irow route "address routing"
3747 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3748 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3749 .irow transport "transports"
3750 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3751 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3752 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3754 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3755 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3756 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3757 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3758 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3759 turn everything off.
3761 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3762 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3763 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3764 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3765 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3768 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3769 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3770 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3771 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3772 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3775 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3776 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3779 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3780 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3781 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3782 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3783 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3784 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3786 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3787 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3789 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3791 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3792 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3793 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3794 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3797 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3798 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3799 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3802 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3803 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3804 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3805 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3806 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3807 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3808 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3809 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3812 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3813 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3814 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3815 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3816 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3818 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3819 .cindex "sender" "name"
3820 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3821 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3822 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3823 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3824 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3825 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3827 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3828 .cindex "sender" "address"
3829 .cindex "address" "sender"
3830 .cindex "trusted users"
3831 .cindex "envelope from"
3832 .cindex "envelope sender"
3833 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3834 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3835 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3836 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3839 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3840 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3841 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3842 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3845 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3846 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3847 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3848 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3849 examples of shell commands:
3851 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3852 exim -f "" user@domain
3854 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3855 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3858 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3859 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3860 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3861 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3864 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3865 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3866 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3867 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3868 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3869 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3872 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3873 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3875 control = suppress_local_fixups
3877 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3878 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3881 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3884 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3885 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3886 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3887 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3891 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3892 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3893 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3894 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3895 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3896 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3897 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3898 by its &'mailx'& command.
3900 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3901 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3902 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3903 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3904 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3905 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3906 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3908 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3910 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3911 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3912 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3913 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3914 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3915 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3916 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3917 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3920 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3921 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3922 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3923 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3924 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3925 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3927 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3928 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3929 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3930 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3932 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3933 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3934 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3935 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3936 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3937 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3938 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3939 can be used only by an admin user.
3941 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3943 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3944 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3946 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3947 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3948 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3949 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3950 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3951 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3952 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3953 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3956 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3957 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3958 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3961 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3962 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3963 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3966 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3967 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3968 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3970 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3971 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3972 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3973 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3976 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3977 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3978 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3981 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3982 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3983 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3985 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3988 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3989 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3990 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3993 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3994 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3995 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3996 the following four arguments.
3998 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3999 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4000 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
4001 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
4002 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
4003 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
4004 messages through the same SMTP connection.
4006 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
4007 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4008 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
4011 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4012 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4013 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
4017 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4018 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4019 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
4021 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
4025 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4026 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
4027 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
4028 The argument gives the SNI string.
4029 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
4031 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
4032 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4033 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4034 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
4035 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
4037 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4038 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
4039 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
4040 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
4041 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
4042 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
4043 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
4044 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
4045 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
4046 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
4047 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
4048 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
4049 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
4050 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
4052 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
4053 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
4054 .cindex "sender" "changing"
4055 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
4056 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4057 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4058 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4059 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4060 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4062 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4063 .cindex "freezing messages"
4064 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4065 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4066 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4067 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4068 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4069 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4072 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4073 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4074 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4075 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4076 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4077 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4078 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4079 is sent to the sender.
4080 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4083 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4085 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4086 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4087 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4088 queue to the given named queue.
4089 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4090 string to define the default queue.
4091 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4092 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4094 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4095 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4096 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4097 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4098 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4099 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4101 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4102 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4103 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4104 .cindex "removing recipients"
4105 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4106 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4107 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4108 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4109 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4110 can be used only by an admin user.
4112 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4113 .cindex "removing messages"
4114 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4115 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4116 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4117 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4118 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4119 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4120 placed in the queue.
4125 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4126 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4127 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4131 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4132 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4133 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4134 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4135 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4136 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4137 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4138 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4139 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4140 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4142 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4143 .cindex "thawing messages"
4144 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4145 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4146 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4147 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4148 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4149 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4152 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4153 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4154 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4155 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4156 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4158 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4159 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4160 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4161 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4162 be written to the standard output in
4163 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4164 format. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4166 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4167 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4168 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4169 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4170 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4171 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4173 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4174 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4175 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4176 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4177 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4180 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4181 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4182 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4185 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4186 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4187 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4188 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4189 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4190 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4191 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4194 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4195 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4196 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4197 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4198 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4199 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4200 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4204 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4205 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4206 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4207 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4209 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4210 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4213 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4214 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4215 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4216 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4220 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4221 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4222 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4223 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4224 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4225 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4228 .cindex "background delivery"
4229 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4230 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4231 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4232 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4233 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4234 processes to finish.
4236 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4237 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4238 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4239 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4241 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4242 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4243 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4244 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4247 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4248 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4249 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4250 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4251 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4252 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4254 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4255 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4258 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4259 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4261 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4262 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4263 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4264 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4268 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4272 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4273 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4274 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4275 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4276 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4277 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4278 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4279 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4280 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4281 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4285 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4286 .cindex "first pass routing"
4287 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4288 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4289 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4290 configuration file is in effect.
4292 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4293 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4294 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4295 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4296 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4297 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4298 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4299 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4300 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4304 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4305 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4306 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4309 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4311 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4312 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4313 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4314 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4317 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4318 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4319 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4320 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4321 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4324 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4325 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4326 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4327 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4328 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4331 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4332 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4336 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4337 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4341 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4342 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4343 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4344 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4345 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4346 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4349 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4351 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4352 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4353 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4354 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4355 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4356 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4357 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4359 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4360 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4362 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4364 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4365 followed by a colon and the port number:
4367 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4369 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4370 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4371 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4372 whichever one is last.
4374 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4375 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4376 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4377 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4378 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4379 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4380 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4382 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4383 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4384 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4385 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4386 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4387 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4388 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4390 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4391 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4392 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4393 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4394 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4395 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4396 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4397 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4398 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4400 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4401 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4402 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4403 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4404 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4405 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4407 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4408 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4409 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4410 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4411 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4412 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4413 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4414 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4416 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4417 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4418 is sending the bounce.
4420 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4421 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4422 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4423 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4424 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4425 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4426 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4427 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4428 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4429 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4430 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4432 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4433 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4434 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4435 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4436 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4437 uses the name it is given.
4439 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4440 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4441 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4442 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4443 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4444 used, when there is no default.
4447 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4448 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4449 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4450 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4453 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4454 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4455 whatever that means.
4457 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4458 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4459 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4460 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4461 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4462 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4463 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4464 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4467 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4468 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4469 This option is not intended for general use.
4470 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4471 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4472 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4474 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4475 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4476 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4477 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4478 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4479 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4481 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4482 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4483 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4484 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4485 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4486 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4487 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4490 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4492 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4493 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4494 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4495 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4496 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4497 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4498 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4499 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4500 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4503 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4504 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4506 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4508 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4509 option is also present.
4510 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4511 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4513 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4515 The socket is currently used for
4517 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4519 caching compiled regexes
4521 obtaining a current queue size
4525 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4526 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4527 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4528 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4532 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4533 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4534 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4535 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4538 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4540 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4542 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4544 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4545 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4546 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4547 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4548 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4549 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4552 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4553 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4554 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4555 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4556 and &%-S%& options).
4558 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4559 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4560 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4561 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4562 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4563 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4564 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4567 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4568 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4569 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4570 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4571 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4574 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4575 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4576 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4577 this to be repeated periodically.
4579 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4580 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4581 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4582 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4584 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4585 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4586 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4588 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4589 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4590 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4591 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4595 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4596 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4597 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4598 .cindex "first pass routing"
4599 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4600 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4601 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4602 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4605 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4607 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4608 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4609 then in the first phase of the run,
4610 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4611 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4613 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4614 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4615 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4617 After the first queue scan complete,
4618 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4620 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4621 delivered down a single SMTP
4622 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4623 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4624 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4625 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4627 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4628 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4629 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4632 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4634 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4635 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4636 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4637 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4638 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4640 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4642 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4643 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4644 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4645 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4646 their retry times are tried.
4648 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4650 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4651 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4654 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4656 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4657 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4658 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4661 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4664 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4665 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4666 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4667 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4668 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4669 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4670 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4672 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4673 will specify a queue to operate on.
4676 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4678 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4681 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4682 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4683 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4684 starting message id. For example:
4686 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4688 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4689 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4690 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4692 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4694 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4695 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4696 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4697 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4698 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4699 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4701 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4702 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4703 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4704 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4705 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4706 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4707 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4708 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4709 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4711 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4713 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4714 process every 30 minutes.
4716 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4717 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4720 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4723 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4724 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4726 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4728 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4731 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4733 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4735 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4737 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4738 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4739 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4740 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4741 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4742 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4743 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4745 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4746 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4747 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4748 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4749 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4750 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4752 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4753 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4755 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4757 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4758 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4759 applied to each queue run.
4761 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4762 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4763 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4764 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4765 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4766 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4767 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4768 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4769 address will be skipped.
4771 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4772 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4773 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4776 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4777 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4778 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&), its default
4779 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4780 an arbitrary command instead.
4783 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4785 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4787 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4788 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4789 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4790 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4791 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4792 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4794 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4795 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4796 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4797 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4800 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4804 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4805 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4806 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4807 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4808 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4810 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4811 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4812 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4813 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4814 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4815 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4816 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4817 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4818 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4819 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4820 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4822 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4823 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4824 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4825 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4826 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4827 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4829 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4830 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4831 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4832 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4833 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4834 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4835 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4836 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4837 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4838 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4841 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4842 compatibility with Sendmail.
4844 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4845 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4846 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4847 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4848 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4849 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4850 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4854 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4855 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4856 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4857 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4858 set. Exim ignores this option.
4861 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4862 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4863 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4864 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4865 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4866 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4870 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4871 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4872 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4875 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4876 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4877 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4879 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4880 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4881 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4882 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4890 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4891 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4892 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4893 . creates a man page for the options.
4894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4897 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4908 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4909 "The runtime configuration file"
4911 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4912 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4913 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4914 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4915 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4916 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4917 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4918 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4919 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4922 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4923 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4924 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4925 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4926 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4927 actually alter the string.
4929 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4930 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4931 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4932 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4933 existing file in the list.
4936 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4937 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4938 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4939 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4940 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4941 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4942 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4943 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4944 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4945 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4947 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4948 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4949 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4950 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4951 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4953 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4954 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4955 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4956 compromise the Exim user account.
4958 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4959 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4960 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4961 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4962 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4963 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4968 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4969 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4970 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4971 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4972 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4973 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4974 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4975 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4976 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4977 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4978 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4980 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4981 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4982 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4983 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4984 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4985 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4986 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4987 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4988 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4991 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4992 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4993 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4994 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4995 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4997 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4998 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4999 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
5000 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
5001 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
5002 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
5004 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
5005 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
5006 necessarily be discarded.
5007 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
5008 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
5009 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
5010 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
5011 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
5012 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
5014 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
5015 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
5016 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
5017 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
5018 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
5019 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
5020 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
5022 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
5023 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
5024 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
5028 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
5029 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
5030 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
5031 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
5032 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
5033 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
5034 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
5035 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
5038 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
5041 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5042 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
5043 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
5045 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
5046 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
5047 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
5049 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
5050 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
5051 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
5053 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
5054 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
5055 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
5056 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5059 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5060 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5061 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5063 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5064 want to use this feature, you must set
5066 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5068 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5069 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5072 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5073 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5074 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5075 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5077 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5078 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5079 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5080 and does not introduce a comment.
5082 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5083 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5084 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5085 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5086 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5088 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5089 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5090 change settings as required.
5092 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5093 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5094 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5095 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5096 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5101 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5102 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5103 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5104 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5105 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5106 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5109 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5110 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5112 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5113 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5114 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5115 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5116 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5119 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5120 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5121 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5122 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5124 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5125 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5128 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5131 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5132 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5137 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5138 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5139 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5140 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5141 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5142 definition, and must be of the form
5144 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5146 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5147 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5148 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5149 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5150 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5152 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5153 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5154 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5156 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5157 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5158 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5159 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5160 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5161 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5162 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5165 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5166 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5168 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5169 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5170 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5171 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5172 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5173 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5176 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5177 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5178 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5183 MAC == updated value
5185 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5186 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5187 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5188 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5192 MAC == MAC and something added
5194 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5195 from a number of other files.
5197 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5198 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5199 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5200 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5201 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5206 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5207 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5208 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5209 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5211 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5212 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5214 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5216 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5218 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5219 address lists. In Exim version 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5220 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5223 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5224 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5225 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5226 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5227 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5230 The following classes of macros are defined:
5232 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5233 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5234 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5235 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5236 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5237 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5238 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5239 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5240 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5241 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5242 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5243 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5244 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5245 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5246 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5247 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5250 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5253 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5254 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5255 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5256 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5257 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5258 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5259 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5261 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5262 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5263 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5267 message_size_limit = 50M
5269 message_size_limit = 100M
5272 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5273 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5274 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5275 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5276 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5278 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5279 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5280 in this line"& will always be true.
5282 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5283 to clarify complicated nestings.
5287 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5288 .cindex "common option syntax"
5289 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5290 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5291 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5292 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5293 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5294 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5295 space) and then the value. For example:
5297 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5299 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5300 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5301 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5302 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5303 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5304 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5305 word &"hide"&. For example:
5307 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5309 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5311 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5313 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5314 all instances of the same driver.
5316 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5317 that are found in option settings.
5320 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5321 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5322 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5323 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5324 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5325 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5326 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5327 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5328 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5329 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5330 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5331 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5336 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5341 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5346 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5347 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5348 .cindex "format" "integer"
5349 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5350 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5351 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5352 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5355 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5356 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5357 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5359 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5360 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5361 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5365 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5366 .cindex "integer format"
5367 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5368 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5369 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5370 Such options are always output in octal.
5373 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5374 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5375 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5376 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5377 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5381 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5382 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5383 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5384 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5385 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5395 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5396 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5397 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5401 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5402 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5403 .cindex "format" "string"
5404 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5405 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5406 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5407 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5408 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5409 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5410 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5411 therefore equivalent:
5413 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5414 trusted_users = uucp:\
5415 # This comment line is ignored
5418 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5419 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5420 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5421 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5422 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5425 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5426 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5427 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5429 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5430 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5434 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5435 character, that character replaces the pair.
5437 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5438 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5439 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5440 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5441 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5442 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5445 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5446 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5447 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5448 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5449 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5450 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5451 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5452 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5453 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5454 within a quoted configuration string.
5457 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5458 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5459 .cindex "format" "user name"
5460 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5461 .cindex "format" "group name"
5462 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5463 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5464 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5465 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5468 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5469 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5470 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5471 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5472 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5473 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5474 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5475 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5476 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5477 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5478 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5480 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5481 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5482 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5483 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5484 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5485 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5488 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5490 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5492 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5493 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5494 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5495 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5497 .subsection "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5498 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5499 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5500 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5501 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5502 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5503 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5504 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5506 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5508 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5509 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5510 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5512 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5513 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5514 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5515 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5516 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5517 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5518 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5519 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5520 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5522 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5524 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5525 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5526 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5527 the value in quotes. For example:
5529 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5531 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5532 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5533 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5534 enclosing an empty list item.
5538 .subsection "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5539 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5540 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5541 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5543 senders = user@domain :
5545 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5546 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5547 items, the second of which is empty:
5549 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5551 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5552 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5553 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5554 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5558 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5559 is at the end of the list.
5564 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5565 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5566 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5567 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5568 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5569 a sequence of lines like this:
5571 <&'instance name'&>:
5576 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5577 followed by three options settings:
5582 transport = local_delivery
5584 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5585 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5586 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5587 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5588 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5589 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5591 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5592 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5594 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5595 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5596 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5597 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5598 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5601 .cindex "generic options"
5602 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5603 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5604 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5605 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5606 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5607 .cindex "private options"
5608 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5609 they all have default values.
5611 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5612 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5613 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5615 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5616 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5617 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5618 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5619 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5620 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5621 configuration lines:
5626 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5627 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5628 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5629 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5635 command_timeout = 10s
5637 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5638 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5641 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5642 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5643 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5652 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5654 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5655 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5656 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5657 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5658 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5659 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5660 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5661 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5662 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5663 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5664 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5668 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5669 All macros should be defined before any options.
5671 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5673 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5675 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5676 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5677 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5678 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5680 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5681 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5682 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5685 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5686 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5687 in the file, after the macros.
5688 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5690 # primary_hostname =
5692 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5693 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5694 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5695 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5697 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5699 domainlist local_domains = @
5700 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5701 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5703 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5704 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5705 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5706 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5708 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5709 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5712 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5713 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5714 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5715 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5716 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5717 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5719 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5720 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5721 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5722 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5723 domain is permitted.
5725 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5726 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5727 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5728 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5729 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5730 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5732 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5733 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5734 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5736 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5738 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5739 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5741 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5742 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5743 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5744 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5745 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5746 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5747 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5748 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5749 contents of a message to be checked.
5751 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5753 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5754 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5756 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5757 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5758 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5759 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5761 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5763 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5764 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5765 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5767 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5768 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5769 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5770 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5771 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5772 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5773 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5775 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5777 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5778 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5780 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5781 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5782 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5783 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5784 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5785 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5786 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5787 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5788 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5789 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5790 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5791 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5792 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5793 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5794 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5795 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5797 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6409,RFC 6409) (previously 4409)
5798 specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5799 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5800 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
5801 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5802 which should be used in preference to 587.
5803 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5805 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5807 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5810 # qualify_recipient =
5812 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5813 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5814 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5815 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5816 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5817 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5819 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5820 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5821 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5822 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5824 # allow_domain_literals
5826 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5827 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5828 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5829 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5830 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5831 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5833 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5837 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5838 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5839 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5840 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5841 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5842 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5843 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5844 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5846 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5847 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5852 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5853 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5854 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5855 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5856 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5857 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5860 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by
5861 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
5862 (hence their names):
5865 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5867 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5868 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5869 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5870 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5871 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5872 information, you can change this.
5874 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5875 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5880 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5881 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5882 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5883 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5885 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5886 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5888 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5889 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5891 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5894 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5895 +tls_certificate_verified
5898 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5900 # percent_hack_domains =
5902 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5903 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5904 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5906 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5907 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5908 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5909 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5910 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5911 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5912 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5913 always bounce messages.
5915 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5916 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5918 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5919 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5920 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5921 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5922 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5924 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5925 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5926 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5927 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5928 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5931 # split_spool_directory = true
5934 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5935 messages &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2048,RFC 2047)
5936 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5937 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5938 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5939 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5940 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5941 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5943 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5946 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5947 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5948 that are not 8-bit clean.
5950 # accept_8bitmime = false
5953 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5954 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5955 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5956 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5957 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5958 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5960 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5961 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5965 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5966 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5967 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5968 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5969 It starts with the line
5973 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5974 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5975 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5977 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5978 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5979 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5980 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5981 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5982 result of the ACL processing.
5986 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5991 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5992 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5993 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5994 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5995 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5996 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5998 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5999 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
6000 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
6003 deny domains = +local_domains
6004 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
6005 message = Restricted characters in address
6007 deny domains = !+local_domains
6008 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
6009 message = Restricted characters in address
6011 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
6012 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
6013 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
6014 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
6015 in Internet mail addresses.
6017 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
6018 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
6019 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
6020 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
6021 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
6022 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
6023 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
6024 policy of being as safe as possible.
6026 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
6027 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
6028 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
6029 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6030 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6031 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6033 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
6034 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
6035 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
6036 have to modify this rule.
6038 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in
6039 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
6041 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
6042 common convention of local parts constructed as
6043 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
6044 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
6045 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
6046 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
6047 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
6048 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
6050 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
6051 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
6052 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
6053 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
6054 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
6055 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
6056 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
6058 accept local_parts = postmaster
6059 domains = +local_domains
6061 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
6062 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
6063 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6064 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6065 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6067 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6068 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6069 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6071 require verify = sender
6073 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6074 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6075 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6076 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6077 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6078 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6079 discusses the details of address verification.
6081 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6082 control = submission
6084 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6085 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6086 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6087 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6088 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6089 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6090 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6091 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6092 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6094 accept authenticated = *
6095 control = submission
6097 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6098 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6099 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6100 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6101 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6102 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6104 require message = relay not permitted
6105 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6107 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6108 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6110 require verify = recipient
6112 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6113 fails, the address is rejected.
6115 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6116 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6117 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6120 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6121 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6122 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6123 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6125 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6126 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6127 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6130 # require verify = csa
6132 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6133 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6138 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6139 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6143 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6144 of this ACL are commented out:
6147 # message = This message contains a virus \
6150 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6151 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6152 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6153 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6155 # warn spam = nobody
6156 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6157 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6158 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6159 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6161 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6162 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6163 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6164 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6165 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6166 whatever the spam score.
6170 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6173 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6174 .cindex "default" "routers"
6175 .cindex "routers" "default"
6176 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6181 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6182 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6183 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6184 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6185 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6188 # driver = ipliteral
6189 # domains = !+local_domains
6190 # transport = remote_smtp
6192 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6193 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6194 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6195 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6196 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6198 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6199 macro has been defined, per
6201 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6210 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6211 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6212 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6213 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6217 driver = manualroute
6218 domains = ! +local_domains
6219 transport = smarthost_smtp
6220 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6221 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6224 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6225 specified by the line
6227 domains = ! +local_domains
6229 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6230 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6231 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6232 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6233 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6234 passed on to the following routers.
6236 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6237 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6238 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6239 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6241 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6242 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6243 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6244 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6245 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6246 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6247 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6252 domains = ! +local_domains
6253 transport = remote_smtp
6254 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6257 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6259 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6260 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6261 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6262 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6263 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6265 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6266 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6267 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6268 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6269 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6270 the address fails and is bounced.
6272 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6273 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6274 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6275 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6276 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6277 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6278 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6285 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6287 file_transport = address_file
6288 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6290 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6291 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6292 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6293 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6294 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6297 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6298 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6299 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6300 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6305 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6306 # local_part_suffix_optional
6307 file = $home/.forward
6312 file_transport = address_file
6313 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6314 reply_transport = address_reply
6316 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6317 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6318 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6319 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6320 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6323 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6324 # local_part_suffix_optional
6326 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6327 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6328 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6329 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6330 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6331 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6332 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6334 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6335 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6336 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6337 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6339 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6340 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6341 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6342 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6343 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6344 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6345 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6347 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6348 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6349 There are two reasons for doing this:
6352 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6353 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6356 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6357 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6358 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6359 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6363 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6364 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6365 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6366 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6368 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6369 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6370 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6372 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6374 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6380 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6381 # local_part_suffix_optional
6382 transport = local_delivery
6384 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6385 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6386 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6387 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6388 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6391 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6392 .cindex "default" "transports"
6393 .cindex "transports" "default"
6394 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6395 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6396 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6400 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6404 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6409 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6410 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6411 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6412 with over-long lines.
6414 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6415 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6416 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6417 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6419 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6420 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6421 usual federated system.
6426 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6430 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6431 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6432 hosts_require_tls = *
6433 tls_verify_hosts = *
6434 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6435 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6436 # you succeed or not:
6437 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6439 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6440 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6441 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6442 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6443 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6444 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6446 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6447 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6450 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6457 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6458 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6459 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6460 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6461 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6462 then no other options are defined.
6463 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6464 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6465 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6466 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6467 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6468 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6469 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6470 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6471 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6472 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6473 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6475 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6477 All other options are defaulted.
6481 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6488 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6489 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6491 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6492 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6493 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6494 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6495 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6497 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6498 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6499 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6500 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6501 show how this can be done.
6503 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6504 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6505 similarly-named options above.
6511 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6512 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6513 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6514 be returned to the sender.
6522 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6523 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6524 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6529 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6534 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6535 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6536 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6537 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6538 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6539 introduced by the line
6543 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6546 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6548 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6549 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6550 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6551 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6552 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6554 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6555 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6556 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6559 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6560 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6564 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6565 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6569 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6570 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6571 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6573 begin authenticators
6575 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6576 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6577 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6578 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6579 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6580 to support most MUA software.
6582 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6585 # driver = plaintext
6586 # server_set_id = $auth2
6587 # server_prompts = :
6588 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6589 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6591 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6594 # driver = plaintext
6595 # server_set_id = $auth1
6596 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6597 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6598 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6601 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6602 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6603 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6604 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6605 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6606 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6607 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6608 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6610 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6611 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6612 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6613 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6615 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6616 usercode and password are in different positions.
6617 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6619 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6623 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6626 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6628 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6630 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6631 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6632 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6633 regular expressions is discussed in
6634 online Perl manpages, in
6635 many Perl reference books, and also in
6636 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6637 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6638 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6639 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6640 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6642 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6643 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6644 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6645 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6646 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6649 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6650 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6651 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6652 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6654 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6656 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6657 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6658 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6659 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6660 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6661 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6664 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6665 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6666 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6667 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6668 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6669 match anywhere in the subject string.
6671 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6672 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6674 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6676 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6679 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6681 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6682 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6689 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6690 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6691 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6692 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6693 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6694 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6697 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6698 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6699 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6700 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6701 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6702 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6704 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6705 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6706 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6707 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6708 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6709 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6710 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6711 or may be &*implicit*&,
6712 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6715 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6716 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6717 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6718 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6719 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6720 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6722 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6723 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6724 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6725 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6726 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6728 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6729 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6732 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6733 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6734 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6735 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6736 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6737 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6739 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6740 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6742 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6743 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6744 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6745 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6746 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6749 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6750 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6752 The file could contains lines like this:
6757 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6758 matches the list item.
6760 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6761 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6762 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6765 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6766 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6768 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6770 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6771 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6772 causes a second lookup to occur.
6774 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6775 and a comma-separated list of options.
6776 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6777 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6779 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6780 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6781 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6782 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6784 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6785 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6786 lookup is permitted.
6789 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6790 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6791 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6792 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6795 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6796 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6797 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6798 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6799 The file string may not be tainted.
6801 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6802 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6803 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6804 If this is given and the lookup
6805 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6806 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6807 version of the lookup key.
6810 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6811 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6812 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6813 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6815 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6816 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6817 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6818 list item after the first semicolon.
6820 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6821 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6822 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6823 appropriate for the lookup.
6826 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6827 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6828 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6833 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6834 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6835 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6840 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6841 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6842 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6843 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6846 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6847 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6848 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6849 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6850 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6851 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6852 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6853 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6854 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6856 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6857 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6858 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6859 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6861 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6862 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6863 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6864 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6867 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6868 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6869 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6870 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6871 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6872 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6873 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6875 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6876 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6877 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6878 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6879 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6880 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6881 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6884 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6885 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6887 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6888 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6889 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6890 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6891 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6892 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6893 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6896 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6897 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6898 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6900 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6901 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6902 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6903 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6904 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6905 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6906 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6907 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6908 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6909 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6912 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6913 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6914 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6915 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6916 Unless the options (below) permit a path,
6917 the key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6918 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6919 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6920 The result is regarded as untainted.
6922 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6923 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6924 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6926 Three options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6928 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6929 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6931 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6933 The default result is just the requested entry.
6935 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6936 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6937 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6939 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6941 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6944 The "key" option relaxes the restriction that only a simple path component can
6945 be searched for, to permit a sequence of path components. Example:
6947 ${lookup {foo/bar} dsearch,key=path {/etc}}
6949 If this option is used, a ".." component in the key is specifically disallowed.
6950 The default operation is that the key may only be a single path component.
6952 An example of how this
6953 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6954 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6956 .subsection iplsearch
6957 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6958 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6959 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6960 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6961 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6962 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6963 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6965 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6966 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6967 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6968 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6970 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6971 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6972 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6973 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6974 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6976 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6977 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6978 lookup types support only literal keys.
6980 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6981 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6982 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6984 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6985 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6986 notation before executing the lookup.)
6988 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6989 rather than omitting the key portion.
6990 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6994 .cindex json "lookup type"
6995 .cindex JSON expansions
6996 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6997 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6998 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6999 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
7000 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
7001 of the JSON structure.
7002 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
7003 nunbered array element is selected.
7004 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
7005 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
7006 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
7008 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
7014 .cindex database lmdb
7015 The given file is an LMDB database.
7016 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
7017 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
7018 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/,LMDB)
7019 for the feature set and operation modes.
7021 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
7022 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
7023 or your operating system package repository.
7024 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
7026 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
7027 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
7031 .cindex "linear search"
7032 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
7033 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
7034 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
7035 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
7036 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
7037 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
7038 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
7039 in the file is used.
7041 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
7042 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
7043 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
7044 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
7045 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
7050 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
7051 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
7052 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
7053 wildcarding of any kind.
7055 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
7056 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
7057 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
7058 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
7059 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
7060 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
7061 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
7062 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
7063 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7066 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7067 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7068 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7069 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7070 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7071 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7072 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7073 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7075 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
7076 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7077 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7078 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7079 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7080 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7081 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7082 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7083 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7084 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7086 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7087 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7088 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7089 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7092 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7094 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7095 *fish data for anythingfish
7098 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7099 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7101 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7103 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7104 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7105 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7107 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7109 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7110 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7111 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7113 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7116 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7117 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7118 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7119 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7120 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7122 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7123 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7124 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7125 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7126 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7129 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7130 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7131 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7134 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7136 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7139 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7140 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7141 be followed by optional colons.
7143 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7144 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7145 lookup types support only literal keys.
7148 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7149 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7150 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7151 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7152 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7155 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7156 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7157 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7158 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7159 many of them are given in later sections.
7162 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7163 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7164 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7165 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7166 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7169 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7170 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7171 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7174 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7175 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7176 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7177 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7178 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7179 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7180 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7183 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7184 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7185 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7186 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7189 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7190 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7191 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7192 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7195 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7196 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7197 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7198 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7201 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7202 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7203 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7204 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7205 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7206 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7207 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7208 password value. For example:
7210 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7214 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7215 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7216 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7217 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7220 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7221 .cindex lookup Redis
7222 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7223 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7226 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7227 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7228 The format of the query is
7229 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7232 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7233 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7236 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7237 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7238 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7239 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7240 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7241 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7242 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7243 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7244 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7246 require condition = \
7247 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7249 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7250 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7251 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7252 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7256 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7257 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7258 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7259 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7260 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7261 options such as a list of local domains.
7263 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7264 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7265 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7266 or may give up altogether.
7270 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7271 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7272 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7273 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7274 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7275 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7276 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7277 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7279 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7280 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7281 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7283 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7284 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7285 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7287 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7288 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7289 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7290 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7291 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7292 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7293 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7294 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7295 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7296 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7298 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7300 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7301 looks up these keys, in this order:
7307 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7308 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7309 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7310 Exim move on to try the next key.
7314 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7315 .cindex "partial matching"
7316 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7317 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7318 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7319 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7320 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7321 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7322 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7323 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7324 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7325 a key in a DBM file is
7327 *.dates.fict.example
7329 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7330 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7331 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7334 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7335 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7336 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7338 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7339 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7340 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7341 partial matching keys
7342 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7343 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7344 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7346 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7347 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7348 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7349 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7350 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7351 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7354 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7355 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7356 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7357 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7358 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7359 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7361 2250.dates.fict.example
7362 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7363 *.dates.fict.example
7366 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7369 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7370 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7371 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7372 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7373 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7374 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7376 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7378 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7379 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7380 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7381 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7383 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7385 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7386 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7388 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7389 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7390 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7393 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7395 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7396 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7398 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7399 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7400 for &"*"& on its own.
7402 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7406 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7407 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7408 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7409 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7410 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7411 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7412 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7414 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7415 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7416 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7417 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7418 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7420 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7421 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7422 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7423 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7428 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7429 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7430 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7431 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7432 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7433 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7434 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7436 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7437 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7438 and a real lookup is done.
7440 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7441 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7442 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7443 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7444 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7445 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7447 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7448 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7454 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7455 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7456 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7457 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7458 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7459 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7463 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7464 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7466 [name="$local_part"]
7468 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7469 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7470 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7471 of the following form is provided:
7473 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7475 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7477 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7479 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7480 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7481 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7482 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7483 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7484 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7489 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7490 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7491 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7492 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7493 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7494 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7495 an expansion string could contain:
7497 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7499 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7500 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7501 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7502 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7504 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7505 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7506 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7508 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7509 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7510 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7511 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7512 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7514 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7516 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7517 white space is ignored.
7518 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7519 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7520 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7522 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7523 When the type is PTR,
7524 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7525 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7527 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7529 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7530 altered and nothing is added.
7532 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7533 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7534 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7535 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7536 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7537 The field separator can be modified as above.
7539 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7540 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7541 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7542 unless a field separator is specified.
7543 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7545 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7547 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7548 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7549 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7551 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7552 white space is ignored.
7554 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7555 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7556 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7557 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7560 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7563 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7564 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7565 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7566 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7567 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7568 each followed by a comma,
7569 that may appear before the record type.
7571 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7572 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7573 a defer-option modifier.
7574 The possible keywords are
7575 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7576 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7577 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7578 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7579 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7580 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7581 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7583 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7584 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7586 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7587 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7589 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7590 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7591 The possible keywords are
7592 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7593 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7595 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7596 is not labelled as authenticated data
7597 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7598 The default is &"lax"&.
7600 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7602 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7603 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7604 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7605 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7607 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7609 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7610 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7611 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7613 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7614 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7616 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7617 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7618 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7621 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7622 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7623 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7624 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7625 the pseudo-type MXH:
7627 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7629 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7632 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7633 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7634 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7635 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7636 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7637 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7638 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7639 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7641 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7642 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7644 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7645 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7646 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7648 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7649 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7650 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7651 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7652 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7655 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7656 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7657 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7658 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7659 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7660 result of a successful lookup such as:
7662 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7664 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7665 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7666 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7668 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7669 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7670 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7671 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7673 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7677 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7678 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7679 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7680 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7681 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7683 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7684 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7685 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7687 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7688 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7689 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7690 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7692 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7693 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7694 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7699 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7700 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7701 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7702 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7703 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7704 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7705 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7706 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7707 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7708 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7709 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7710 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7712 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7713 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7714 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7715 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7716 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7718 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7719 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7721 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7722 the way they handle the results of a query:
7725 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7728 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7729 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7731 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7732 from all of them are returned.
7736 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7737 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7738 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7739 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7742 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7743 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7744 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in
7745 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2255). For example, in
7746 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7748 data = ${lookup ldap \
7749 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7750 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7752 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7753 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7754 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7755 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7757 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7758 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7759 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7761 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7762 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7763 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7764 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7765 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7766 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7767 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7768 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7772 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7773 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7774 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7775 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7776 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7777 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7779 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7780 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7789 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2254,RFC 2254).
7790 The resulting string is then quoted according
7791 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7795 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7797 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7801 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7803 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7805 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7807 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7808 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7809 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7813 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7814 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in
7815 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2253).)
7816 The resulting string is then quoted according to the rules for URLs.
7819 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7823 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7825 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7827 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7829 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7830 authentication below.
7833 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7834 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7835 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7836 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7837 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7840 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7842 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7843 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7844 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7845 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7846 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7847 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7848 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7849 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7850 failures, and timeouts.
7852 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7853 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator
7854 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1738,RFC 1738)). Because
7855 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7856 doubled. For example
7858 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7860 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7861 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7862 the local host) is used.
7864 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7865 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7866 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7867 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7870 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7871 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7872 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7873 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7875 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7877 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7878 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7880 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7882 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7883 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7884 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7885 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7886 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7887 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7888 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7891 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7892 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7893 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7896 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7899 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7903 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7904 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7908 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7909 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7910 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7911 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7912 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7913 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7914 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7915 them. The following names are recognized:
7916 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7917 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7918 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7919 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7920 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7921 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7922 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7923 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7924 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7926 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7927 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7928 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7929 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7931 .cindex LDAP timeout
7932 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7933 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7934 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7935 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7936 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7937 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7938 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7939 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7940 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7941 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7943 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7944 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7946 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7947 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7948 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7949 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7950 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7951 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7952 alternate list (colon-separated).
7954 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7955 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7958 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7959 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7962 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7963 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7964 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7965 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7967 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7968 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7969 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7971 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7972 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7974 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7975 quoting has two advantages:
7978 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7979 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7981 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7984 For example, a setting such as
7986 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7988 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7990 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7991 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7992 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7993 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7997 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7998 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
8003 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
8004 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
8005 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
8006 as a sequence of values, for example
8008 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
8010 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
8011 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
8012 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
8013 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
8014 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
8017 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
8018 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
8019 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
8020 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
8022 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
8023 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
8024 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
8025 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
8026 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
8027 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
8028 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
8029 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
8030 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
8032 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
8033 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
8034 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
8035 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
8036 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
8039 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
8042 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8045 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
8046 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
8048 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8049 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8051 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
8052 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8055 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
8056 results of LDAP lookups.
8057 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
8058 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
8059 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
8060 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
8061 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
8062 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
8067 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
8068 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
8069 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
8070 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8071 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8072 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8073 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8074 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8076 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8078 might return the string
8080 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8081 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8083 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8085 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8091 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8092 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8093 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8097 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8098 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8099 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8100 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8101 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8102 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8103 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8104 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8105 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8106 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8107 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8108 .cindex lookup Redis
8109 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8111 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8114 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8117 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8118 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8120 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8125 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8127 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8128 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8129 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8133 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8134 with a newline between the data for each row.
8137 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8138 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8139 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8140 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8141 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8142 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8143 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8144 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8145 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8146 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8147 .cindex lookup Redis
8148 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8149 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8150 or &%redis_servers%&
8151 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8153 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8154 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8155 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8156 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8157 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8158 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8159 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8160 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8162 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8163 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8164 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8165 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8167 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8169 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8170 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8171 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8173 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8174 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8176 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8177 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8178 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8179 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8180 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8181 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8183 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8184 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8185 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8187 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8188 host, database number, and password.
8190 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8191 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8192 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8194 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8196 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8199 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8200 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8201 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8202 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8204 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8205 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8207 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8208 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8209 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8210 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8212 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8214 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8216 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8217 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8218 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8221 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8223 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8224 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8225 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8227 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8228 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8229 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8232 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8236 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8238 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8240 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8241 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8242 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8244 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8247 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8248 semicolon separated:
8250 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8252 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8253 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8254 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8255 including the server specification - which is not permissible.
8256 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8257 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8259 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8262 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8263 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8264 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8265 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8266 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8267 the default value is &"exim"&.
8268 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8270 <&'hostspec'&><&'portspec'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8271 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8273 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8274 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8277 A &'hostspec'& can be a hostname, an IPv4 address or an IPv6 address.
8278 For the latter, a &'portspec'& is a dot followed by a port number;
8279 for the other two a &'portspec'& is a colon followed by a port number.
8282 Note that the default list-separator for the list of servers is a colon so
8283 (unless that is changed) all colons in list items must be doubled.
8285 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8288 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8289 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8291 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8292 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8293 is zero because no rows are affected.
8295 To get an encryted connection, use a Mysql option file with the required
8296 parameters for the connection.
8299 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8301 The &'hostspec'& for PostgreSQL follows the same rules as for MySQL above.
8304 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8305 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8306 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8307 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8310 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8312 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8313 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8314 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8316 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8317 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8320 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8321 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8322 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8323 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8324 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8325 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8327 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8328 There are two ways of
8329 specifying the file.
8330 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8331 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8332 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8333 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8335 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8337 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8338 separated by white space.
8340 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8341 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8342 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8345 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8347 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8349 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8351 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8353 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8355 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8356 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8358 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8359 quote, which it doubles.
8361 .cindex timeout SQLite
8362 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8363 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8364 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8365 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8366 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8367 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8368 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8371 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8372 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8373 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8374 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8377 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8378 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8381 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8382 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8383 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8384 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8387 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8388 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8389 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8399 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8400 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8401 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8402 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8403 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8404 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8405 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8406 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8407 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8409 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8410 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8411 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8412 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8414 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8415 support all the complexity available in
8416 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8420 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8421 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8422 In some contexts additional information is stored
8423 about the list element that matched:
8426 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8427 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8429 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8430 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8432 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8433 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8435 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8436 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8438 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8439 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8442 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8443 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8448 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8449 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8451 Each list, after any leading change-of-separator specification
8452 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) is expanded as a single string,
8453 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8454 &*Note*&: As a result, if any component was tainted then the
8455 entire expansion result string becomes tainted.
8457 Splitting out a leading explicit change-of-separator permits
8458 one being safely used on a list that has tainted components
8459 while still detecting the use of a tainted setting.
8460 The latter is not permitted.
8463 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8464 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8467 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8468 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8469 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8470 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8471 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8474 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8475 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8476 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8478 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8479 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8480 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8481 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8482 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8484 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8485 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8487 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8488 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8489 senders based on the receiving domain.
8494 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8495 .cindex "list" "negation"
8496 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8497 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8498 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8499 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8500 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8501 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8503 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8504 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8505 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8506 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8507 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8509 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8511 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8512 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8513 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8515 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8517 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8518 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8519 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8521 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8522 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8527 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8528 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8529 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8530 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8531 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8532 filenames are not allowed,
8533 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8534 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8538 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8539 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8541 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8542 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8543 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8545 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8549 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8550 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8551 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8552 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8554 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8555 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8557 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8559 and the file contains the lines
8564 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8565 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8569 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8570 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8571 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8572 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8573 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8574 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8575 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8576 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8578 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8579 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8580 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8581 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8586 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8587 .cindex "named lists"
8588 .cindex "list" "named"
8589 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8590 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8591 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8592 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8593 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8594 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8595 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8597 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8599 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8600 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8601 configured with the line
8603 domains = +local_domains
8605 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8606 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8610 domains = ! +local_domains
8611 transport = remote_smtp
8614 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8615 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8616 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8617 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8619 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8620 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8622 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8624 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8625 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8626 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8628 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8629 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8630 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8632 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8633 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8635 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8636 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8637 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8639 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8641 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8642 referenced lists if you can.
8645 The list item which references a named list (&"+<listname>"&)
8649 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8650 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8651 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8652 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8653 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8654 word &"hide"&. For example:
8656 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8660 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8661 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8662 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8664 domains = +local_domains
8666 on several of your routers
8667 or in several ACL statements,
8668 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8669 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8670 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8671 the same each time they are referenced.
8673 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8674 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8675 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8676 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8680 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8681 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8682 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8683 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8684 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8687 ALIST = host1 : host2
8688 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8690 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8692 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8694 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8697 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8698 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8700 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8702 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8706 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8707 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8708 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8709 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8710 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8711 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8712 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8713 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8714 message. For example:
8716 domainlist special_domains = \
8717 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8719 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8720 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8721 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8722 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8723 same list each time.
8725 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8726 cache the result anyway. For example:
8728 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8730 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8731 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8735 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8736 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8737 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8738 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8739 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8742 .cindex "primary host name"
8743 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8744 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8745 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8746 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8747 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8748 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8749 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8750 differ only in their names.
8752 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8754 The pattern may not be tainted.
8759 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8760 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8761 .cindex "domain literal"
8762 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8763 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8764 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8765 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8766 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8767 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8768 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8770 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8772 The pattern may not be tainted.
8778 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8779 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8780 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8781 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8782 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8783 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8784 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8785 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8786 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8787 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8788 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8791 The pattern may not be tainted.
8794 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8795 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8796 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8797 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8798 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8800 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8801 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8802 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8803 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8804 on a router). For example:
8806 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8808 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8809 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8811 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8812 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8813 contain negative items.
8815 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8816 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8817 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8819 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8820 an.other.domain : ...
8822 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8823 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8825 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8826 an.other.domain ? ...
8828 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8832 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8833 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8834 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8835 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8836 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8837 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8838 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8839 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8840 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8843 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8844 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8845 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8848 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8849 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8850 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8851 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8852 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8853 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8854 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8855 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8856 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8858 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8859 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8860 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8861 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8862 expression by expansion, of course).
8864 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8865 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8866 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8871 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8872 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8873 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8874 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8875 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8876 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8878 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8880 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8881 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8882 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8883 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8884 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8885 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8886 other statements in the same ACL.
8887 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8888 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8889 The value will be untainted.
8891 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8892 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8893 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8894 may be what is wanted.
8898 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8899 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8901 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8903 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8904 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8907 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8908 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8909 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8910 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8911 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8912 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8916 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8917 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8918 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8919 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8921 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8922 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8924 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8925 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8926 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8927 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8928 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8929 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8930 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8931 The value will be untainted.
8934 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8935 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8936 followed by a comma and options,
8937 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8938 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8941 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8942 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8943 between the pattern and the domain.
8945 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8946 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8947 Note that this is commonly untainted
8948 (depending on the way the list was created).
8949 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8950 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8951 the domain, for later operations.
8953 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8954 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8955 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8959 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8961 domainlist funny_domains = \
8964 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8965 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8966 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8967 nis;domains.byname : \
8968 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8970 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8971 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8972 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8973 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8974 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8979 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8980 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8981 .cindex "list" "host list"
8982 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8983 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8984 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8985 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8986 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8987 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8988 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8991 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8992 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8993 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8994 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8995 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8996 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8999 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9000 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
9001 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
9005 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
9006 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
9007 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
9008 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
9009 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
9010 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
9011 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
9014 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
9015 inspecting its IP address:
9018 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
9019 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
9020 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
9021 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
9022 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
9023 with the IP address of the subject host.
9025 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
9026 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
9027 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
9028 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
9029 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9032 .cindex "@ in a host list"
9033 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
9034 domain name, as just described.
9037 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
9038 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
9039 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
9040 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
9041 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
9042 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
9043 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
9044 that can never match a client host.
9047 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
9048 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
9049 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
9050 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
9052 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
9056 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9057 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
9062 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
9063 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
9064 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
9065 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
9066 significant end of the address.
9068 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
9069 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
9070 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
9071 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
9075 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
9076 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
9079 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
9081 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
9082 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
9084 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
9085 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
9088 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
9090 could make use of a file containing
9095 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
9096 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
9097 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
9099 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
9102 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9108 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9110 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9111 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9112 address, the pattern takes this form:
9114 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9118 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9120 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9121 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9122 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9123 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9124 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9125 returned by the lookup is not used.
9127 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9128 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9129 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9130 patterns of this form:
9132 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9136 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9138 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9139 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9140 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9141 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9142 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9144 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9145 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9146 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9147 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9148 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9149 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9150 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9151 converted using colons and not dots.
9152 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9153 addresses are always used.
9154 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9156 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9157 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9158 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9161 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9162 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9163 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9164 case the IP address is used on its own.
9168 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9169 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9170 .cindex "unknown host name"
9171 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9172 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9173 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9174 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9175 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9178 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9179 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9180 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9181 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9182 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9183 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9184 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9186 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9187 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9189 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9190 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9191 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9192 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9193 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9194 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9195 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9196 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9197 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9199 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9200 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9202 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9203 .cindex "alias for host"
9204 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9205 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9208 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9209 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9210 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9211 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9212 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9215 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9216 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9217 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9218 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9219 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9220 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9221 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9226 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9227 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9228 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9229 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9230 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9232 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9234 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9235 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9236 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9243 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9244 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9245 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9246 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9247 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9248 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9250 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9251 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9253 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9254 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9255 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9256 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9257 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9258 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9259 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9260 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9261 not recognized in an indirected file).
9262 The effects of these special items do not propagate into referenced
9266 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9267 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9269 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9271 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9272 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9275 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9276 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9279 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9282 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9283 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9284 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9287 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9288 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9291 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9293 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9295 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9296 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9297 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9300 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9301 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9302 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9304 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9306 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9307 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9308 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9309 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9310 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9311 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9312 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9315 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9316 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9318 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9319 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9321 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9322 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9323 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9328 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9330 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9331 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9332 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9333 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9334 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9335 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9336 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9337 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9338 host lists such as whitelists.
9342 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9344 .cindex "unknown host name"
9345 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9346 If a pattern is of the form
9348 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9352 dbm;/host/accept/list
9354 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9355 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9358 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9359 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9360 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9361 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9362 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9363 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9364 lookup, both using the same file.
9368 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9369 If a pattern is of the form
9371 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9373 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9374 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9375 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9377 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9378 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9380 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9381 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9382 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9385 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9386 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9387 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9389 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9390 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9391 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9392 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9393 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9394 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9400 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9401 .cindex "list" "address list"
9402 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9403 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9404 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9405 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9406 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9407 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9408 using this option setting:
9412 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9413 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9414 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9415 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9417 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9420 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9422 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9423 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9424 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9425 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9426 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9427 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9428 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9430 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9431 *@+hostile_domains:\
9432 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9433 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9435 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9436 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9437 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9438 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9439 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9441 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9442 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9443 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9444 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9445 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9447 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9450 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9451 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9455 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9456 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9457 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9458 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9459 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9460 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9461 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9463 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9464 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9466 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9467 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9470 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9471 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9472 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9475 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9476 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9477 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9479 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9480 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9481 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9482 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9484 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9485 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9487 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9488 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9489 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9490 default. For example, with this lookup:
9492 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9494 the file could contains lines like this:
9496 user1@domain1.example
9499 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9502 nimrod@jaeger.example
9506 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9507 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9509 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9511 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9512 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9514 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9515 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9516 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9520 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9521 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9526 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9527 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9528 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9529 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9530 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9531 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9532 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9533 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9534 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9536 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9537 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9538 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9539 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9540 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9543 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9545 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9547 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9549 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9551 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9552 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9553 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9554 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9555 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9556 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9558 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9561 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9564 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9565 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9566 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9567 might have entries like
9569 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9570 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9573 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9574 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9575 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9576 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9578 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9579 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9580 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9583 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9584 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9585 can only return a single list of local parts.
9588 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9589 in these two examples:
9592 senders = *@+my_list
9594 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9595 example it is a named domain list.
9600 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9601 .cindex "case of local parts"
9602 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9603 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9604 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9605 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9606 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However,
9607 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505) (&'Anti-Spam
9608 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9609 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9610 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9613 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9614 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9615 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9616 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9617 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9618 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9619 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9622 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9623 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9624 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9625 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9626 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9627 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9628 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9629 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9630 The effects of &"+caseful"& propagate into any referenced named lists.
9633 This string may not be tainted.
9634 To do caseful matching on list elements whic are tainted,
9635 place them in a named list.
9640 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9641 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9642 .cindex "local part" "list"
9643 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9646 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9647 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9648 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9649 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9650 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9651 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9652 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9653 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9656 This string may not be tainted.
9657 To do caseful matching on list elements whic are tainted,
9658 place them in a named list.
9661 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9662 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9663 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9664 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9665 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9666 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9667 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9669 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9675 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9677 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9678 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9679 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9680 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9682 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9683 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9684 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9685 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9686 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9687 escape character, as described in the following section.
9689 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9690 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9692 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9693 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9694 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9695 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9696 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9698 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9699 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9700 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9701 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9702 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9704 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9706 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9707 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9708 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9709 or the password file,
9710 or accessed via a DBMS.
9711 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9715 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9716 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9717 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9718 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9719 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9720 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9721 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9722 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9724 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9725 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9726 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9727 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9729 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9731 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9732 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9737 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9738 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9739 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9740 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9741 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9742 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9743 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9746 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9747 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9748 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9751 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9752 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9753 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9755 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9756 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9757 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9758 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9759 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9760 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9761 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9764 When reading lines from the standard input,
9765 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9769 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9771 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9773 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9774 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9775 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9778 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9779 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9780 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9781 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9783 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9785 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9786 Exim message identifier. For example:
9788 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9790 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9791 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9794 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9795 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9796 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9797 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9798 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9799 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9800 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9801 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9802 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9803 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9804 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9805 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9811 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9812 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9813 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9814 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9815 white space is significant.
9818 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9819 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9820 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9825 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9826 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9827 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9828 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9829 given, the expansion fails.
9831 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9832 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9833 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9834 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9838 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9839 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9840 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9841 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9842 string easier to understand.
9844 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9845 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9846 expansion item below.
9849 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9850 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9851 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9852 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9853 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9854 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9855 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9856 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9857 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9858 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9859 the result of the expansion.
9860 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9861 the expansion result is an empty string.
9862 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9865 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9866 .cindex authentication "results header"
9867 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9868 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9869 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9870 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9872 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9873 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9874 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9883 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9885 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9887 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9888 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9891 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9892 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9893 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9894 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9895 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9896 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9897 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9898 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9902 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9903 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9908 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9912 If the field is found,
9913 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9914 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9915 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9916 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9918 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9919 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9922 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9924 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9925 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9927 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9928 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9929 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9930 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9931 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9932 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9933 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9934 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9936 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9937 take an optional modifier of "int"
9938 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9939 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9940 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9942 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9943 newline-separated by default,
9944 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9945 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9946 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9948 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9949 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9950 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9951 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9952 if so the element tags are omitted.
9954 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9956 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9957 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9959 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9960 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9964 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9965 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9966 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9968 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9971 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9972 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9973 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9974 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9975 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9976 must have the following type:
9978 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9980 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9981 function should return one of the following values:
9983 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9984 into the expanded string that is being built.
9986 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9987 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9989 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9990 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9992 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9994 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9995 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9996 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9999 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10000 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
10001 .cindex "environment" "values from"
10002 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
10004 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
10005 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
10006 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
10008 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
10009 appear, for example:
10011 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
10013 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
10014 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
10016 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
10018 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
10021 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
10022 &%add_environment%& main section options.
10025 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10026 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10027 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
10028 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
10029 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
10030 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
10031 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
10032 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
10034 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
10036 .vindex "&$value$&"
10037 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
10038 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
10039 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
10040 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
10041 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
10042 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
10043 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
10044 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
10045 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
10047 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
10048 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10049 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
10052 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
10053 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
10055 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
10056 appear, for example:
10058 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
10060 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
10061 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
10063 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10064 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10065 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10066 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10067 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
10068 .cindex JSON expansions
10069 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
10070 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
10071 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
10072 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
10074 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
10076 .vindex "&$value$&"
10077 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
10078 the spaces are optional.
10079 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
10080 For the &"json"& variant,
10081 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10083 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10084 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10085 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
10087 The results of matching are handled as above.
10090 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
10091 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10092 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
10093 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
10094 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10095 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10096 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
10097 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
10098 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
10099 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
10100 <&'string3'&> as before.
10102 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
10103 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
10104 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
10105 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
10106 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
10107 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
10108 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
10109 provided. For example:
10111 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10115 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10117 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
10118 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
10121 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10122 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10123 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10124 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10125 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
10126 .cindex JSON expansions
10127 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10128 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10130 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10131 there is no choice of field separator.
10132 For the &"json"& variant,
10133 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10135 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10136 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10139 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10140 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10141 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10144 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10145 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10146 then the whole is taken as a list.
10148 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10150 For each item in this list,
10151 its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is evaluated.
10152 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10153 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10154 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10155 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10156 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10158 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10160 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10161 to what it was before.
10162 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10165 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10166 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10167 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10168 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10169 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10170 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10172 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10173 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10174 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10175 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10177 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10179 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10180 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10181 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10182 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10183 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10185 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10187 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10188 letters appear. For example:
10190 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10191 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10192 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10195 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10196 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10197 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10198 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10199 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10200 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10201 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10202 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10203 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10204 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10205 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10206 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10207 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10208 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10209 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10210 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10211 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10215 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10216 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10217 lines) may be present.
10219 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10220 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10223 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10224 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10225 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10228 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10229 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10230 are multiple headers with a given name.
10231 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10232 list-processing facilities can be used.
10233 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10234 the content is &"raw"&.
10237 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10238 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10239 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10240 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10241 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10242 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10243 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10244 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10247 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10248 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10249 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10250 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10251 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10252 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10255 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10256 command of the following form:
10258 headers charset "UTF-8"
10260 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10261 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10262 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10263 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10264 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10267 Header names follow the syntax of
10268 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
10269 which states that they may contain
10270 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10271 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10272 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10274 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10275 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10276 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10277 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10278 router or transport are not accessible.
10280 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10281 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10282 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10283 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10284 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10285 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10286 point they are added.
10287 When any of the above ACLs are
10288 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10290 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10291 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10292 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10293 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10294 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10295 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10296 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10299 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10300 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10301 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10302 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10303 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10304 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10305 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10306 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10308 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10309 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10310 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10313 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10314 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10316 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10317 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10318 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2104.RFC 2104).
10319 This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10320 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10321 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10322 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10323 present. For example:
10325 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10327 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10330 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10332 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10333 an Exim configuration:
10335 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10337 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10340 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10341 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10342 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10344 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10345 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10346 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10347 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10348 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10349 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10352 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10353 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10354 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10355 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10356 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10357 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10359 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10361 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10362 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10363 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10364 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10365 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10367 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10368 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10369 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10371 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10375 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10380 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10381 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10382 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10383 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10384 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10385 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10389 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10390 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10391 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10392 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10393 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10394 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10395 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10396 some of the braces:
10398 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10400 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10401 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10402 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10403 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10406 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10407 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10408 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10409 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10410 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10411 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10412 apart from an optional leading minus,
10413 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10416 The <&'string1'&> argument, after any leading change-of-separator
10417 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
10418 is expanded and the whole forms the list.
10420 By default, the list separator is a colon.
10422 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10423 If the number is negative, the fields are
10424 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10425 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10426 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10428 If the modulus of the
10429 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10430 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10434 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10438 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10440 yields &"result: 42"&.
10442 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10443 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10445 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10448 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10449 .cindex quoting "for list"
10450 .cindex list quoting
10451 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10452 in the given string.
10453 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10454 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10455 in a list using the given separator.
10458 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10459 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10460 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10461 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10462 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10463 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10464 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10465 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10466 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10467 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10468 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10470 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10471 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10472 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10473 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10474 out by the system administrator.
10476 .vindex "&$value$&"
10477 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10478 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10479 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10480 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10481 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10482 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10483 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10484 original lookup fails.
10486 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10487 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10488 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10489 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10490 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10491 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10492 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10493 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10495 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10496 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10497 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10498 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10500 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10501 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10502 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10503 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10505 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10507 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10509 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10510 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10512 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10517 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10518 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10521 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10522 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10523 then the whole is taken as a list.
10525 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10527 For each item in this list,
10528 its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10529 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10530 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10531 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10533 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10535 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10536 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10537 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10539 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10540 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10541 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10542 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10543 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10544 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10545 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10547 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10549 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10550 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10551 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10552 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10555 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10557 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10561 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10562 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10563 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10564 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10565 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10566 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10567 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10568 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10570 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10571 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10572 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10573 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10574 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10575 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10578 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10579 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10580 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10582 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10583 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10586 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10587 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10588 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10589 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10590 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10591 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10592 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10593 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10595 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10596 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10597 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10598 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10599 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10600 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10601 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10602 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10603 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10604 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10606 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10607 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10608 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10609 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10611 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10612 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10613 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10614 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10615 is the expansion of the third argument.
10617 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10618 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10619 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10621 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10622 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10623 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10624 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10625 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10626 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10627 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10628 newlines are left in the string.
10629 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10630 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10631 the string expansion fails.
10633 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10634 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10638 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10639 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10640 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10641 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10642 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10643 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10644 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10647 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10648 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10650 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10651 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10652 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10653 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10654 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10657 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10659 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10660 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10661 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10662 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10663 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10664 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10665 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10667 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10670 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10671 and must be present if any options are given.
10672 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10675 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10678 The following option names are recognised:
10681 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10682 request in the same process.
10683 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10684 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10685 will be invalidated.
10689 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10690 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10691 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10695 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10696 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10700 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10701 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10702 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10706 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10707 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10708 turns them into spaces:
10710 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10712 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10713 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10714 addition, the following errors can occur:
10717 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10719 Failure to connect the socket;
10721 Failure to write the request string;
10723 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10726 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10727 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10728 errors occurs. For example:
10730 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10733 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10734 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10735 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10736 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10737 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10739 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10740 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10743 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10744 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10745 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10746 .vindex "&$value$&"
10748 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string.
10751 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10752 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10753 then the whole is taken as a list.
10755 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10757 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10758 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10759 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10760 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10761 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10762 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10763 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10765 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10767 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10770 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10772 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10773 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10776 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10777 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10778 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10781 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10782 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10783 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10784 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10787 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10788 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10789 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10791 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10792 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10793 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10794 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10795 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10796 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10797 and without whitespace.
10799 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10800 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10801 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10802 Then the command is run
10803 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10804 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10805 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10806 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10808 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10809 potential attacker;
10810 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10812 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10813 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10814 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10815 and then the command is run as above.
10816 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10817 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10818 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10819 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10820 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10821 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10822 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10823 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10824 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10826 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10828 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10829 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10830 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10831 .vindex "&$value$&"
10832 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10833 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10834 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10835 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10836 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10839 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10840 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10841 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10842 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10844 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10845 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10846 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10849 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10850 log_message = Output of id: $value
10852 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10853 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10855 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10857 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10859 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10860 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10861 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10863 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10864 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10868 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10869 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10872 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10873 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10874 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10875 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10877 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10878 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10881 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10882 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10883 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10884 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10885 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10886 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10887 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10888 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10890 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10892 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10893 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10894 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10896 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10898 yields &"defabc"&, and
10900 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10902 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10903 the regular expression from string expansion.
10905 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10906 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10909 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10910 .cindex sorting "a list"
10911 .cindex list sorting
10912 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10914 <&'string'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10915 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10916 then the whole is taken as a list.
10918 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10920 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10921 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10922 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10923 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10924 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10925 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10926 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10927 to give values for comparison.
10929 The item result is a sorted list,
10930 with the original list separator,
10931 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10935 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10937 sorts a list of numbers, and
10939 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10941 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10945 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10946 SRS encoding. See section &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10950 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10951 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10952 .cindex "substring extraction"
10953 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10954 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10955 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10956 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10957 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10959 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10961 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10962 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10965 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10966 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10967 length required. For example
10969 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10971 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10972 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10973 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10974 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10976 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10977 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10978 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10980 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10982 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10983 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10984 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10986 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10988 yields an empty string, but
10990 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10994 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10995 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10996 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10997 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
11000 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
11002 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
11004 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11008 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
11009 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
11010 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
11011 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
11012 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
11013 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
11014 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
11015 replacement list. For example
11017 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
11019 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
11020 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
11021 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
11024 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11030 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
11031 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
11032 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
11033 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
11034 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
11035 following operations can be performed:
11038 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11039 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
11040 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
11041 The string is interpreted as an
11042 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11043 address, as it might appear in a
11044 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
11045 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11047 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11050 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11051 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
11052 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
11053 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in
11054 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11055 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
11056 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
11057 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
11058 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
11059 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
11061 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
11062 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
11063 character. For example:
11065 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
11067 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
11068 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
11069 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
11070 separator explicitly:
11072 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
11075 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
11076 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
11077 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
11080 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
11081 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
11082 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
11083 email address separator. For the example header line:
11085 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
11087 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
11088 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
11089 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
11090 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
11091 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
11092 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
11093 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
11095 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
11096 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
11098 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
11099 Last:user@example.com
11100 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
11102 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
11106 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11107 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
11108 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11109 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11110 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
11111 Only lowercase letters are used.
11113 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
11114 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
11115 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11116 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
11117 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
11119 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11120 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
11121 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11122 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11123 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
11124 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
11125 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
11126 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
11127 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
11129 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
11130 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
11131 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11132 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
11133 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
11134 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
11137 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11138 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
11139 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
11140 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
11141 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
11142 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
11144 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11145 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
11148 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11149 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
11150 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
11151 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
11152 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
11155 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11156 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
11157 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
11158 The string is interpreted as an
11159 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11160 address and the domain is extracted from it.
11161 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11164 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11165 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
11166 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
11167 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11168 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11169 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11170 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11172 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11173 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11174 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11175 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11176 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11177 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11180 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11181 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11182 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11183 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11184 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11185 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11186 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11187 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11188 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11189 C programming language):
11191 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11192 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11193 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11194 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11195 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11197 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11199 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11200 space is permitted before or after operators.
11202 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11203 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11204 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11205 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11206 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11208 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11210 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11211 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11214 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11215 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11216 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11217 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11218 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11219 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11220 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11221 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11222 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11223 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11224 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11227 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11231 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11234 {$recipients_count} \
11235 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11238 message = Too many bad recipients
11240 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11241 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11244 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11245 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11246 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11249 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11251 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11252 and then re-expands what it has found.
11255 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11257 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11258 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11259 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11260 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11261 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11262 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11263 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11264 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11265 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11267 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11268 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11269 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11270 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11271 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11272 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11273 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11276 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11277 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11278 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11279 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11280 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11281 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11283 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11285 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11286 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11290 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11291 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11292 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11293 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11294 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11295 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11296 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11297 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11298 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11299 column number is reached.
11300 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11301 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11302 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11306 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11307 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11308 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11309 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11310 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11311 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11315 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11316 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11317 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11318 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11319 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11320 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11321 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11324 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11325 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11326 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11327 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11328 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11329 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11330 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11332 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11333 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11334 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11335 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11336 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11337 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11338 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11339 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11340 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11343 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11344 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11345 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11346 .cindex "lower casing"
11347 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11348 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11349 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11353 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11355 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11356 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11357 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11358 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11359 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11360 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11362 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11364 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11365 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11366 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11367 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11370 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11371 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11372 .cindex "list" "item count"
11373 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11374 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11375 The part of the string after any leading change-of-separator is expanded,
11376 then the whole is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11379 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11380 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11381 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11382 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11383 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11384 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11385 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11386 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11387 matching list is returned.
11388 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11389 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11392 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11393 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11394 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11395 The string is interpreted as an
11396 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11397 address and the local part is extracted from it.
11398 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11399 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11402 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11403 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11404 .cindex "masked IP address"
11405 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11406 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11407 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11408 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11409 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11410 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11411 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11412 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11413 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11415 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11417 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11419 Since this operation is expected to
11420 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11423 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11424 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11426 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11430 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11432 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11433 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11434 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11437 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11439 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11440 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11441 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11442 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11443 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11445 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11446 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11449 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11450 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11451 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11452 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11453 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11454 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11456 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11458 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11461 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11462 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11463 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11464 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11465 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11466 is an empty string or
11467 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11468 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11469 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11470 respectively For example,
11478 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11479 variable or a message header.
11481 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11482 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11483 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11484 required to do so by the rules of
11485 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11486 for quoting local parts. For example,
11487 a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11488 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11489 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11491 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11492 will likely use the quoting form.
11493 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11496 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11497 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11498 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11499 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11500 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11502 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11508 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11509 yields an unchanged string.
11512 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11513 .cindex "random number"
11514 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11515 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11516 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11517 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11518 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11519 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11520 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11521 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11525 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11526 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11527 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11528 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11529 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11530 for DNS. For example,
11532 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11533 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11538 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11542 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11543 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11544 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11545 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11546 This operator encodes text according to the rules of
11547 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). This is an
11548 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11549 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11550 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11551 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11554 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11556 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11557 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11561 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11562 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11563 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11564 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11565 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per
11566 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
11568 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11569 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11570 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11572 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11573 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11574 to use this operator as well.
11578 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11579 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11580 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11581 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11582 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11583 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11584 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11587 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11588 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11589 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11590 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11591 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11592 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11593 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11595 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11596 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11599 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11600 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11601 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11602 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11603 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11604 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11605 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11606 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11607 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11608 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11610 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11612 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11613 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11615 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11616 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11617 Finally, if an underbar
11618 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11619 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11620 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11623 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11624 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11625 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11626 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11627 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11628 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11630 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11632 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11633 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11634 with 256 being the default.
11636 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11637 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11638 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11639 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11642 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11643 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11644 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11645 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11646 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11647 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11648 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11649 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11650 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11651 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11652 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11653 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11654 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11656 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11657 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11658 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11660 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11661 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11662 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11666 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11667 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11668 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11669 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11670 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11671 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11672 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11675 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11676 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11677 .cindex "substring extraction"
11678 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11679 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11680 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11681 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11683 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11685 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11686 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11687 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11689 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11690 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11691 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11692 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11695 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11696 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11697 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11698 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11699 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11700 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11703 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11704 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11705 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11706 .cindex "upper casing"
11707 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11708 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11709 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11710 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11712 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11713 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11714 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11715 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11716 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11717 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11718 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11719 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11720 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11721 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11722 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11723 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11724 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11725 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11727 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11729 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11730 literal question mark).
11732 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11733 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11734 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11735 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11736 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11737 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11739 .cindex internationalisation
11740 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11741 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11742 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11743 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11744 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11745 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11748 .vitem &*${xtextd:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11749 .cindex "text forcing in strings"
11750 .cindex "string" "xtext decoding"
11752 .cindex "&%xtextd%& expansion item"
11753 This performs xtext decoding of the string (per
11754 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
11765 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11766 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11767 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11768 while expanding strings:
11771 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11772 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11773 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11774 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11777 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11778 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11779 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11780 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11782 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11784 .irow "== " "equal"
11785 .irow "> " "greater"
11786 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11788 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11792 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11794 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11795 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11796 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11797 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11798 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11801 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11802 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11803 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11806 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11807 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11808 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11809 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11810 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11811 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11812 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11813 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11814 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11815 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11816 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11817 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11818 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11819 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11821 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11822 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11823 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11824 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11825 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11826 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11828 An empty string is treated as false.
11829 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11830 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11831 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11833 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11834 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11837 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11841 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11842 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11843 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11844 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11845 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11846 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11847 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11848 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11850 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11852 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11853 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11854 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11855 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11856 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11857 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11858 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11859 included in the binary.
11861 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11862 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11863 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11864 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11865 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11866 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11867 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11868 string in LDAP form is:
11870 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11872 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11873 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11875 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11877 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11882 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11883 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11884 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11885 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11886 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11887 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11891 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11892 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11893 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11894 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11895 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11896 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11899 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11900 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11901 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11902 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11903 whatever its length.
11906 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11907 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11908 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11909 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11911 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11912 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11913 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11914 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11915 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11916 support &[crypt16()]&.
11918 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11919 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11920 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11921 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11922 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11924 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11925 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11926 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11928 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11929 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11930 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11931 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11932 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11934 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11935 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11936 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11937 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11938 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11939 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11941 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11943 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11944 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11946 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11947 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11948 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11949 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11950 exists in the message. For example,
11952 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11954 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11955 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11957 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11958 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11959 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11960 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11961 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11962 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11963 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11964 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11965 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11966 case is defined per the system C locale.
11968 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11969 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11970 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11971 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11972 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11973 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11974 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11975 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11977 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11979 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11981 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11982 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11983 .cindex "first delivery"
11984 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11985 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11986 .cindex retry condition
11987 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11988 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11991 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11992 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11993 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11994 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11995 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11997 These conditions iterate over a list.
11999 The first argument, after any leading change-of-separator
12000 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
12001 is expanded and the whole forms the list.
12003 By default, the list separator is a colon.
12005 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
12006 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
12007 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
12009 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
12010 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
12011 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
12013 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
12014 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
12015 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
12017 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
12018 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
12019 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
12023 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
12025 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
12026 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
12028 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
12030 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12031 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12032 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12033 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
12034 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
12035 .cindex JSON expansions
12036 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
12037 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
12038 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
12039 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
12040 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
12042 The array separator is not changeable.
12043 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
12044 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
12048 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12049 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12050 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12051 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12052 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
12053 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
12054 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12055 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
12056 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
12058 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12060 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12061 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12062 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12063 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12064 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
12065 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
12066 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12067 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
12068 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
12070 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12073 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
12074 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
12077 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
12078 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
12079 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12080 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
12081 The <&'subject'&> string is expanded.
12083 The <&'list'&> first has any change-of-list-separator
12084 +(see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) retained verbatim,
12085 +then the remainder is expanded.
12087 The whole is treated as a list of simple strings;
12088 if the subject string is a member of that list, then the condition is true.
12089 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
12091 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
12092 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
12094 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
12095 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
12096 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
12097 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
12100 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12101 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12102 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12103 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
12104 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12106 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
12108 can be used for de-tainting.
12109 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12112 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12113 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12114 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
12115 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
12116 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
12117 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
12118 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
12119 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
12120 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
12121 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
12122 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
12124 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
12125 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
12126 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
12127 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
12128 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
12130 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
12131 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
12133 This is no longer the case.
12135 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
12136 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
12138 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
12140 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
12142 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
12143 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
12144 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
12145 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
12146 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
12147 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
12148 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
12149 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
12150 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
12151 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
12152 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
12153 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
12154 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
12158 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12159 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12160 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12161 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12162 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
12163 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
12164 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12165 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
12166 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
12168 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12170 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12171 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12172 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12173 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12174 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
12175 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
12176 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12177 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
12178 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
12180 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12183 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12184 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
12185 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
12186 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
12187 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
12188 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
12189 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
12190 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
12191 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
12192 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
12193 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
12196 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12198 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12199 backslashes is also required.
12201 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12202 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12203 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12204 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12205 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12206 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12207 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12208 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12210 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12211 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12212 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12213 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12214 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12215 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12216 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12217 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12219 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12220 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12221 See &*match_local_part*&.
12223 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12224 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12225 See &*match_local_part*&.
12227 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12228 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12229 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12230 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12231 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12232 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12234 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12236 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12239 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12241 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12243 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12244 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12245 in a single test such as
12246 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12247 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12248 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12249 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12251 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12253 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12255 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12257 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12258 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12259 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12260 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12261 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12262 masks. For example:
12264 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12266 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12267 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12268 address mask, for example:
12270 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12272 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12273 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12275 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12279 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12280 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12282 For the latter case, only the part after any leading
12283 change-of-separator specification is expanded.
12286 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12288 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12289 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12290 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12292 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12293 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12294 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12295 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12296 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12297 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12298 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12299 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12302 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12304 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12305 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12306 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12307 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12309 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12311 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12312 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12313 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items
12314 (including those of referenced named lists)
12315 to have their local parts matched casefully.
12316 Domains are always matched caselessly.
12318 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12319 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12320 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12321 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12322 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12324 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12326 can be used for de-tainting.
12327 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12329 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12330 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12332 For the latter case, only the part after any leading
12333 change-of-separator specification is expanded.
12336 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12337 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12338 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12339 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12341 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12342 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12343 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12344 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12345 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12346 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12347 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12348 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12349 available in Solaris
12350 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12351 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12352 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12356 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12357 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12359 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12360 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12361 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12362 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12363 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12364 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12365 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12367 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12368 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12370 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12371 For example, the configuration
12372 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12374 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12376 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12377 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12378 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12379 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12382 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12383 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12385 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12386 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12387 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12388 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12389 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12390 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12392 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12393 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12394 building Exim. For example:
12396 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12398 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12399 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12400 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12401 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12403 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12404 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12405 configuration, you might have this:
12407 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12409 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12411 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12413 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12414 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12415 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12416 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12417 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12418 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12421 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12423 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12424 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12425 Radius authentication
12426 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2865,RFC 2865))
12427 is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12428 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12429 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12432 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12433 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12434 this library, you need to set
12436 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12438 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12439 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12441 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12443 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12444 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12445 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12447 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12448 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12449 the authentication is successful. For example:
12451 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12455 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12456 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12457 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12459 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12460 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12461 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12462 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12463 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12464 by a process that is not running as root.
12466 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12467 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12468 building Exim. For example:
12470 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12472 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12473 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12474 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12476 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12477 two are mandatory. For example:
12479 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12481 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12482 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12483 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12488 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12489 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12490 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12491 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12492 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12493 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12494 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12498 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12499 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12500 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12501 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12502 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12505 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12507 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12508 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12509 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12511 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12512 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12513 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12514 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12515 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12516 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12517 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12518 parsed but not evaluated.
12520 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12525 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12526 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12527 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12528 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12529 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12530 .cindex "tainted data"
12531 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12532 a potential attacker.
12533 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12534 values are created.
12535 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12537 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12540 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12541 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12542 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12543 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12544 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12545 In the expansion condition case
12546 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12547 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12548 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12549 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12550 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12551 matching condition.
12552 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12554 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12555 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12556 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12557 any unused variables being made empty.
12559 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12560 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12561 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12562 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12563 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12564 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12565 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12566 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12567 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12568 during subsequent delivery.
12570 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12571 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12572 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12573 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12574 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12575 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12576 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12577 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12580 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12581 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12582 this variable has the number of arguments.
12584 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12585 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12586 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12587 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12588 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12590 warn !verify = sender
12591 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12593 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12594 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12596 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12598 .vitem &$address_data$&
12599 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12600 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12601 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12602 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12603 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12604 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12607 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12608 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12609 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12610 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12611 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12612 from the child's routing.
12614 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12615 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12616 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12619 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12620 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12621 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12623 .vitem &$address_file$&
12624 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12625 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12626 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12627 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12628 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12630 /home/r2d2/savemail
12632 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12633 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12634 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12635 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12636 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12637 to the relevant file.
12639 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12640 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12641 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12642 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12645 .vitem &$atrn_host$&
12646 .vindex ATRN "data for routing"
12647 When an ATRN command is accepted, this variable is filled in with the client
12648 IP and port, for use in a manualroute router.
12650 .vitem &$atrn_mode$&
12653 When in provider mode this variable will contain &"P"&.
12654 When in customer mode it will contain &"C"&.
12655 Otherwise, it will be empty.
12658 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12659 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12660 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12661 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12663 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12664 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12665 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12666 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12667 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12668 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12669 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12670 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12671 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12673 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12674 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12675 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12676 command line option.
12677 This second case also sets up information used by the
12678 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12680 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12681 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12682 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12683 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12684 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12685 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12686 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12687 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12688 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12692 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12693 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12694 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12695 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12696 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12697 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12698 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12699 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12700 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12701 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12703 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12704 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12705 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12706 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12707 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12710 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12711 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12712 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12713 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12714 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12715 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12716 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12717 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12718 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12719 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12720 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12721 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12723 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12724 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12725 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12726 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12727 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12728 the ACL malware condition.
12730 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12731 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12732 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12733 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12734 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12735 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12737 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12738 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12739 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12740 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12741 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12742 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12743 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12745 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12746 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12747 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12748 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12749 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12751 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12752 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12753 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12754 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12755 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12757 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12758 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12759 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12760 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12761 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12762 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12763 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12765 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12766 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12767 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12768 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12769 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12770 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12771 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12773 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12774 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12775 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12776 address that was connected to.
12778 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12779 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12780 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12781 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12782 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12784 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12785 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12786 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12787 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12788 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12789 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12791 .vitem &$config_file$&
12792 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12793 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12795 .vitem &$connection_id$&
12796 .vindex "&$connection_id$&"
12797 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
12798 An identifier for the accepted connection, for use in custom logging.
12800 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12801 Results of DKIM verification.
12802 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12804 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12805 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12806 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12807 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12808 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12810 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12811 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12812 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12813 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12814 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12815 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12816 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12817 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12818 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12819 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12820 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12821 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12822 &$dkim_key_length$&
12823 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12824 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12826 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12827 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12828 When a message has been received this variable contains
12829 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12830 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12832 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_spf$& &&&
12833 &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$& &&&
12834 &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12835 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12836 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12837 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12838 Results of DMARC verification.
12839 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12841 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12842 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12843 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12845 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12846 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12847 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12848 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12849 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12850 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12851 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12852 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12853 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12856 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12857 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12858 case for &$domain$&.
12860 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12861 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12862 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12863 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12865 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12866 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12867 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12868 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12869 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12870 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12872 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12873 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12874 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12876 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12879 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12880 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12881 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12882 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12883 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12884 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12885 the &(smtp)& transport.
12888 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12889 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12890 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12891 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12894 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12895 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12896 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12897 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12898 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12899 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12902 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12903 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12904 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12905 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12908 .cindex "tainted data"
12909 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12910 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12911 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12912 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12913 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12914 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12917 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12918 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12919 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12922 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12923 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12924 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12925 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12927 If the router routes the
12928 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12929 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12932 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12933 the rest of the ACL statement.
12935 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12936 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12937 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12939 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12940 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12941 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12943 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12944 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12945 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12947 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12948 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12949 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12950 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12951 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12952 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12953 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12955 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12957 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12958 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12959 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12960 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12961 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12963 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12964 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12965 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12966 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12967 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12971 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12972 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12973 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12974 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12975 by a setting on the transport itself.
12977 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12978 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12979 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12983 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12984 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12985 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12986 to local and remote transports.
12988 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12989 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12990 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12991 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12992 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12993 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12994 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12997 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12998 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12999 client is connected.
13002 .vitem &$host_address$&
13003 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
13004 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
13005 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
13006 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
13008 .vitem &$host_data$&
13009 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
13010 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
13011 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
13012 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
13014 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
13015 message = $host_data
13018 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13019 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
13020 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13021 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
13022 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
13023 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
13024 variables is set to &"1"&.
13027 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
13028 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13031 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
13032 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
13033 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
13036 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
13037 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
13038 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
13039 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
13040 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
13041 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
13042 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
13043 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
13044 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
13045 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
13047 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
13048 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
13049 &%authresults%& expansion item.
13052 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
13053 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13054 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
13056 .vitem &$host_port$&
13057 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
13058 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
13059 for an outbound connection.
13061 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
13062 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
13063 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
13064 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
13065 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
13066 to &$spool_directory$& later.
13069 .vindex "&$inode$&"
13070 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
13071 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
13072 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
13073 a unique name for the file.
13075 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
13077 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
13078 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
13079 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13083 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
13084 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
13085 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
13089 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
13090 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
13091 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
13094 .vitem &$load_average$&
13095 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
13096 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
13097 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
13098 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
13100 .tvar &$local_part$&
13101 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
13102 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
13103 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
13104 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
13106 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
13107 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
13108 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
13109 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
13112 .cindex "tainted data"
13113 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
13114 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
13115 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
13117 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
13119 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
13121 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
13122 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
13123 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
13124 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
13125 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
13126 rather than this variable.
13127 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
13128 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
13129 the retrieved data.
13131 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
13132 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
13133 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
13136 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
13137 local part of the recipient address.
13139 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
13140 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
13141 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
13143 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
13146 "abc:xyz"@test.example
13147 abc\:xyz@test.example
13149 the value of &$local_part$& is
13153 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
13154 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
13157 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
13159 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
13160 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
13161 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
13163 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
13164 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
13165 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
13166 matches a local part list
13167 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
13168 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
13169 applied to the data read by a lookup.
13170 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
13172 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
13174 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
13175 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
13176 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
13177 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
13178 .cindex affix variables
13179 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
13180 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
13181 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
13182 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
13183 .cindex "tainted data"
13184 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
13185 the affix variable value is not tainted.
13187 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
13188 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
13189 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
13190 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
13192 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
13193 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
13194 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
13195 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
13197 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
13198 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
13199 See &$local_user_uid$&.
13201 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
13202 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
13203 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
13204 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
13205 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
13206 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
13207 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
13208 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
13210 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
13211 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13212 This contains the expanded value of the
13213 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
13216 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
13217 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13218 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
13219 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
13220 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
13221 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
13223 .vitem &$log_space$&
13224 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13225 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
13226 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
13227 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
13228 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13229 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13232 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13233 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13234 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13235 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13236 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13237 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13238 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13239 and &"yes"& if it was.
13240 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13241 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13242 as authenticated data.
13244 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13245 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13246 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13247 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13248 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13249 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13250 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13253 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13254 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13255 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13256 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13257 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13259 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13260 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13261 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13262 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13263 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13264 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13266 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13268 .vitem &$message_age$&
13269 .cindex "message" "age of"
13270 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13271 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13272 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13275 .tvar &$message_body$&
13276 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13277 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13278 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13279 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13280 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13281 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13282 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13283 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13285 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13286 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13287 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13288 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13289 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13291 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13292 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13293 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13294 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13295 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13298 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13299 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13300 .cindex "message body" "size"
13301 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13302 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13303 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13304 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13305 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13307 If the spool file is wireformat
13308 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13309 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13311 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13312 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13313 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13314 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13315 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13316 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13317 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13318 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13320 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13321 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13322 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13323 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13324 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13326 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13327 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13328 contents of header lines is done.
13330 .vitem &$message_id$&
13331 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13333 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13334 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13335 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13336 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13337 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13338 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13339 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13340 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13341 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13342 from the body is not counted.
13344 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13345 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13346 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13347 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13348 header and the body).
13350 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13353 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13354 message = Too many lines in message header
13356 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13357 message has not yet been received.
13359 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13361 .vitem &$message_size$&
13362 .cindex "size" "of message"
13363 .cindex "message" "size"
13364 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13365 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13366 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13367 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13368 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13369 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13370 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13371 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13372 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13374 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13375 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13376 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13377 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13379 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13380 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13381 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13382 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13383 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13384 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13385 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13386 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13387 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13388 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13389 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13390 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13391 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13392 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13393 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13394 &$mime_part_count$&
13395 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13396 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13397 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13399 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13400 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13401 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13403 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13404 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13405 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13406 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13407 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13408 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13409 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13410 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13411 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13413 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13414 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13415 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13417 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13418 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13419 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13420 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13421 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13422 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13423 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13424 the original address.
13426 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13427 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13428 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13429 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13430 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13432 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13433 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13434 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13436 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13437 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13438 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13439 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13440 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13441 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13442 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13443 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13444 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13446 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13447 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13448 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13449 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13450 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13451 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13452 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13453 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13456 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13457 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13458 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13460 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13461 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13462 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13465 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13467 This variable contains the current process id.
13469 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13470 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13471 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13472 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13473 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13474 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13475 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13476 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13477 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13478 variable"& error if encountered.
13479 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13480 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13481 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13483 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13484 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13485 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13486 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13487 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13488 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13489 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13492 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13493 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13494 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13495 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13497 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13499 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13501 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13502 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13503 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13504 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13506 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13507 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13508 &$prvscheck_result$&
13509 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13510 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13511 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13513 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13514 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13515 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13517 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13518 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13519 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13520 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13522 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13523 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13524 .cindex "named queues" variable
13525 .cindex queues named
13526 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13528 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13529 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13530 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13531 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13532 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13533 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13534 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13539 .cindex router variables
13540 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13541 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13542 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13543 and the eventual transport.
13545 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13546 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13547 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13548 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13549 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13551 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13552 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13553 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13554 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13555 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13556 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13558 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13559 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13560 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13561 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13562 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13564 .vitem &$received_count$&
13565 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13566 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13567 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13568 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13571 .tvar &$received_for$&
13572 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13573 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13574 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13575 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13577 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13579 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13580 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13581 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13582 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13583 (The remote IP address and port are in
13584 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13585 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13588 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13589 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13590 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13591 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13592 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13594 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13596 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13597 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13598 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13599 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13600 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13601 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13602 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13603 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13604 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13606 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13607 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13608 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13609 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13610 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13611 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13613 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13614 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13615 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13617 .vitem &$received_time$&
13618 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13619 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13620 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13622 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13623 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13624 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13625 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13626 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13628 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13629 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13631 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13632 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13633 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13634 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13636 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13637 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13638 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13639 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13642 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13643 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13646 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13649 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13650 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13654 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13657 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13660 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13661 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13663 .tvar &$recipients$&
13664 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13665 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13667 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13668 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13669 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13671 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13673 However, the variables
13674 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13675 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13679 In a system filter file.
13681 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13682 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13683 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13684 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13686 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13690 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13691 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13692 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13693 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13694 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13695 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13698 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13699 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13700 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13701 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13703 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13704 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13705 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13706 these variables contain the
13707 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13708 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13711 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13712 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13713 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13714 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13715 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13716 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13718 .vitem &$return_path$&
13719 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13720 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13721 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13722 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13723 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13724 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13725 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13726 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13727 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13728 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13731 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13732 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13733 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13735 .vitem &$router_name$&
13736 .cindex "router" "name"
13737 .cindex "name" "of router"
13738 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13739 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13740 this variable contains the router name.
13743 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13744 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13745 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13746 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13747 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13748 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13749 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13752 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13753 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13754 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13755 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13756 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13757 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13758 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13759 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13761 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13762 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13763 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13764 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13765 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13767 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13768 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13769 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13770 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13771 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13772 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13773 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13774 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13776 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13777 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13779 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13780 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13782 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13783 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13784 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13785 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13786 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13789 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13790 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13792 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13793 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13794 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13795 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13797 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13798 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13799 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13800 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13801 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13802 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13803 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13804 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13805 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13806 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13807 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13808 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13809 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13811 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13812 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13813 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13814 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13815 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13817 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13818 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13819 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13820 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13821 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13823 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13824 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13825 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13826 this variable contains that
13827 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13829 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13830 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13831 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13832 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13833 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13834 &$authenticated_id$&.
13836 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13837 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13838 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13839 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13840 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13841 resolver library states that both
13842 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13843 other times, this variable is false.
13845 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13846 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13847 library, by setting:
13852 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13853 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13854 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13855 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13856 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13857 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13862 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13863 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13865 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13866 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13868 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13869 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13870 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13871 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13874 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13875 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13876 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13877 other means, this variable is empty.
13879 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13880 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13881 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13882 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13883 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13884 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13885 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13887 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13888 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13889 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13890 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13892 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13893 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13894 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13897 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13898 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13899 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13900 following are true:
13903 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13905 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13906 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13907 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13909 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13910 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13911 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13913 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13914 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13915 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13917 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13918 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13919 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13920 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13922 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13924 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13925 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13929 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13930 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13931 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13932 number that was used on the remote host.
13934 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13935 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13936 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13937 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13938 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13941 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13942 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13943 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13944 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13946 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13947 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13948 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13949 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13950 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13951 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13952 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13953 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13954 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13955 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13956 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13959 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13960 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13961 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13962 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13963 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13965 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13966 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13967 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13968 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13969 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13971 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13972 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13973 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13974 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13975 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13976 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13977 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13979 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13980 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13981 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13982 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13983 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13985 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13986 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13987 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13988 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13989 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13990 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13992 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13993 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13994 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13995 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
14000 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
14001 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
14002 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
14003 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
14005 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
14006 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
14007 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
14008 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
14009 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
14010 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
14012 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
14013 .cindex SMTP "command history"
14014 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
14015 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
14016 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
14019 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
14020 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
14021 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
14022 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
14023 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
14024 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
14025 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
14026 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
14027 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
14028 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
14029 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
14031 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
14032 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
14033 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
14034 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
14036 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
14037 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
14038 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
14039 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
14040 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
14041 message is junk mail.
14043 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
14044 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
14046 &$spam_report$& &&&
14048 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
14049 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
14050 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
14052 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
14053 &$spf_received$& &&&
14055 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
14056 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
14057 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
14058 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
14060 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
14061 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
14062 The name of Exim's spool directory.
14064 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
14065 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14066 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
14067 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
14068 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
14069 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
14071 .vitem &$spool_space$&
14072 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14073 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
14074 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
14075 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
14076 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
14077 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
14078 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
14080 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
14082 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
14085 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
14086 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
14087 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
14088 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
14089 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
14090 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
14092 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
14093 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
14094 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
14095 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
14096 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
14097 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
14098 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
14099 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
14101 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
14102 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14105 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
14106 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
14107 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
14108 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
14109 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
14110 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
14112 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
14113 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
14114 .cindex certificate variables
14115 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
14116 inbound connection when the message was received.
14117 It is only useful as the argument of a
14118 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14119 or a &%def%& condition.
14121 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
14122 when a list of more than one
14123 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
14124 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
14126 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
14127 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
14128 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14129 inbound connection when the message was received.
14130 It is only useful as the argument of a
14131 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14132 or a &%def%& condition.
14133 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14134 which is not the leaf.
14136 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
14137 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
14138 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
14139 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14140 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14141 or a &%def%& condition.
14143 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
14144 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
14145 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14146 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14147 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14148 or a &%def%& condition.
14149 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14150 which is not the leaf.
14152 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
14153 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
14154 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
14155 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
14157 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
14158 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14161 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
14162 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
14163 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
14164 outbound SMTP connection was made,
14165 and &"0"& otherwise.
14167 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
14168 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14169 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
14170 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14171 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
14172 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
14173 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
14174 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
14175 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
14177 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
14178 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
14179 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
14181 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
14182 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
14183 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14185 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
14186 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
14188 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
14189 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
14190 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
14191 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
14193 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
14194 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
14195 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14197 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
14198 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
14199 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14201 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
14202 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
14203 When a message is received from a remote client connection
14204 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
14206 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
14207 1 No response to request
14208 2 Response not verified
14209 3 Verification failed
14210 4 Verification succeeded
14213 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
14214 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
14215 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
14216 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
14217 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
14219 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
14220 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
14221 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
14222 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
14223 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14224 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
14225 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14226 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14227 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14228 which is not the leaf.
14230 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14231 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14234 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14235 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14236 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14237 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14238 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14239 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14240 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14241 which is not the leaf.
14244 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14245 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14246 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14247 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14248 .cindex TLS resumption
14249 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14252 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14253 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14254 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14256 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14257 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14258 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14259 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14260 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14261 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14262 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14263 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14265 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14266 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14269 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14270 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14271 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14273 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14275 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14278 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14279 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14280 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14282 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14283 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14284 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14285 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14287 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14288 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14289 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14290 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14293 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14294 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14295 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14296 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14298 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14299 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14300 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14302 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14303 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14304 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14306 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14307 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14308 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14309 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14310 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14311 values for those that are behind (west).
14314 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14315 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14316 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14318 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14319 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14320 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14321 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14324 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14325 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14326 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14329 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14330 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14331 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14332 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14334 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14335 .cindex "transport" "name"
14336 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14337 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14338 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14341 .vindex "&$value$&"
14342 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14343 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14344 &*reduce*& expansion.
14346 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14347 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14348 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14349 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14352 .vitem &$version_number$&
14353 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14354 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14355 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14357 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14358 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14359 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14360 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14362 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14363 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14364 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14365 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14371 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14372 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14374 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14375 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14376 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14377 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14378 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14379 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14384 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14387 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14388 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14389 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14390 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14391 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14392 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14393 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14394 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14395 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14397 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14398 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14399 should usually be something like
14401 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14403 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14404 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14405 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14406 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14407 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14408 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14409 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14410 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14414 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14415 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14416 a startup when Exim is entered.
14418 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14419 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14422 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14423 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14426 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14427 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14428 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14429 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14430 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14431 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14434 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14437 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14438 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14439 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14440 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14444 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14445 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14447 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14448 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14449 with an error message of the form
14451 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14453 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14454 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14455 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14456 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14457 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14458 that was passed to &%die%&.
14461 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14462 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14463 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14466 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14468 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14469 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14470 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14472 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14473 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14474 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14475 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14477 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14478 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14479 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14480 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14481 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14482 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14483 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14486 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14487 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14488 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14489 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14490 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14491 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14492 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14493 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14494 avoided, but the output is lost.
14496 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14497 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14498 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14499 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14500 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14501 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14502 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14504 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14506 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14507 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14508 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14509 as the first subroutine argument.
14513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14516 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14517 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14518 "Starting the daemon"
14519 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14520 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14521 .cindex "network interface"
14522 .cindex "interface" "network"
14523 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14524 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14525 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14526 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14527 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14528 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14529 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14530 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14531 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14532 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14533 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14536 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14537 and ports to listen on.
14539 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14540 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14541 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14542 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14543 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14544 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14545 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14546 as an error situation.
14548 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14549 for the outgoing connection.
14553 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14554 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14555 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14556 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14557 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14559 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14560 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14561 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14562 chapter describes how they operate.
14564 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14565 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14569 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14570 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14571 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14575 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14577 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14579 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14580 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14583 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14584 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14585 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14586 colons. For example:
14588 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14591 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14593 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14594 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14597 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14598 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14600 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14601 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14604 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14605 with a colon separator, for example:
14607 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14608 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14612 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14613 default setting contains just one port:
14615 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14617 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14618 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14619 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14620 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14621 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14625 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14626 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14627 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14628 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14629 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14630 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14632 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14634 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14636 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14638 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14642 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14643 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14644 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14645 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14646 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14647 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14650 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14651 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14652 If there are any items that do not
14653 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14654 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14655 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14656 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14660 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14663 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14665 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14666 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14667 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14671 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14672 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14673 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14674 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14675 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14676 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14677 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14678 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14679 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14680 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14681 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14682 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14683 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14686 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14687 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14688 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14690 The common use of this option is expected to be
14692 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14694 per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314).
14695 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14696 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14698 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14699 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14700 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14701 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14702 connections via the daemon.)
14707 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14708 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14709 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14710 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14711 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14712 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14713 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14714 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14716 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14718 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14719 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14720 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14721 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14722 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14723 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14725 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14727 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14728 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14729 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14730 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14731 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14733 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14734 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14735 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14736 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14737 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14738 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14739 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14740 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14741 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14742 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14743 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14744 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14746 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14747 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14748 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14749 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14750 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14754 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14755 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14757 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14758 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14760 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14761 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14762 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14763 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14765 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14767 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14769 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14771 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14772 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14774 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14775 IPv4 loopback address only:
14777 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14779 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14781 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14783 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14787 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14788 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14789 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14790 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14793 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14794 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14795 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14796 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14798 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14799 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14800 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14801 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14802 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14803 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14804 used for listening. Consider this example:
14806 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14808 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14810 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14812 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14813 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14816 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14817 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14818 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14819 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14820 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14821 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14822 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14823 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14827 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14828 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14829 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14830 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14831 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14832 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14839 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14841 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14842 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14843 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14844 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14847 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14848 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14850 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14851 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14852 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14854 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14855 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14856 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14857 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14861 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14862 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14863 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14864 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14865 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14866 listed in more than one group.
14868 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14870 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14871 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14872 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14873 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14874 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14875 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14876 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14877 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14878 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14879 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14880 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14881 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14882 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14886 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14888 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14889 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14890 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14891 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14892 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14893 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14898 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14900 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14901 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14902 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14903 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14904 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14905 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14906 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14907 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14908 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14909 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14910 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14911 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14916 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14918 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14919 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14920 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14921 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14922 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14923 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14924 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14925 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14926 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14927 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14928 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14929 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14930 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14931 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14932 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14933 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14938 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14940 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14941 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14942 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14943 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14948 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14950 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14951 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14952 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14953 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14954 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14955 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14956 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14957 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14958 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14959 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14960 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14961 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14962 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14963 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14964 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14969 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14971 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14972 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14977 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14979 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14980 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14981 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14986 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14988 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14989 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14990 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14991 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14992 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14993 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14994 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14995 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14996 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
15001 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
15003 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
15004 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
15005 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
15006 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
15007 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
15008 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
15009 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15010 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
15011 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15012 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15013 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15014 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15015 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15016 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15017 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15018 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15020 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15021 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15022 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15023 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
15024 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15029 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
15031 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
15032 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
15033 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
15034 .row &%acl_smtp_atrn%& "ACL for ATRN"
15035 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
15036 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
15037 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
15038 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
15039 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
15040 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
15041 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
15042 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
15043 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
15044 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
15045 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
15046 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
15047 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
15048 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
15049 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
15050 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
15051 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
15052 .row &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
15053 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
15054 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15056 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
15057 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
15058 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
15059 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
15060 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
15061 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
15062 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
15063 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
15064 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
15065 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
15066 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
15067 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
15068 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
15069 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
15070 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
15071 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
15072 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
15073 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
15074 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
15075 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
15076 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
15077 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
15082 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
15084 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
15086 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
15088 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
15089 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
15090 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
15095 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
15097 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
15098 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
15099 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
15100 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
15101 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
15102 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15103 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
15104 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
15105 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
15106 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
15107 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
15108 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
15109 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
15110 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
15111 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
15112 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
15113 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
15114 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
15115 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
15116 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
15121 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
15123 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
15124 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
15125 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
15126 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
15127 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
15128 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
15129 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
15130 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
15135 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
15137 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
15138 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
15139 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
15140 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
15141 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
15142 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
15143 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
15144 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
15150 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
15152 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
15159 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
15160 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
15163 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
15164 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
15165 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
15166 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
15167 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
15168 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
15169 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
15170 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
15171 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
15172 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
15173 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
15174 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
15175 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
15176 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
15177 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15178 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15179 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15180 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15181 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15182 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15183 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15185 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15186 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
15187 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
15188 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15189 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15190 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
15191 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
15192 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
15193 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
15194 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
15195 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
15196 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
15197 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
15198 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
15199 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15200 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15205 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
15207 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
15208 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
15209 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
15210 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
15211 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
15212 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
15213 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
15214 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15215 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15216 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
15217 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
15218 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15219 .row &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%& "advertise WELLKNOWN to these hosts"
15224 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
15226 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
15227 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
15228 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
15229 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15231 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15232 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15233 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15234 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15235 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15236 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15237 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15238 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15239 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15240 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15245 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15247 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15248 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15250 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15251 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15252 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15253 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15254 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15259 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15261 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15262 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15263 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15264 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15265 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15266 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15267 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15268 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15269 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15270 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15271 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15272 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15273 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15274 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15275 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15276 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15277 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15278 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15279 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15280 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15281 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15282 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15283 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15284 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15285 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15290 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15292 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15293 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15294 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15295 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15296 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15297 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15298 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15299 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15300 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15301 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15302 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15303 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15304 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15305 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15306 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15311 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15312 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15315 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15317 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15318 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15319 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15320 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15321 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15322 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15323 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15324 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15326 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15327 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15328 It now defaults to true.
15329 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15331 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15334 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15336 log_selector = +8bitmime
15339 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15340 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15341 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15342 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15343 read and is on the point of being accepted. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for
15346 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15347 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15348 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15351 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15352 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15353 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15354 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15355 non-SMTP message. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for further details.
15358 .option acl_smtp_atrn main string&!! unset
15359 .cindex ATRN "ACL for"
15360 .cindex ATRN advertisement
15361 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ATRN
15362 .cindex ODMR provider
15363 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ATRN command is
15365 If no value is set, or the result after expansion is an empty string,
15366 then the ATRN facility is not advertised.
15367 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs,
15368 and section &<<SECTODMRPRDVR>>& for description of ATRN.
15371 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15372 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15373 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15374 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15376 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15377 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15379 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15380 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15381 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15382 See section &<<SECconnectACL>>& for further details.
15384 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15385 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15386 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15387 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15388 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECdataACLS>>& for further details.
15390 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15391 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15392 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15393 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15394 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15395 This option defines the ACL that,
15396 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15397 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15398 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15399 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>& for further details.
15401 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15402 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15403 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15404 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15405 of a received message.
15406 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15408 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15409 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15410 .cindex "ETRN" advertisement
15411 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15413 If no value is set then the ETRN facility is not advertised.
15414 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs,
15415 and section &<<SECTETRN>>& for description of ETRN.
15417 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15418 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15419 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15420 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15422 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15423 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15424 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15425 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15426 command is received. See section &<<SECheloACL>>& for further details.
15429 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15430 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15431 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15432 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15434 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15435 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15436 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15438 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15439 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15441 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15442 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15443 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15444 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15445 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15447 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15448 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15449 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15450 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15451 See section &<<SECTNOTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15453 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15454 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15455 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15458 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15459 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15460 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15461 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15463 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15464 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15465 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15466 received. See section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15468 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15469 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15470 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15471 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15473 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15474 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15475 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15476 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15478 .option acl_smtp_wellknown main string&!! unset
15479 .cindex "WELLKNOWN, ACL for"
15480 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP WELLKNOWN command is
15481 received. See section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>& for further details.
15483 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15484 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15485 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15486 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15487 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15489 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15491 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15492 .cindex "admin user"
15493 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15494 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15495 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15496 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15497 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15498 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15499 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15501 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15502 .cindex "domain literal"
15503 If this option is set, the
15504 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
15505 domain literal format is permitted in
15506 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15507 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15508 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15510 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15511 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15512 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15513 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15514 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15515 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15516 the local host's IP addresses.
15518 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15519 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15520 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15521 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15522 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15523 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15524 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15525 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15526 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15528 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15529 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15530 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15531 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15532 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15533 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15534 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15536 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15537 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15538 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15540 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15541 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15542 this option can be left as default.
15544 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15545 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15546 suitable setting is:
15548 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15549 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15551 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15553 dns_check_names_pattern =
15555 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15558 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15559 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15560 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15561 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15562 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15563 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15564 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15565 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15566 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15567 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15568 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15569 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15571 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15572 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15573 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15574 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15575 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15576 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15578 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15579 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15580 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15581 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15583 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15585 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15586 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15587 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15588 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15591 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15592 .cindex "thawing messages"
15593 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15594 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15595 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15596 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15597 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15598 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15600 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15601 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15602 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15605 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15606 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15607 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15609 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15611 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15612 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15615 .option bi_command main string unset
15617 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15618 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15619 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15620 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15623 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15624 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15625 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15626 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15627 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15628 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15629 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15630 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15631 absolute and untainted.
15632 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15635 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15636 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15637 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15638 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15640 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15641 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15642 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15643 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15644 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15645 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15646 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15647 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15648 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15649 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15651 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15652 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15653 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15654 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15655 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15656 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15657 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15658 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15659 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15660 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15662 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15663 during reception of a message.
15664 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15666 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15669 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15670 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15671 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15672 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15675 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15676 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15677 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15678 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15679 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15680 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15681 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15682 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15683 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15685 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15686 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15687 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15688 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15689 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15692 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15693 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15694 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15695 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15696 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15697 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15698 connection. A typical setting might be:
15700 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15702 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15704 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15706 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15709 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15710 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15711 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15712 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15713 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15714 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15717 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15718 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15719 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15720 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15723 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15724 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15725 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15726 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15729 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15730 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15731 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15732 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15735 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15736 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15737 callout verification. The default value is
15739 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15741 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15744 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15745 check_log_space main integer 10M
15746 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15748 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15749 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15750 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15751 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047)
15752 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15753 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15754 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15755 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15756 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15757 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15758 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15761 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15762 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15763 .cindex "checking disk space"
15764 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15765 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15766 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15767 message is accepted.
15769 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15770 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15771 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15772 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15773 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15774 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15775 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15776 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15779 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15780 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15782 check_spool_space = 100M
15783 check_spool_inodes = 100
15785 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15786 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15789 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15790 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15791 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15793 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15794 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15795 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15796 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15797 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15798 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15800 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15801 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15802 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15804 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15805 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15806 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15808 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15809 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15810 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15811 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15813 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15814 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15815 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15816 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15817 The CHUNKING extension
15818 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3030.html,RFC 3030))
15819 will be advertised in the EHLO message to these hosts.
15820 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15822 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15823 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15824 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15825 administrative user.
15826 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15828 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15829 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15830 .cindex memory debugging
15831 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15832 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15833 it should normally be left as default.
15835 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15836 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15837 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15838 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15839 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15840 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15842 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15843 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15844 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15845 These options control the retrying done by
15846 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15847 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15848 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15849 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15851 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15852 .cindex "warning of delay"
15853 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15854 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15855 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15856 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15857 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15858 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15859 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15860 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15863 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15865 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15866 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15867 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15868 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15872 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15873 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15875 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15877 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15878 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15879 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15881 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15882 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15883 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15884 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15885 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15886 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15887 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15888 not sent. The default is:
15890 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15891 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15892 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15893 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15896 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15897 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15898 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15899 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15901 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15902 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15903 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15904 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15905 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15906 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15907 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15908 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15910 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15911 .cindex "load average"
15912 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15913 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15914 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15915 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15916 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15919 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15920 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15921 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15922 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15923 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15924 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15925 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15926 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15928 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15929 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15930 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15931 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15932 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15933 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15934 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15935 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15937 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15938 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15939 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15940 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15943 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15944 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15945 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15946 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15947 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15948 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15949 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15952 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15953 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15954 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15955 and an order of processing.
15956 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15958 Acceptable values include:
15965 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates
15966 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301).
15968 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15969 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15970 and an order of processing.
15971 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15974 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15975 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15976 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15977 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15979 The default enforces the
15980 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
15981 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15983 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15984 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15987 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15988 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15989 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15990 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15991 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15992 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15995 .options dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
15996 dmarc_history_file main string unset &&&
15997 dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15998 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15999 These options control DMARC processing.
16000 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
16003 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
16004 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
16005 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
16006 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
16007 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
16008 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
16009 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
16010 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
16011 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
16012 by a setting such as this:
16014 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
16016 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
16017 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
16018 is security-relevant).
16019 It also applies when the
16020 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
16021 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
16022 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
16023 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
16024 options are applied after this global option.
16026 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
16027 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
16028 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
16029 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
16030 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
16031 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
16032 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
16033 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
16034 value of this option. The default pattern is
16036 dns_check_names_pattern = \
16037 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
16039 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
16040 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
16041 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
16042 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
16043 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
16046 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
16047 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
16048 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
16050 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
16051 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
16052 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
16053 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
16055 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
16056 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
16057 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
16058 not do it internally.
16059 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
16060 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
16062 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
16063 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
16064 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
16067 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
16068 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16069 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16070 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
16071 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
16072 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
16074 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
16076 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
16077 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
16078 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
16079 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
16080 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
16081 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
16087 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
16088 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
16089 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
16090 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
16091 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
16092 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
16093 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
16094 domain matches this list.
16096 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
16097 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
16098 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
16099 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
16100 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
16101 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
16104 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
16105 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16106 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
16107 .cindex "DNS" timeout
16108 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
16109 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
16110 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
16111 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
16112 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
16113 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
16114 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
16115 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
16117 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
16120 .option dns_retry main integer 0
16121 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
16124 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
16125 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16126 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16127 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
16128 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
16129 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
16130 match with this expanded domain list.
16132 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
16133 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
16134 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
16135 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
16136 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
16137 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
16139 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
16140 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
16141 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
16143 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
16144 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
16145 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
16146 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
16147 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
16149 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16150 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
16151 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16152 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
16153 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
16154 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
16155 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
16156 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
16159 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
16161 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
16162 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
16163 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
16166 .option drop_cr main boolean false
16167 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
16168 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
16169 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
16171 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16172 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
16173 .cindex "DSN" "success"
16174 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
16175 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
16176 DSN extensions (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461))
16177 will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
16178 and accepted from, these hosts.
16179 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
16180 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
16181 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
16182 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
16184 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
16185 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
16187 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
16188 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
16189 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
16190 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
16191 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
16192 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
16194 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
16196 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
16197 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
16199 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
16200 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
16201 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
16202 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
16203 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
16204 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
16205 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
16206 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
16207 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
16210 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
16211 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
16212 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
16213 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
16214 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
16215 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
16216 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
16217 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
16218 must be enclosed in double quotes.
16220 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
16221 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
16222 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
16223 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
16224 are examined. For example:
16226 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
16227 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
16228 postmaster@mydomain.example
16230 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16231 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16232 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
16233 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
16234 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
16235 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
16236 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
16239 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
16240 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
16241 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
16243 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
16245 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
16246 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
16247 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
16248 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
16249 overrides the default.
16251 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
16252 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
16253 and warning messages. For example:
16255 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
16257 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid
16258 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
16259 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
16260 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
16261 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
16265 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16267 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16268 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16271 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16272 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16273 .cindex "Exim group"
16274 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16275 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16276 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16277 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16278 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16282 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16283 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16284 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16285 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16286 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16287 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16289 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16290 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16291 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16292 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16295 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16296 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16297 .cindex "Exim user"
16298 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16299 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16300 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16301 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16303 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16304 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16305 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16306 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16309 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16310 .cindex "Exim version"
16311 .cindex customizing "version number"
16312 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16313 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16314 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16317 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16318 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16319 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16320 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16323 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16324 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16326 . .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments"
16327 . but apparently this results in searchability problems; bug 1197
16329 .option extract_addresses_remove_arguments main boolean true
16331 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16332 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16333 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16334 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16335 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16336 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16337 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16338 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16339 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16340 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16344 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16345 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16346 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16347 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16348 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16349 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16350 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16351 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16354 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16355 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16356 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16357 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16361 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16362 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16363 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16364 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16365 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16366 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16367 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16368 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16369 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16370 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16371 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16372 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16373 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16374 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16375 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16376 logging that you require.
16379 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16380 gecos_pattern main string unset
16382 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16383 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16384 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16385 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16386 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16387 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16388 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16389 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16391 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16392 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16393 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16396 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16397 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16398 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16399 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16401 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16406 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16407 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16408 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16409 implementations of TLS.
16412 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16413 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16414 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16417 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16422 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16423 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16424 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16425 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16426 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16427 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16431 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16432 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16433 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16434 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16435 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16436 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16437 sections are rejected.
16440 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16441 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16442 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16443 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16444 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16445 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16446 zero means &"no limit"&.
16451 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16452 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16453 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16454 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16455 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16456 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16457 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16458 if you want to do semantic checking.
16459 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16463 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16464 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16465 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16466 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16467 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16468 non-ip-literal EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16469 hyphens, and dots. For example if you really must allow underscores,
16472 helo_allow_chars = _
16474 This option does not apply to names that look like ip-literals.
16475 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16478 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16479 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16480 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16481 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16482 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16483 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16484 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16488 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16489 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16490 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16491 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16492 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16493 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16494 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16495 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16496 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16497 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16498 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16499 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16501 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16502 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16503 EHLO command either:
16506 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16508 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16509 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16510 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16511 calling host address, or
16513 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16516 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16517 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16518 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16520 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16521 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16522 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16524 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16525 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16526 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16527 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16528 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16529 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16530 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16531 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16532 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16535 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16536 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16537 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16538 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16539 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16540 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16541 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16542 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16543 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16545 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16546 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16547 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16548 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16549 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16551 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16552 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16553 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16554 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16557 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16558 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16559 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16560 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16561 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16562 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16563 default configuration file contains
16567 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16568 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16570 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16571 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16572 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16574 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16575 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16576 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16577 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16578 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16579 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16582 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16583 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16584 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16585 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16586 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16589 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16590 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16591 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16592 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16596 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16597 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16598 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16599 as soon as the connection is made.
16600 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16601 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16602 connections immediately.
16604 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16605 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16607 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16608 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16609 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16610 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16611 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16614 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16615 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16616 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16617 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16618 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16619 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16620 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16621 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16622 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16624 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16626 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16627 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16630 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16631 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16633 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16634 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16635 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16636 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16637 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16639 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16640 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16643 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16644 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16645 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16646 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16649 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16650 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16651 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16652 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16655 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16656 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16657 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16658 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16659 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16661 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16662 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16664 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16665 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16666 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16667 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16668 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16669 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16670 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16673 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16674 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16675 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16676 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16677 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16681 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16682 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16683 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16684 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16685 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16686 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16688 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16689 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16690 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16691 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16692 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16693 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16694 for frozen messages. For example,
16696 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16698 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16699 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16700 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16701 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16702 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16703 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16706 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16707 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16708 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16709 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16710 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16711 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16712 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16713 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16714 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16715 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16716 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16720 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16721 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16722 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16723 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16724 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16725 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16726 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16727 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16728 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16730 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16731 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16733 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16734 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16735 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16736 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16738 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16739 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16740 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16743 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16744 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16745 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16749 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16750 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16751 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16752 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16756 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16757 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16758 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16759 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16760 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16761 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16762 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16763 and constrained to be a directory.
16766 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16767 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16768 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16769 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16770 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16771 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16772 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16773 and constrained to be a file.
16776 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16777 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16778 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16779 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16780 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16781 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16784 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16785 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16786 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16787 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16788 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16789 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16790 identity to be proven.
16793 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16794 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16795 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16796 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16797 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16800 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16801 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16802 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16803 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16804 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16808 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16809 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16810 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16811 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16812 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16813 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16817 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16818 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16819 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16820 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16821 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16823 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16824 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16825 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16828 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16829 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16830 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16831 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16832 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16833 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16834 has been built with LDAP support.
16838 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16839 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16840 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16841 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16842 LIMITS extension (&url(https://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc9422.html,RFC 9422))
16844 If permitted, Exim as a server will advertise in the EHLO response
16845 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16846 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16849 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16850 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16851 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16852 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16853 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16854 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16855 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16857 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16858 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16859 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16861 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16862 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16863 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16864 and the default qualify domain.
16866 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16867 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16868 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16869 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16871 .cindex "envelope from"
16872 .cindex "envelope sender"
16873 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16874 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16875 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16877 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16878 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16879 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16884 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16885 local_from_suffix main string unset
16886 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16887 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16888 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16889 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16890 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16891 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16894 local_from_prefix = *-
16896 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16898 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16900 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16901 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16905 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16906 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16907 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16908 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16909 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16910 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16911 &%local_interfaces%& is
16913 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16915 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16917 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16920 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16921 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16922 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16923 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16924 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16925 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16926 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16927 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16931 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16932 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16933 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16934 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16935 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16936 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16937 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16938 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16943 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16944 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16945 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16946 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16947 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16948 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16949 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16950 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16951 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16952 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16953 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16954 each host must set a different
16955 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16956 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16957 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16958 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16959 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16960 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16961 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16962 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16963 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16967 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16968 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16969 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16970 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16971 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16972 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16973 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16974 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16975 A path must start with a slash.
16976 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16977 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16978 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16979 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16980 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16981 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16982 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16983 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16986 .option log_selector main string unset
16987 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16988 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16989 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16990 minus characters. For example:
16992 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16994 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16995 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16998 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16999 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
17000 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
17001 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
17002 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
17003 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
17004 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
17005 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
17006 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
17007 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
17008 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
17009 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
17010 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
17013 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
17014 .cindex "too many open files"
17015 .cindex "open files, too many"
17016 .cindex "file" "too many open"
17017 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
17018 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
17019 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
17020 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
17021 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
17022 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
17023 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
17024 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
17025 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
17026 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
17027 &%lookup_open_max%&.
17030 .option max_username_length main integer 0
17031 .cindex "length of login name"
17032 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
17033 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
17034 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
17035 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
17036 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
17037 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
17040 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
17041 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
17042 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
17043 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
17044 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
17045 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
17046 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
17047 option is set true, this no longer happens.
17050 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
17051 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
17052 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
17053 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
17054 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
17055 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
17056 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
17059 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
17060 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
17061 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
17062 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
17063 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
17064 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
17065 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
17066 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
17067 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
17068 empty string, the option is ignored.
17071 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
17072 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
17073 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
17074 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by
17075 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17076 to take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
17077 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
17078 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
17079 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
17080 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
17081 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
17082 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
17083 colons will become hyphens.
17086 .option message_logs main boolean true
17087 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
17088 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
17089 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
17090 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
17091 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
17092 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
17093 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
17094 which is not affected by this option.
17097 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
17098 .cindex "message" "size limit"
17099 .cindex "limit" "message size"
17100 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
17101 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
17102 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
17103 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
17104 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
17105 optionally followed by K or M.
17107 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
17108 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
17109 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
17110 service extension keyword.
17112 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
17113 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
17114 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
17115 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
17116 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17118 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
17119 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
17120 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
17121 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
17122 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
17123 message that an individual transport can process.
17125 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
17126 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
17127 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
17128 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
17129 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
17130 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
17131 some problems may result.
17133 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
17134 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
17135 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
17138 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
17139 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
17140 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
17142 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
17144 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
17145 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
17146 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
17147 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
17148 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
17151 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
17152 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
17153 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
17154 contains a full description of this facility.
17158 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
17159 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
17160 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
17161 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
17162 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
17165 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
17166 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
17167 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
17168 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
17169 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
17172 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
17173 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
17174 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
17175 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
17176 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
17178 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
17179 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
17182 never_users = root:daemon:bin
17184 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
17185 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
17189 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
17190 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
17191 listens for work and information-requests.
17192 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
17193 should need to modify the default.
17195 The option is expanded before use.
17196 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
17197 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
17199 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
17202 If this option is set as empty,
17203 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
17204 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
17205 then a notifier socket is not created.
17208 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
17209 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
17210 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
17211 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
17212 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
17214 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
17215 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
17216 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
17217 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
17218 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
17219 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
17220 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
17222 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
17223 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
17224 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
17225 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
17226 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
17228 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
17230 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
17231 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
17232 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
17233 some now infamous attacks.
17237 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
17238 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
17239 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
17241 # Disable older protocol versions:
17242 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
17245 Possible options may include:
17249 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
17251 &`cipher_server_preference`&
17253 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
17257 &`legacy_server_connect`&
17259 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
17261 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
17263 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
17265 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
17267 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17271 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17285 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17289 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17291 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17293 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17295 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17299 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17302 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17303 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17304 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17305 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17306 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17307 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17310 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17311 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17312 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17313 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17314 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17317 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17318 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17319 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17320 to terminate the process
17321 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17322 then a coredump is requested.
17324 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17325 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17326 common installed configuration.
17328 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17329 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17330 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17331 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17332 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17333 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17334 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17336 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17337 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17338 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17339 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17342 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17343 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17344 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17345 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17346 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17347 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17348 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17351 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17352 perl_startup main string unset
17354 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17355 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17357 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17359 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17362 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17363 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17364 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17365 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17366 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17367 PostgreSQL support.
17370 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17371 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17372 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17373 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17374 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17377 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17379 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17381 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17382 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17383 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17386 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17387 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17388 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17389 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17390 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17391 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17392 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17393 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17394 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17395 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17397 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17398 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17399 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17400 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17401 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17402 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17403 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17404 commands are acceptable.
17405 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17407 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17409 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17410 it permits the client to pipeline
17411 TCP connection and hello command (cleatext phase),
17412 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17413 on later connections to the same host.
17416 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17417 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17418 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17419 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17420 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17421 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17422 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17423 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17424 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17426 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17427 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17428 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17429 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17430 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17431 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17432 volume of mail. Use with care!
17435 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17436 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17437 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17438 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17439 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17440 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17441 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17442 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17443 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17444 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17446 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17447 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17448 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17449 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17450 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17451 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17454 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17455 .cindex "printing characters"
17456 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17457 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17458 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17459 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17460 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17461 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17464 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17465 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses
17466 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) encoding of
17467 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17468 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17469 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17473 .option process_log_path main string unset
17474 .cindex "process log path"
17475 .cindex "log" "process log"
17476 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17477 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17478 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17479 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17480 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17481 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17482 different spool directories.
17485 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17486 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17490 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17491 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17492 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17495 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17496 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17497 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17498 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17501 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17502 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17503 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17504 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17505 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17506 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17507 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17508 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17509 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17511 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17512 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17513 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17514 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17515 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17516 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17517 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17520 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17521 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17522 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17526 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17527 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17528 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17529 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17530 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17531 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17532 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17533 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17536 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17537 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17538 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17539 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17540 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17541 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17542 routed for a single host.
17545 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17546 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17548 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17549 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17550 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17551 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17554 .option queue_only main boolean false
17555 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17556 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17557 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17558 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17559 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17560 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17562 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17563 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17564 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17565 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17568 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17569 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17570 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17571 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17572 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17573 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17574 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17575 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17576 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17578 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17580 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17581 &_/some/file_& exists.
17584 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17585 .cindex "load average"
17586 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17587 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17588 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17589 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17590 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17591 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17592 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17595 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17596 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17597 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17598 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17601 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17602 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17603 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17604 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17605 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17606 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17607 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17608 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17609 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17610 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17611 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17612 re-evaluated for each message.
17615 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17616 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17617 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17618 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17619 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17620 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17623 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17624 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17625 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17626 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17627 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17628 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17629 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17630 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17631 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17632 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17633 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17634 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17635 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17639 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17640 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17641 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17642 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17643 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17644 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17645 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17646 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17647 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17649 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17650 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17651 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17652 the daemon's command line.
17654 .cindex queues named
17655 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17656 To set limits for different named queues use
17657 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17659 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17660 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17661 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17662 .cindex "first pass routing"
17663 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17664 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17665 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17666 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17667 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17668 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17669 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17670 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17671 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17672 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17676 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17677 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17678 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17679 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17680 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17681 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17682 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17684 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17685 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17686 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17687 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17688 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17689 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17690 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17691 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17692 &"Received:"& and conform to the
17693 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17694 specification for &'Received:'& header lines.
17695 The default setting is:
17698 received_header_text = Received: \
17699 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17700 {${if def:sender_ident \
17701 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17702 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17703 by $primary_hostname \
17704 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17705 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17706 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17707 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17708 ${if def:sender_address \
17709 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17710 id $message_exim_id\
17711 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17714 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17715 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17716 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17717 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17718 header lines such as the following:
17720 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17721 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17722 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17723 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17724 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17725 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17726 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17728 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17729 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17730 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17731 message was accepted.
17734 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17735 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17736 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17737 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17738 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17739 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17740 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17741 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17744 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17745 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17746 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17747 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17748 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17749 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17750 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17751 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17752 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17753 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17754 option was not set.
17757 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17758 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17759 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17760 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17761 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17762 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17763 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17764 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17765 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17768 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17769 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17770 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17771 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17772 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17775 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17776 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17777 RCPT commands in a single message.
17780 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17781 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17782 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17783 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17784 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17785 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17786 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17789 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17790 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17791 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17792 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17793 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17794 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17795 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17796 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17797 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17798 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17799 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17800 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17801 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17802 tagged with its process id.
17804 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17805 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17806 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17807 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17810 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17811 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17813 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17814 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17815 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17816 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17817 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17818 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17819 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17820 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17821 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17822 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17823 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17825 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17826 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17827 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17828 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17831 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17832 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17833 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17834 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17835 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17837 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17839 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17840 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17843 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17844 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17845 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17846 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17847 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17851 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17852 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17853 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17854 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17855 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17856 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17857 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17861 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17862 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17863 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821), section 4.4,
17864 states that an SMTP server must insert a
17865 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17866 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17867 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17868 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17869 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17870 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17871 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17874 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17875 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17878 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17880 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17881 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17882 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17883 an item in the list.
17884 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17887 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17888 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17889 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17890 This sets the timeout on
17891 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17892 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17893 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17896 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17897 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17898 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17899 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17900 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17901 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17902 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17903 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17904 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17905 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17908 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17909 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17910 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17911 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17912 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17913 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17914 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17918 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17919 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17920 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17921 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17922 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17923 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17924 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17925 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17926 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17927 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17928 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17932 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17933 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17934 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17936 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17937 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17938 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17939 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17940 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17941 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17943 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17944 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17945 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17946 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17949 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17950 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17951 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17952 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17953 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17954 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17955 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17956 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17958 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17959 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17960 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17961 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17962 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17963 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17964 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17965 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17968 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17969 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17970 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17971 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17975 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17976 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17977 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17978 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17979 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17980 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17981 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17982 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17983 . the option name to split.
17985 .option smtp_accept_max_per_connection main integer&!! 1000
17986 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17987 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17988 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17989 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17990 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17991 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17992 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17994 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17995 and may depend on values available at that time.
17996 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17999 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
18000 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
18001 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
18002 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
18003 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
18004 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
18005 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
18006 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
18007 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
18008 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
18009 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
18011 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
18012 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
18013 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
18014 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
18015 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
18016 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
18020 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
18021 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
18022 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
18023 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
18024 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
18025 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
18026 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
18027 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
18028 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
18029 to all messages received in the same connection.
18031 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
18032 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
18033 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
18034 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
18037 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
18039 .option smtp_accept_queue_per_connection main integer 10
18040 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
18041 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
18042 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
18043 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
18044 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
18045 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
18046 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
18047 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
18048 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
18049 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
18050 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
18053 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
18054 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
18055 .cindex "host" "reserved"
18056 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
18057 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
18058 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
18059 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
18060 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
18061 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
18062 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
18063 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
18066 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
18067 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
18068 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
18069 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
18072 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
18073 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
18074 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
18075 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
18076 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
18077 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
18078 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
18079 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
18080 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
18082 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
18083 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
18084 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
18085 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
18087 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
18088 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
18089 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
18090 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
18091 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
18094 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
18095 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
18098 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
18099 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
18100 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
18101 &%helo_data%& value.
18103 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
18104 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
18105 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
18106 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
18107 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
18108 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
18109 This facility is only available on Linux.
18111 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
18112 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
18113 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
18114 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
18115 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
18116 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
18117 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
18118 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
18120 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
18121 $version_number $tod_full
18123 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
18124 a forced fail just closes the connection.
18125 If you want to create a
18126 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
18127 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
18128 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
18129 multiline response).
18132 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
18133 .cindex "checking disk space"
18134 .cindex "disk space, checking"
18135 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
18136 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
18137 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
18138 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
18139 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
18140 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
18143 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
18144 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
18145 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
18146 .cindex "backlog of connections"
18147 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
18148 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
18149 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
18150 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
18151 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
18152 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
18153 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
18154 attacks by SYN flooding.
18157 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
18158 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
18159 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
18160 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
18161 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
18162 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
18163 fewer, but they still exist.
18165 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
18166 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
18167 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
18168 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
18169 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
18170 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
18171 does detect many instances.
18173 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
18174 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
18175 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
18176 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
18180 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
18181 .cindex ETRN "command to be run"
18182 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
18183 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18184 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
18185 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
18186 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
18187 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
18188 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
18191 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
18192 $sender_host_address
18194 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
18195 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
18196 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
18197 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
18199 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
18200 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
18201 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
18202 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
18203 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
18207 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
18208 .cindex ETRN serializing
18209 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
18210 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
18211 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
18214 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
18215 .cindex "load average"
18216 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
18217 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
18218 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
18219 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
18220 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
18221 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
18225 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
18226 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
18227 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
18228 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
18229 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
18231 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
18233 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
18234 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
18235 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
18236 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
18237 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
18239 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
18240 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
18241 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
18242 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
18243 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
18244 not count towards the limit.
18248 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
18249 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
18250 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
18251 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
18252 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
18255 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
18256 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
18260 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
18261 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
18262 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
18263 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
18264 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
18265 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
18266 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
18267 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
18270 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
18271 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
18272 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
18273 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18275 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18276 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18277 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18278 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18282 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18284 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18285 fractional parts are allowed here.
18287 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18289 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18290 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18293 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18294 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18296 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18297 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18299 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18300 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18301 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18302 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18306 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18307 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18308 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18309 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18310 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18311 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18312 the message is abandoned.
18313 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18315 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18316 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18318 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18319 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18321 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18322 expanded before use and may depend on
18323 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18327 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18328 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18329 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18330 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18331 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18334 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18335 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18336 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18339 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18340 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18341 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18342 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18343 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18344 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18345 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18346 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18347 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18348 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18350 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18351 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18355 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18356 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18357 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18358 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18359 the availability thereof is advertised in
18360 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18361 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18364 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18365 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18366 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18367 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18371 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18372 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18373 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18375 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18376 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18377 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18378 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18379 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18380 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18381 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18382 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18386 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18388 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18390 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18392 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18394 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18396 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18398 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18400 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18402 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18404 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18406 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18408 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18409 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18412 A note on using Exim variables: As
18413 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18414 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18417 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18418 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18419 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18420 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18421 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18422 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18423 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18424 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18425 arrival of the message.
18427 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18428 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18429 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18430 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18431 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18433 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18434 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18435 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18436 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18437 automatically deleted.
18439 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18440 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18441 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18442 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18443 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18444 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18445 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18446 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18447 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18450 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18451 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18452 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18453 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18454 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18455 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18456 &$primary_hostname$&.
18458 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18459 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18460 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18461 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18462 as failures in the configuration file.
18464 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18465 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18467 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18468 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18469 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18470 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18471 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18472 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18475 The following variables will not have useful values:
18477 $max_received_linelength
18482 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18483 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18484 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18485 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18487 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18488 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18489 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18491 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18492 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18493 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18494 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18496 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18497 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18498 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18499 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18500 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18501 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18503 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18504 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18505 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18506 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18507 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18508 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18509 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18512 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18513 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18514 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18515 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18516 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18517 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18518 domain causes a syntax error.
18519 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18523 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18524 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18525 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18526 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18527 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18528 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18529 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18530 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18531 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18532 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18533 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18534 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18537 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18538 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18539 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18540 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18541 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18542 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18543 details of Exim's logging.
18546 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18547 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18548 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18549 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18550 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18551 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18552 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18556 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18557 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18558 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18559 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18560 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18564 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18565 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18566 .cindex timestamps syslog
18567 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18568 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18569 details of Exim's logging.
18572 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18573 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18574 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18575 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18576 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18577 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18578 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18579 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18580 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18581 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18582 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18583 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18586 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18587 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18588 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18589 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18590 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18591 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18594 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18595 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18596 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18597 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18598 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18600 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18601 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18602 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18603 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18604 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18606 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18607 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18608 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18609 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18610 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18611 contains the pipe command.
18614 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18615 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18616 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18617 is used in a system filter.
18620 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18621 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18622 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18623 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18624 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18625 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18626 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18627 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18628 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18629 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18631 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18632 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18633 transport option overrides.
18636 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18637 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18638 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18639 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18640 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18641 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18642 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18643 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18644 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18645 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18646 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18647 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18651 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18652 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18653 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18654 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18655 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18656 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18657 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18658 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18659 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18660 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18662 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18663 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18664 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18667 .option timezone main string unset
18668 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18669 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18670 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18671 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18672 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18673 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18677 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18678 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18679 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18680 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18681 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18682 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18685 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18686 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18687 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18688 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18689 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18690 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18691 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18692 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18693 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18694 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18695 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18696 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18699 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18700 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18702 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18703 If this option is set,
18704 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18705 and the client offers either more than one
18706 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18707 the TLS connection is declined.
18710 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18711 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18712 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18713 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18714 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18715 Commonly only one file is needed.
18716 The server's private key is also
18717 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18718 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18720 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18721 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18722 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18723 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18725 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18726 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18728 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18729 when a list of more than one
18730 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18731 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18733 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18734 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18735 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18736 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18737 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18739 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18741 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18742 generated fresh for every connection.
18744 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18745 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18746 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18747 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18748 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18750 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18752 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18753 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18754 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18756 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18759 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18760 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18761 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18762 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18763 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18764 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18766 The value must be at least 1024.
18768 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18769 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18770 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18772 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18775 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18776 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18777 larger prime than requested.
18780 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18781 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18782 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18783 to be used by Exim.
18785 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18786 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18787 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18788 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18790 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18791 then it names a file from which DH
18792 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18793 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18794 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18795 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18796 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18797 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18799 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18802 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18803 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18804 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18805 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18807 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18808 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18810 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18811 2.2 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18812 "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18813 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18815 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18816 of DH primes specified in
18817 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2409,RFC 2409),
18818 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3526,RFC 3526),
18819 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18820 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919), or from other
18821 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18822 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18823 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18825 The available standard primes are:
18826 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18827 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18828 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18829 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18831 The available additional primes are:
18832 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18834 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18835 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18836 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18837 of the later IKE values, which led into
18838 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919)
18839 providing new fixed constants (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18841 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18842 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18843 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18844 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by
18845 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8247,RFC 8247)
18846 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18848 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18849 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18850 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18851 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18853 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18854 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18855 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18856 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18857 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18860 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18861 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18862 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18863 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18864 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18865 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18866 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18869 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18870 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18871 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18872 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18873 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18874 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18876 After expansion it must contain
18877 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18878 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18879 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18881 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18882 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18883 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18885 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18888 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18889 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18890 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18892 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18893 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18894 Certificate Authority.
18896 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18897 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18899 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18900 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18901 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18902 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18903 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18905 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18906 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18908 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18909 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18910 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18911 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18912 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18913 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18914 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18916 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18917 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18918 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18919 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18921 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18924 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18925 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18926 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18927 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18931 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18932 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18933 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18934 files which contains the server's private keys.
18935 If this option is unset, or if
18936 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18937 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18938 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18940 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18943 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18944 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18945 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18946 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18947 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18948 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18952 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18953 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18954 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18955 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18956 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18957 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18958 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18959 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18960 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18961 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18962 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18965 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18966 .cindex TLS resumption
18967 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18968 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18971 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18972 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18973 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18974 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18977 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18978 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18979 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18980 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18982 or the absolute path to
18983 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18984 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18986 The "system" value for the option will use a
18987 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18988 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18989 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18992 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18993 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18995 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18997 either by file or directory
18998 are added to those given by the system default location.
19000 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
19001 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
19002 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
19003 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
19004 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
19005 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
19006 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
19007 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
19009 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
19011 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
19015 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
19016 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
19017 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
19018 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
19019 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
19020 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
19021 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
19022 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
19024 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
19025 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
19026 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
19028 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
19029 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
19030 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
19031 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
19033 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
19034 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
19035 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
19036 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
19037 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
19038 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
19039 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
19042 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
19046 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
19047 .cindex "trusted groups"
19048 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
19049 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
19050 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
19051 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
19052 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
19053 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
19054 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
19057 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
19058 .cindex "trusted users"
19059 .cindex "user" "trusted"
19060 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
19061 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
19062 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
19063 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
19064 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
19065 Exim user are trusted.
19067 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
19068 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
19069 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
19070 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
19071 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
19072 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
19073 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
19074 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
19075 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
19078 .option unknown_username main string unset
19079 See &%unknown_login%&.
19081 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
19082 .cindex "trusted users"
19083 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
19084 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
19085 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
19086 .cindex "envelope from"
19087 .cindex "envelope sender"
19088 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
19089 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
19090 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
19091 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
19092 is used) is ignored.
19094 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
19095 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
19097 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
19099 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
19100 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
19101 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
19102 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
19103 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
19104 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
19105 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
19106 followed by a hyphen
19107 by a setting like this:
19109 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
19111 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
19112 restriction, you can use
19114 untrusted_set_sender = *
19116 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
19117 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
19118 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
19119 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
19120 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
19121 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
19122 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
19123 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
19125 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
19126 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
19127 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
19128 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
19132 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
19133 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19134 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
19135 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
19136 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
19137 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
19138 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
19139 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
19140 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
19141 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
19143 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
19144 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
19146 The pattern can be seen by running
19148 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
19150 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
19151 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
19152 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
19153 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
19154 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
19155 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
19158 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
19159 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
19162 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
19163 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
19164 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
19165 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
19166 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
19167 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
19168 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
19169 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
19170 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
19171 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
19172 absolute and untainted.
19173 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
19176 .option wellknown_advertise_hosts main boolean unset
19177 .cindex WELLKNOWN advertisement
19178 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" WELLKNOWN
19179 This option enables the advertising of the SMTP WELLKNOWN extension.
19180 See also the &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL (&<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&).
19182 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
19183 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
19184 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
19185 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
19186 .ecindex IIDconfima
19187 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
19192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19193 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19195 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
19196 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
19197 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
19198 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
19199 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
19201 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
19202 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
19203 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
19204 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
19205 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
19207 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
19208 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
19212 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
19213 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
19214 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
19215 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
19216 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
19217 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
19218 delivery of the address to be deferred.
19220 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19221 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
19222 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
19223 routers, and the eventual transport.
19225 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
19226 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
19227 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
19228 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
19229 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
19231 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
19232 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
19233 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
19234 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
19235 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
19237 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
19238 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
19239 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
19241 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
19243 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
19245 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
19247 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
19248 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
19250 See also the &%set%& option below.
19252 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
19253 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19254 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
19255 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
19256 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
19257 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
19258 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
19262 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
19264 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
19265 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
19266 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
19267 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
19268 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
19273 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
19274 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
19275 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
19276 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
19277 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
19278 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
19279 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
19280 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
19281 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
19282 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
19285 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
19287 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19290 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19292 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19293 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19294 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19295 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19298 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19299 .cindex "case of local parts"
19300 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19301 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19302 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19303 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19304 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19305 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19306 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19309 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19310 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19311 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19312 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19313 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19314 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19315 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19316 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19317 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19319 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19320 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19321 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19322 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19326 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19327 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19328 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19329 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19331 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19332 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19333 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19334 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19335 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19337 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19338 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19339 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19340 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19341 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19342 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19343 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19344 the router is skipped.
19346 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19347 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19348 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19349 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19350 setting to achieve this. For example:
19352 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19354 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19355 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19356 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19360 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19361 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19362 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19363 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19364 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19365 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19366 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19367 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19369 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19370 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19372 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19373 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19375 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19376 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19377 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19379 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19381 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19383 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19386 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19388 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19389 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19393 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19394 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19395 be specified using &%condition%&.
19397 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19398 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19399 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19400 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19401 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19402 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19403 Router rules processing behavior.
19405 This is best illustrated in an example:
19407 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19408 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19410 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19413 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19416 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19417 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19418 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19419 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19420 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19421 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19422 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19423 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19425 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19426 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19427 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19428 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19431 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19432 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19433 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19434 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19435 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19438 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19439 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19440 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19441 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19442 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19443 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19444 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19445 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19446 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19447 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19448 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19449 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19450 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19451 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19455 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19456 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19457 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19458 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19459 transport option of the same name.
19461 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19462 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19463 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19464 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19465 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19466 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19467 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19468 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19470 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19471 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19472 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19473 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19474 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19475 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19476 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19477 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19478 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19481 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19482 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19483 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19484 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19486 The data returned by the list check
19487 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19488 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19489 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19490 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19492 A complex example, using a file like:
19498 and checking both domain and local_part
19500 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19501 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19506 .option driver routers string unset
19507 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19511 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19512 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19513 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19514 If this option is set true, and extended DSN
19515 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461)) processing is in effect,
19516 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19517 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19518 Not effective on redirect routers.
19522 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19523 .cindex "envelope from"
19524 .cindex "envelope sender"
19525 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19526 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19527 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19528 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19529 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19530 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19531 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19533 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19534 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19535 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19538 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19539 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19540 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19541 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19543 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19544 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19545 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19546 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19552 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19553 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19554 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19555 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19556 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19558 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19559 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19560 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19561 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19562 setting &%return_path%&.
19564 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19565 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19566 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19570 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19571 .cindex "address" "testing"
19572 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19573 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19574 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19575 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19576 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19577 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19578 on for the system alias file.
19579 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19582 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19583 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19584 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19588 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19589 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19590 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19591 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19595 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19596 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19597 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19601 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19602 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19603 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19607 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19608 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19609 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19610 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19611 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19612 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19613 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19614 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19615 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19617 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19618 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19619 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19620 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19621 transport for further details.
19624 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19625 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19626 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19627 .cindex "transport" "local"
19628 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19629 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19630 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19632 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19633 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19634 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19635 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19636 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19640 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19641 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19642 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19643 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19644 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19645 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19646 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19647 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19648 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19649 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19650 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19651 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19652 &"see"& the added header lines.
19654 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19655 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19656 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19657 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19659 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19660 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19662 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19663 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19665 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19666 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19667 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19668 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19669 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19670 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19671 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19672 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19673 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19674 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19678 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19679 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19680 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19681 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19682 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19683 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19684 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19685 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19686 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19688 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19689 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19690 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19691 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19692 &"see"& the original header lines.
19694 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19695 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19696 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19699 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19700 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19702 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19703 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19705 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19706 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19707 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19708 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19710 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19711 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19712 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19716 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19717 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19718 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19719 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19720 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19721 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19722 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19725 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19729 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19731 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19732 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19733 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19734 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19735 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19736 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19738 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19739 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19741 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19742 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19744 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19745 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19747 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19748 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19749 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19750 domain that is being routed.
19752 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19753 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19756 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19757 .cindex "additional groups"
19758 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19759 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19760 .cindex "transport" "local"
19761 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19762 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19763 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19764 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19765 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19769 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19770 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19771 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19772 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19773 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19774 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19775 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19778 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19779 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19780 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19781 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19782 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19783 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19784 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19785 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19786 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19788 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19789 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19790 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19791 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19792 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19793 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19794 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19795 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19796 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19797 the relevant transport.
19799 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19800 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19801 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19803 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19804 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19805 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19808 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19809 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19810 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19811 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19812 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19816 local_part_prefix = real-
19818 transport = local_delivery
19820 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19821 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19823 condition = ${if match_ip {$sender_host_address} \
19824 {<; ; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1}}
19827 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19828 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19829 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19830 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19833 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19834 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19838 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19839 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19840 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19841 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19842 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19843 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19844 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19845 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19846 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19850 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19851 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19855 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19856 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19857 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19858 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19859 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19861 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19862 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19865 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19867 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19868 the data returned by the list check
19869 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19870 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19871 You might use this option, for
19872 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19873 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19874 each virtual domain:
19878 local_parts = postmaster
19879 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19883 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19884 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19885 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19886 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19887 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19888 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19889 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19890 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19891 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19892 redirect addresses.
19896 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19897 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19898 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19899 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19900 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19901 delivery to be deferred.
19903 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19904 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19906 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19907 means of the setting
19911 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19912 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19913 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19915 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19916 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19917 controls what happens next.
19920 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19921 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19922 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19923 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19924 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19925 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19926 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19927 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19929 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19930 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19931 applies to all of them.
19935 .option pass_router routers string unset
19936 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19937 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19938 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19939 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19940 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19941 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19942 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19943 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19944 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19945 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19949 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19950 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19951 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19952 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19953 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19954 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19956 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19957 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19958 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19959 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19963 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19964 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19965 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19966 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19967 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19968 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19969 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19971 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19972 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19973 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19974 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19975 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19977 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19978 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19979 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19980 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19981 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19984 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19985 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19988 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19989 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19990 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19991 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19992 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19993 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19994 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19995 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19997 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19998 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19999 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
20000 operates as follows:
20002 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
20003 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
20004 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
20005 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
20008 require_files = mail:/some/file
20009 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
20011 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
20012 &%require_files%& condition fails.
20014 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
20015 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
20016 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
20017 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
20019 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
20020 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
20021 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
20022 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
20023 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
20025 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
20026 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
20027 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
20028 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
20029 check again in that process.
20031 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
20032 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
20033 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
20034 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
20035 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
20036 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
20037 as if the file did not exist. For example:
20039 require_files = +/some/file
20041 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
20042 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
20043 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
20047 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
20048 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20049 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
20050 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
20051 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
20052 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
20053 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
20054 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
20057 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
20058 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
20059 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
20060 &%check_local_user%&,
20063 &%local_part_prefix%&,
20064 &%local_part_suffix%&,
20067 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
20068 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
20071 Failing to set this option when it is needed
20072 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
20073 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
20075 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
20076 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
20077 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
20081 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
20082 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
20083 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
20085 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
20086 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
20087 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
20088 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
20089 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
20090 cause the router to defer.
20092 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
20093 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
20095 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20097 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
20098 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
20100 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
20101 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
20102 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
20103 of these values that is set:
20106 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20108 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20110 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20112 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20115 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
20116 router, but not for the transport.
20120 .option self routers string freeze
20121 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20122 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20123 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
20124 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
20125 and &(manualroute)& routers.
20126 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
20128 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
20129 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
20130 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
20131 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
20132 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20134 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
20135 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
20136 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
20137 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
20138 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
20143 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
20145 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
20146 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
20147 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
20148 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
20150 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
20151 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
20152 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
20157 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
20158 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
20159 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
20160 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
20161 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
20162 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
20168 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
20169 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
20170 be passed to the next router.
20173 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
20176 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
20177 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
20178 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
20179 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
20180 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
20181 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
20186 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
20187 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
20188 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
20189 address matches something on the list.
20190 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20193 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
20194 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
20195 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
20196 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
20197 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
20198 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
20199 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
20203 .option set routers "string list" unset
20204 .cindex router variables
20205 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
20206 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
20207 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
20210 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
20211 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
20212 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
20213 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
20214 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
20216 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
20217 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
20218 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
20219 The variables can be used by the router options
20220 (not including any preconditions)
20221 and by the transport.
20222 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
20223 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
20225 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
20226 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
20229 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
20230 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
20231 .cindex "packet radio"
20232 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
20233 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
20234 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
20235 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
20236 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
20237 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
20238 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
20239 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20241 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20242 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
20243 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
20244 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
20245 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
20246 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
20247 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
20248 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
20249 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
20250 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
20252 translate_ip_address = \
20253 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
20256 The file would contain lines like
20258 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
20259 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
20261 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
20266 .option transport routers string&!! unset
20267 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
20268 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
20269 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
20270 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
20271 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
20272 delivery is deferred.
20274 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
20275 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
20276 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
20280 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
20281 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20282 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
20283 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
20284 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
20285 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
20286 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
20287 overridden by a setting on the transport.
20288 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20289 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20290 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20296 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20297 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20298 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20299 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20300 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20301 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20302 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20303 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20304 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20305 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20307 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20308 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20309 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20310 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20311 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20313 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20319 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20320 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20321 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20322 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20323 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20324 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20325 delivery to be deferred.
20327 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20328 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20329 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20330 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20331 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20332 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20334 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20335 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20336 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20337 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20338 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20339 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20340 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20341 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20343 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20344 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20345 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20346 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20347 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20348 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20349 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20350 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20351 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20352 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20354 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20355 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20356 subsequent routers.
20359 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20360 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20361 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20362 .cindex "transport" "local"
20363 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20364 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20365 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20366 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20367 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20368 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20369 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20370 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20371 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20372 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20373 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20374 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20378 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20379 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20380 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20383 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20384 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20386 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20387 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20388 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20389 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20390 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20391 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20392 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20394 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20395 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20396 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20400 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20401 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20403 delivering in cutthrough mode
20404 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20405 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20407 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20410 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20411 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20412 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20413 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20415 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20416 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20417 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20424 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20425 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20427 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20428 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20429 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20430 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20431 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20432 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20433 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20434 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20435 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20439 domains = mydomain.example
20441 transport = local_delivery
20443 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20444 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20445 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20446 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20453 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20454 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20456 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20457 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20458 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20459 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20460 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20461 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20463 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20464 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20465 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20466 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20469 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20470 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20471 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20472 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20473 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20474 generic option, the router declines.
20476 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20477 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20478 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20480 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20481 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20482 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20483 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20484 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20485 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20488 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20489 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20490 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20491 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20492 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20493 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20495 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20496 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20497 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20498 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20499 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20500 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20501 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20502 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20503 case routing fails.
20506 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20507 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20508 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20509 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20510 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20512 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20513 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20515 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20517 The domain does not exist in DNS
20519 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20520 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20521 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20523 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20525 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20527 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20528 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20530 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20531 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20533 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20534 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20536 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20537 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20543 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20544 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20545 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20547 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20548 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20549 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20550 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20551 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20552 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20553 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20556 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20557 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20558 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records
20559 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2782,RFC 2782))
20560 in addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20561 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20562 required. For example,
20566 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20567 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20568 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20569 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20570 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20573 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20574 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20575 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20576 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20577 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20578 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20580 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20581 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20582 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20583 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20584 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20585 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20586 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20587 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20589 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20590 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20595 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20596 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20597 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20598 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20599 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20600 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20601 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20602 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20606 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20607 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20608 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20609 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20610 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20611 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20612 only A records are used.
20614 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20615 .cindex IPv4 preference
20616 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20617 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20618 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20619 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20620 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20622 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20623 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20624 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20625 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20626 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20627 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20628 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20631 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20633 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20634 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20635 the address record.
20638 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20639 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20640 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20641 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20646 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20647 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20648 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20649 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20650 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20651 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20652 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20653 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20654 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20659 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20660 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20661 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20662 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20663 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20664 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20665 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20666 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20667 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20668 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20669 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20671 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20672 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20675 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20676 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20677 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20678 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20679 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20683 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20684 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20685 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20686 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20687 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20688 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20689 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20690 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20692 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20693 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20694 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20695 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20696 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20697 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20698 without processing them independently,
20699 provided the following conditions are met:
20702 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20703 &%headers_remove%&.
20705 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20712 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20713 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20714 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20715 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20716 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20717 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20718 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20719 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20720 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20721 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20723 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20724 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20729 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20730 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20731 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20732 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20737 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20738 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20739 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20740 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20743 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20745 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20746 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20747 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20748 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20749 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20750 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20753 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20754 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20755 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20756 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20757 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20759 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20760 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20761 such as that implied by
20765 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20766 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20767 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20768 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20778 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20779 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20781 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20782 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20783 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20784 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20785 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20786 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20787 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20788 takes the form of an
20789 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
20790 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20791 router handles the address
20795 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20796 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20797 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20799 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20801 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20802 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20804 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20805 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20806 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20807 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20809 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20810 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20811 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20812 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20816 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20819 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20820 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20821 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20822 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20823 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20824 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20827 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20829 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20831 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20832 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20833 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20834 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20835 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20836 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20837 must not be specified for it.
20839 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20840 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20841 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20842 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20843 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20844 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20845 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20848 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20849 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20850 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20851 delivery to the address is deferred.
20854 .option port iplookup integer 0
20855 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20856 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20860 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20861 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20862 protocols is to be used.
20865 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20866 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20869 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20871 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20872 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20875 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20876 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20877 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20878 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20879 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20880 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20881 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20882 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20885 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20886 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20887 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20888 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20889 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20890 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20891 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20892 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20893 following could be used:
20895 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20896 reroute = $local_part@$1
20899 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20900 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20901 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20902 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20908 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20910 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20911 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20912 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20913 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20914 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20915 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20916 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20917 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20918 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20919 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20921 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20922 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20923 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20924 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20925 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20926 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20927 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20930 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20931 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20932 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20933 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20934 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20935 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20936 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20939 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20940 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20941 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20942 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20943 below, following the list of private options.
20946 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20948 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20949 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20951 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20952 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20954 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20955 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20956 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20957 of the following values:
20966 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20967 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20968 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20971 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20972 router only if &%more%& is true.
20974 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20975 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20976 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20977 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20979 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20980 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20981 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20984 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20985 .cindex "randomized host list"
20986 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20987 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20988 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20989 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20990 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20991 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20992 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20993 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20995 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20996 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20997 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20998 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21000 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21002 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21003 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21004 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
21005 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
21006 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
21009 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
21010 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
21011 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
21014 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
21016 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
21017 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
21021 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
21022 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
21023 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
21024 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
21027 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
21028 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
21029 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
21030 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
21031 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
21032 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
21033 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
21034 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
21036 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
21037 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
21038 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
21039 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
21040 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
21041 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
21042 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
21043 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
21048 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
21049 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
21050 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
21051 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
21052 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
21053 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
21055 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
21057 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
21061 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
21062 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
21064 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
21065 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
21066 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
21067 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
21068 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
21069 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
21070 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
21071 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
21072 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
21073 in a &%route_list%&).
21075 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
21076 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
21077 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
21078 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
21082 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
21083 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
21084 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
21085 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
21086 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
21087 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
21088 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
21091 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
21092 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
21094 This data can be accessed by setting
21096 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
21098 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
21099 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
21100 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
21101 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
21102 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
21107 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
21108 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
21109 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
21110 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
21111 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
21112 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
21113 The format of each item
21114 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
21115 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
21117 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
21118 variables are set during its expansion:
21121 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
21122 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
21123 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
21125 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
21128 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
21130 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
21133 .vindex "&$value$&"
21134 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
21135 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
21137 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
21141 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
21142 semicolon is the default route list separator.
21146 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
21147 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
21148 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
21149 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
21150 When no port is given, an IP address
21151 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
21152 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
21153 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
21156 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
21157 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
21158 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
21160 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
21161 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
21164 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
21165 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
21166 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
21167 number follows. For example:
21169 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
21173 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
21174 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
21175 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
21176 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
21177 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
21180 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
21181 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
21182 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
21183 records in the DNS. For example:
21185 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
21187 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
21190 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
21192 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
21193 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
21194 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
21195 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
21196 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
21197 happens is controlled by the
21198 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
21199 &%self%& option of the router.
21201 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
21202 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
21203 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
21204 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
21205 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
21206 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
21207 defined by MX preferences.
21209 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
21210 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
21211 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
21213 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
21214 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
21215 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
21216 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
21218 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
21219 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
21222 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
21223 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
21224 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
21226 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
21227 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
21231 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
21232 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
21233 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
21234 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
21235 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
21236 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
21237 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
21240 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
21241 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21243 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
21244 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21246 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
21247 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
21248 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
21250 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
21251 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
21252 timeout), delivery is deferred.
21254 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
21256 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
21261 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
21262 domain2 host4:host5
21264 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
21265 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
21266 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
21267 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
21270 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
21271 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
21272 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
21273 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
21276 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
21277 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
21282 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
21283 &%host_find_failed%& option.
21286 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
21287 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
21291 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21292 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21293 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21296 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21297 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21298 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21299 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21301 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21303 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21304 your first router something like this:
21307 driver = manualroute
21308 domains = !+local_domains
21309 transport = remote_smtp
21310 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21312 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21313 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21314 they are tried in order
21315 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21316 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21319 driver = manualroute
21320 transport = remote_smtp
21321 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21323 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21324 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21325 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21326 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21327 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21328 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21329 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21330 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21333 .cindex "mail hub example"
21334 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21335 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21336 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21337 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21338 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21339 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21340 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21341 lookup is easier to manage.
21343 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21344 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21348 driver = manualroute
21349 transport = remote_smtp
21350 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21352 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21353 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21354 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21355 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21356 domain can be used to find the host:
21359 driver = manualroute
21360 transport = remote_smtp
21361 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21363 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21364 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21365 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21369 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21370 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21371 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21372 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21373 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21374 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21377 driver = manualroute
21378 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21379 route_list = saved.domain.example
21381 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21382 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21383 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21386 driver = manualroute
21388 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21389 *.saved.domain2.example \
21390 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21393 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21395 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21396 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21397 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21398 the address if the lookup fails.
21401 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21402 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21403 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21404 one way it can be done:
21410 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21411 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21412 return_fail_output = true
21417 driver = manualroute
21419 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21421 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21423 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21425 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21426 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21427 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21429 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21430 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21439 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21442 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21443 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21444 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21445 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21446 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21447 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21448 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21449 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21450 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21451 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21453 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21455 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21456 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21457 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21458 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21459 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21462 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21463 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21464 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21465 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21466 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21467 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21470 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21471 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21472 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21473 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21474 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21475 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21476 not set, a value for the gid also.
21478 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21479 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21480 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21481 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21482 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21483 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21487 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21488 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21489 before running the command.
21492 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21493 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21494 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21498 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21499 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21500 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21501 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21502 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21505 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21508 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21509 &%no_more%& is set.
21511 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21512 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21513 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21514 included in the SMTP response.
21516 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21517 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21518 included in any SMTP response.
21520 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21522 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21523 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21525 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21526 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21527 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21530 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21531 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21534 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21535 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21537 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21538 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21539 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21540 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21542 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21543 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21544 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21545 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21546 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21548 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21549 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21550 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21551 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21552 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21554 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21555 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21556 variable. For example, this return line
21558 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21560 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21561 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21562 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21563 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21571 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21572 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21573 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21574 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21575 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21576 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21577 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21578 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21579 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21580 redirected in several different ways:
21583 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21586 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21588 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21590 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21592 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21594 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21596 It can be discarded.
21599 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21600 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21601 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21602 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21604 If success DSNs have been requested
21605 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21606 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21607 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21611 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21612 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21613 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21614 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21615 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21616 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21620 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21622 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21623 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21624 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21625 cause delivery to be deferred.
21627 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21628 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21633 file = $home/.forward
21636 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21637 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21638 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21639 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only
21640 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21643 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21644 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21645 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21647 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21648 directly for redirection,
21649 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21650 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21651 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21652 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21656 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21657 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21658 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21659 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21662 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21663 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21664 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21665 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21667 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21668 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21669 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21670 saves some resources.
21678 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21679 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21680 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21681 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21682 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21685 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21686 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21687 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21688 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21689 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21690 document is intended for use by end users.
21692 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21693 described in the next section.
21696 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21697 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21698 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21699 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21700 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21704 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21705 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21706 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21707 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21708 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21709 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21710 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21711 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21712 commas or newlines.
21713 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21716 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21717 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21718 next newline character is ignored.
21720 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21721 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21722 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21723 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21726 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21727 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21728 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21729 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21730 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21731 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21734 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21738 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21739 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21740 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21741 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21742 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21743 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21744 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21745 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21746 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21747 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21748 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21750 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21751 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21752 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21753 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21754 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21756 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21758 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21759 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21760 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21761 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21762 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21765 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid
21766 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21767 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21768 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21769 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21770 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21772 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21773 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21778 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21779 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21782 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21784 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21785 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21786 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21787 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21788 should really contain
21790 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21792 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21793 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21794 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21798 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21799 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21800 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21803 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21804 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21805 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21807 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21808 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21809 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21810 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21811 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21813 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21814 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21815 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21816 in double quotes, for example:
21818 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21820 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21821 quote just the command. An item such as
21823 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21825 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21827 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21828 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21829 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21830 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21831 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21832 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21833 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21834 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21835 an &%accept%& router.
21838 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21839 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21840 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21842 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21843 address that includes a domain. For example,
21845 /home/world/minbari
21847 is treated as a filename, but
21849 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21851 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21852 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21853 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21854 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21856 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21857 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21859 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21860 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21861 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21862 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21865 .cindex "included address list"
21866 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21867 If an item is of the form
21869 :include:<path name>
21871 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21872 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21873 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21874 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21875 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21876 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21878 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21880 It must be given as
21882 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21884 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21885 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21886 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21888 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21889 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21890 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21891 .cindex "black hole"
21892 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21893 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21894 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21895 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21899 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21900 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21901 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21903 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21904 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21905 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21906 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21910 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21911 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21912 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21913 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21914 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21915 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21916 redirection items of the form
21921 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21922 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21923 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21924 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21926 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21928 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21930 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21931 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21933 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21934 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21935 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21937 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21938 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21939 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21940 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21941 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21942 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21943 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21944 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21945 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21948 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21949 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21950 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21951 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21953 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21954 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21955 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21956 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21957 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21959 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21960 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21961 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21962 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21963 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21967 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21968 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21969 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21970 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21971 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21972 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21973 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21977 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21978 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21979 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21980 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21981 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21982 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21983 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21984 aliasing scheme of the type
21986 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21990 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21991 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21992 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21995 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21996 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21998 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21999 the pipes are distinct.
22003 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
22004 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
22005 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
22006 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
22007 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
22008 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
22009 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
22010 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
22011 can be used to avoid this.
22014 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
22015 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
22016 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
22017 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
22018 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
22019 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
22020 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
22024 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
22026 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
22027 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
22030 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
22031 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
22032 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
22035 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
22036 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
22037 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
22038 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
22041 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
22042 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
22043 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
22044 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
22045 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
22046 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
22047 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
22049 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
22050 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
22053 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
22054 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
22055 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
22056 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
22057 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
22061 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
22062 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
22063 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
22064 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
22065 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
22066 let ordinary users do.
22070 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
22071 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
22072 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
22073 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
22074 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
22075 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
22077 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
22078 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
22079 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
22080 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
22081 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
22082 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
22084 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
22086 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
22087 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
22088 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
22089 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
22090 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
22091 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
22092 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
22093 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
22096 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
22097 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
22098 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
22099 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
22100 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
22101 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
22102 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
22103 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
22107 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
22108 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
22109 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
22110 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
22111 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
22112 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
22115 .option data redirect string&!! unset
22116 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
22117 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
22118 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
22119 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
22120 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
22122 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
22123 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
22124 terminated with newline characters. For example:
22126 data = #Exim filter\n\
22127 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
22129 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
22130 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
22131 choice into a newline.
22134 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
22135 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
22136 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22137 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22138 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
22141 .option file redirect string&!! unset
22142 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
22143 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
22144 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
22145 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
22146 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
22147 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
22148 entirely of comments), the router declines.
22150 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
22151 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
22152 runs a check on the containing directory,
22153 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
22154 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
22155 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
22156 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
22157 not, the router declines.
22160 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
22161 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22162 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
22163 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22164 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22165 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
22166 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
22169 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
22170 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
22171 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
22172 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
22173 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
22176 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
22177 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22178 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22179 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
22183 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
22184 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22185 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22186 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
22187 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22192 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
22193 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22194 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
22195 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22196 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
22197 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
22198 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
22199 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
22200 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
22201 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
22202 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
22205 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
22206 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22207 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22208 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22209 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
22212 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
22213 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22214 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22215 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
22216 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22217 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
22219 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
22220 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22221 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22222 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
22223 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
22224 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
22225 &_.forward_& files).
22228 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
22229 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22230 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22231 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22232 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
22235 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
22236 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22237 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22238 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
22239 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
22240 of the embedded Perl support.
22243 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
22244 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22245 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22246 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22247 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
22250 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
22251 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22252 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22253 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22254 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
22257 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
22258 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22259 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22260 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
22261 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
22262 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
22263 &%one_time%& is set.
22266 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
22267 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22268 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22269 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22270 to make use of &%run%& items.
22273 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
22274 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22275 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22276 If this option is true, items of the form
22278 :include:<path name>
22280 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
22283 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
22284 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22285 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22286 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
22287 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
22288 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
22289 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
22292 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
22293 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22294 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22295 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
22296 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22299 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22300 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22301 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22302 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22303 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22308 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22309 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22310 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22311 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22312 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22313 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22314 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22317 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22319 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22320 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22321 file did not exist.
22324 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22326 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22327 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22328 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22330 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22331 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22332 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22333 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22334 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22335 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22336 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22337 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22341 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22342 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22343 redirection list must start with this directory.
22346 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22347 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22348 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22351 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22352 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22353 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22354 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22355 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22356 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22357 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22358 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22359 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22360 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22361 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22362 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22363 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22364 before they subscribed.
22366 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22367 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22368 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22369 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22372 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22373 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22374 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22375 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22377 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22378 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22379 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22381 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22384 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22385 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22386 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22387 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22388 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22392 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22393 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22394 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22395 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22396 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22397 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22398 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22399 See &%check_owner%& above.
22402 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22403 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22404 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22405 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22408 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22409 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22410 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22411 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22412 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22413 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22414 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22417 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22418 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22419 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22420 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22421 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22422 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22423 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22424 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22426 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22427 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22428 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22431 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22432 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22433 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22434 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22435 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22436 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22437 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22438 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22439 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22440 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22443 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22444 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22445 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22446 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22447 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22448 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22451 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22452 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22453 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22454 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22455 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22456 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22459 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22460 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22461 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22462 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22463 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22466 .option sieve_inbox redirect string&!! inbox
22468 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22469 name of the mailbox used for "keep" operations (explicit or implicit).
22472 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22473 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22474 :subaddress part of an address.
22476 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22477 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22478 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22479 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22482 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22483 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22484 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22485 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22486 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22487 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22488 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22492 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22493 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22494 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22495 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22496 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22497 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22498 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22499 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22500 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22501 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22502 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22503 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22504 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22505 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22506 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22507 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22509 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22510 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22511 the following routers.
22513 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22514 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22515 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22516 so it is passed to the following routers.
22518 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22519 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22520 action is specified by
22521 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
22522 The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22523 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22525 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22526 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22527 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22528 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22534 file = $home/.forward
22535 file_transport = address_file
22536 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22537 reply_transport = address_reply
22540 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22541 syntax_errors_text = \
22542 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22543 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22544 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22545 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22546 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22547 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22548 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22549 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22550 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22551 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22553 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22554 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22555 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22560 local_part_prefix = real-
22561 transport = local_delivery
22563 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22564 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22566 condition = ${if match_ip {$sender_host_address} \
22567 {<; ; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1}}
22571 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22572 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22575 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22576 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22577 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22578 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22585 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22586 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22588 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22589 "Environment for local transports"
22590 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22591 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22592 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22593 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22594 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22595 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22596 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22598 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22599 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22600 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22601 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22603 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22604 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22605 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22606 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22607 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22611 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22612 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22613 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22614 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22615 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22616 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22617 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22620 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22621 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22625 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22627 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22628 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22629 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22630 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22635 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22636 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22637 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22638 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22639 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22640 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22641 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22642 group (set by the transport). For example:
22645 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22649 transport = group_delivery
22652 # This transport overrides the group
22654 driver = appendfile
22655 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22658 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22659 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22660 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22663 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22664 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22665 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22666 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22667 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22668 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22670 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22671 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22672 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22673 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22674 original gid is also used.
22676 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22677 following that is set is used:
22680 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22682 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22684 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22685 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22687 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22689 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22690 the uid is the creator's uid;
22692 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22695 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22696 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22697 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22698 The first of the following that is set is used:
22701 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22703 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22705 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22707 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22712 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22713 &%never_users%& list.
22719 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22720 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22721 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22722 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22723 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22724 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22725 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22726 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22727 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22728 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22731 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22733 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22735 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22737 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22740 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22743 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22745 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22749 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22750 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22751 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22755 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22756 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22757 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22758 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22759 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22760 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22761 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22762 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22763 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22764 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22765 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22766 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22767 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22768 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22779 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22780 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22781 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22782 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22783 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22784 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22787 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22790 .option body_only transports boolean false
22791 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22792 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22793 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22794 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22795 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22796 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22797 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22798 automatically suppress them.
22801 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22802 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22803 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22804 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22805 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22806 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22809 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22810 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22811 deliveries by the transport or for any
22812 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22813 what you are doing.
22816 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22817 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22818 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22819 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22821 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22822 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22823 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22824 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22825 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22826 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22828 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22829 transport and the router that called it.
22831 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22832 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22833 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22834 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22835 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22836 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22837 safely be resent to other recipients.
22840 .option driver transports string unset
22841 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22842 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22845 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22846 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22847 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22848 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22849 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22850 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22851 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22852 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22853 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22854 resent to other recipients.
22856 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22857 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22858 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22859 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22860 Doing so is generally not advised.
22863 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22865 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22866 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22869 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22870 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22871 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22872 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22873 &%user%& (see below).
22876 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22877 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22878 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22879 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22880 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22881 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22882 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22883 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22884 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22885 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22886 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22888 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22889 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22892 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22893 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22894 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22895 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22896 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22897 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22898 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22899 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22902 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22903 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22904 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22905 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22906 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22907 to be removed from the message.
22908 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22909 Each list item is separately expanded.
22910 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22911 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22912 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22913 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22915 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22916 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22919 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22920 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22922 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22923 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22924 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22928 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22929 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22930 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22931 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22932 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22933 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22934 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22935 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22938 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22941 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22942 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22943 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22944 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22945 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22946 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22947 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22948 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22949 change envelope recipients at this time.
22952 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22953 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22955 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22956 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22957 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22958 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22959 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22960 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22961 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22965 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22966 .cindex "additional groups"
22967 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22968 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22969 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22970 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22971 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22974 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22975 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22976 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22977 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22978 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22979 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22980 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22981 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22983 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22984 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22985 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22986 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22987 Obviously there is scope for
22988 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22989 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22991 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22992 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22993 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22994 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22995 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22998 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22999 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
23000 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
23001 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
23002 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
23003 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
23004 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
23005 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
23006 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
23007 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
23008 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
23009 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
23010 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
23015 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
23016 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
23017 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
23018 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
23019 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
23020 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
23021 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
23022 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
23025 local_part_prefix = *-
23027 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
23030 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
23032 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
23033 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
23034 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
23035 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
23036 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
23039 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
23040 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
23041 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
23042 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
23043 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
23044 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
23045 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
23046 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
23047 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
23049 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
23050 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
23051 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
23052 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
23054 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
23055 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
23056 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
23059 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
23060 .cindex "envelope sender"
23061 .cindex "envelope from"
23062 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
23063 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
23064 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
23065 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
23066 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
23067 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
23068 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
23069 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
23070 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
23072 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
23073 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
23075 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
23076 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
23077 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
23078 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
23079 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
23080 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
23081 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
23083 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
23084 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
23085 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
23086 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
23087 &%errors_to%& in a router.
23091 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
23092 .chindex Return-path:
23093 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
23094 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
23095 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
23096 have easy access to it.
23098 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
23099 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
23100 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
23101 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
23102 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
23103 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
23107 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
23108 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
23111 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
23112 .cindex "shadow transport"
23113 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
23114 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
23115 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
23117 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
23118 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
23119 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
23120 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
23121 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
23122 cause a log line to be written.
23124 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
23125 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
23126 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
23127 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
23128 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
23131 ST=<shadow transport name>
23133 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
23134 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
23135 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
23136 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
23137 headers that some sites insist on.
23140 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
23141 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23142 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23143 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
23144 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
23145 individual users or via a system filter.
23146 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
23148 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
23149 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
23150 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
23151 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
23152 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
23154 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
23155 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
23157 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
23158 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
23159 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
23160 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
23161 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
23162 &(pipe)& transports.
23164 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
23165 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
23166 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
23167 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
23168 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
23170 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
23172 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
23173 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
23174 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
23175 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
23177 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
23178 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
23179 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
23180 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
23181 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
23182 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
23184 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
23185 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
23186 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
23187 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
23188 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
23189 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
23190 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
23191 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
23193 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23194 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
23195 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
23196 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
23197 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
23198 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
23199 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
23200 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
23201 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
23202 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
23205 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23206 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
23207 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
23208 which the message is being sent. For example:
23209 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
23211 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
23212 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
23215 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
23216 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
23217 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
23219 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
23220 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
23221 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
23224 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
23226 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
23227 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
23229 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
23230 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
23231 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
23232 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
23233 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
23234 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
23235 and the latter does not.
23237 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
23238 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
23239 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
23240 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
23241 Exim tried to expand the first one.
23243 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
23244 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
23245 arguments. Consider this example:
23247 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23248 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23250 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
23251 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
23253 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23254 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23258 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
23259 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
23260 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
23261 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
23262 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
23263 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
23264 bounced from a transport filter.
23266 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
23267 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
23268 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
23271 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
23272 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
23273 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
23274 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
23275 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
23276 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
23277 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
23278 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
23279 becomes a temporary error.
23282 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
23283 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23284 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
23285 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
23286 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
23287 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
23288 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
23291 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
23292 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
23293 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
23295 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
23296 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
23297 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
23298 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
23300 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
23301 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
23302 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23309 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23310 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23312 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23314 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23315 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23316 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23317 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23318 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23319 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23320 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23322 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23323 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23324 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23325 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23326 local transport, for example:
23329 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23330 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23331 recipients saves space.
23333 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23334 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23336 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23337 to a scanner program or
23338 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23342 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23343 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23344 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23346 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23347 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23348 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23349 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23350 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23351 to certain conditions:
23354 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23355 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23356 batching is possible.
23358 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23359 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23360 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23362 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23363 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23364 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23365 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23366 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23369 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23370 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23371 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23375 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23376 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23377 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23378 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23379 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23380 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23381 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23384 escape_string = ".."
23386 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23387 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23388 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23390 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23391 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23392 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23393 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23394 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23395 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23397 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23398 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23399 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23400 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23401 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23402 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23403 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23404 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23405 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23410 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23411 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23413 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23414 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23415 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23416 .cindex "directory creation"
23417 .cindex "creating directories"
23418 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23419 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23420 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23421 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23422 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23423 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23424 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23425 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23426 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23427 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23429 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23430 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23431 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23434 .cindex "quota" "system"
23435 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23436 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23437 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23439 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23440 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23441 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23442 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23444 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23445 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23448 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23449 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23450 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23451 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23456 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23457 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23458 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23459 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23460 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23462 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23463 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23464 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23465 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23466 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23467 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23468 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23469 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23470 operation. There are two cases:
23473 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23474 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23475 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23476 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23477 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23478 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23479 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23481 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23482 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23483 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23485 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23486 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23487 a file or directory name
23488 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23490 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23491 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23492 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23493 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23494 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23495 which returns a path (or component).
23498 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23499 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23500 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23501 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23506 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23508 require "fileinto";
23509 fileinto "folder23";
23511 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23512 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23513 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the
23518 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23519 way of handling this requirement:
23521 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23522 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23523 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23525 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23529 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23530 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23531 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23534 An alternative for the &"keep"& aspect is to use the &%sieve_inbox%& option
23535 on the redirect router that calls the Sieve filter,
23536 to explicitly set the filename used.
23539 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23540 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23541 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23542 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23543 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23544 path to the transport.
23546 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23547 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23550 &*Note 3*&: Permitting a user to enable writes to an absolute path
23551 may be a security issue.
23556 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23557 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23561 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23562 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23563 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23564 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23565 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23566 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23567 delivery is deferred.
23570 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23571 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23572 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23573 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23574 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23575 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23576 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23577 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23580 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23581 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23582 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23583 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23587 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23588 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23591 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23592 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23593 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23594 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23595 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23598 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23599 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23600 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23601 process is running.
23604 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23605 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23606 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23607 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23608 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23609 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23610 contains is significant.
23612 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23613 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23614 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23615 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23616 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23618 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23619 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23620 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23621 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23622 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23623 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23625 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23626 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23627 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23628 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23630 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23631 .cindex "directory creation"
23632 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23633 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23634 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23636 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23637 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23638 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23639 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23640 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23644 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23645 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23646 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23647 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23648 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23651 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23652 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23654 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23655 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23657 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23658 to evade the testing.
23659 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23660 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23661 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23662 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23663 &%file_must_exist%&.
23665 In the fourth case,
23666 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23667 existing directory.
23668 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23669 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23671 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23672 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23673 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23674 becomes de-tainted.
23677 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23678 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23679 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23680 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23682 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23683 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23684 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23685 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23686 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23688 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23692 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23694 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23695 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23696 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23697 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23699 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23701 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23702 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23706 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23707 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23708 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23711 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23712 See &%check_string%& above.
23715 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23716 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23717 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23718 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23719 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23720 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23723 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23726 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23727 .cindex "locking files"
23728 .cindex "lock files"
23729 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23730 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23732 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23733 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23736 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23737 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23740 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23741 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23742 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23743 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23744 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23745 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23749 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23750 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23751 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23752 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23753 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23754 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23755 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23756 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23757 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23760 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23761 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23763 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23764 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23765 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23766 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23767 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23768 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23769 delivery is deferred.
23772 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23773 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23774 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23775 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23778 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23779 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23780 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23781 .cindex "locking files"
23782 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23783 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23784 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23785 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23786 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23787 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23788 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23789 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23791 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23792 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23793 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23794 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23796 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23797 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23800 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23802 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23803 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23804 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23806 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23807 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23809 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23812 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23813 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23814 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23815 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23818 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23819 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23820 for details of locking.
23823 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23824 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23825 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23828 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23829 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23830 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23833 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23834 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23835 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23836 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23837 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23840 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23841 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23842 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23843 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23844 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23845 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23846 external source that maintains the data.
23849 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23850 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23851 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23852 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23853 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23854 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23855 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23856 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23860 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23861 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23862 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23863 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23864 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23865 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23866 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23867 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23868 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23869 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23872 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23873 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23874 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23875 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23876 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23877 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23878 calculation. The default value is:
23880 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23882 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23883 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23885 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23887 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23889 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23890 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23891 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23892 directly into that directory.
23895 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23896 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23897 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23900 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23901 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23902 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23905 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23906 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23907 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23908 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23909 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23910 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23911 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23912 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23914 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23915 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23916 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23917 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23918 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23919 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23920 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23921 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23922 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23923 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23926 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23927 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23928 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23929 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23930 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23931 below for further details.
23934 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23935 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23936 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23939 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23940 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23941 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23944 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23945 .cindex "locking files"
23946 .cindex "file" "locking"
23947 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23948 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23949 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23950 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23951 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23952 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23953 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23955 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23956 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23957 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23964 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23965 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23966 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23967 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23968 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23969 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23970 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23971 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23973 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23974 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23975 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23976 append messages to it.
23979 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23980 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23981 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23982 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23983 in which case it is:
23985 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23986 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23988 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23989 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23991 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23992 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23993 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23994 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23999 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24000 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24002 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
24003 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
24004 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
24005 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
24006 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
24007 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
24008 value, and this option is ignored.
24011 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
24012 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
24013 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
24014 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
24015 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
24018 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
24019 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
24020 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
24021 on users about incoming mail.
24024 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
24025 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
24026 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
24027 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
24028 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
24029 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
24030 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
24031 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
24032 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
24034 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
24035 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
24036 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
24038 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
24039 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
24040 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
24041 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
24042 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
24043 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
24045 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
24046 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
24047 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
24048 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
24049 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
24052 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
24053 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
24055 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
24057 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
24058 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
24059 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
24060 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
24061 system quota failures.
24063 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
24064 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
24065 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
24066 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
24067 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
24068 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
24069 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
24070 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
24071 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
24072 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
24075 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
24076 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
24077 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
24078 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
24079 delivery directory.
24082 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
24083 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
24084 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
24085 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
24086 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
24089 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
24090 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
24092 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
24093 See &%quota%& above.
24096 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
24097 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
24098 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
24099 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
24100 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
24101 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
24102 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
24104 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
24105 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
24106 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
24107 the file length to the filename. For example:
24109 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
24110 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
24112 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
24113 number of lines in the message.
24115 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
24116 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
24117 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
24119 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
24121 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
24122 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
24123 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
24124 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
24125 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
24126 as is used to adjust the effective size.
24129 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
24130 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
24131 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
24133 quota_warn_message = "\
24134 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
24135 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
24136 This message is automatically created \
24137 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
24138 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
24139 a warning threshold that is\n\
24140 set by the system administrator.\n"
24144 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
24145 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
24146 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
24147 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
24148 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
24149 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
24150 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
24151 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
24152 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
24156 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
24158 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
24159 percent sign is ignored.
24161 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
24162 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
24163 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
24164 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
24165 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
24166 &'From:'& line, the default is:
24168 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
24170 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
24171 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
24174 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
24175 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
24179 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
24180 .cindex "envelope from"
24181 .cindex "envelope sender"
24182 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
24183 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
24184 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
24185 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
24186 for details of batch SMTP.
24189 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
24190 .cindex "carriage return"
24192 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24193 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24194 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
24195 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24197 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
24198 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
24199 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
24200 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
24201 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
24202 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24205 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24206 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
24207 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
24208 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
24209 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24210 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
24213 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
24214 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
24215 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
24216 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
24217 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
24219 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
24220 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
24221 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
24222 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
24224 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
24225 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
24226 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
24227 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
24228 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
24231 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
24232 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
24235 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
24236 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
24237 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
24238 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
24239 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
24240 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
24241 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
24243 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24244 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
24245 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
24246 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
24249 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
24250 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
24251 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
24254 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24255 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
24256 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
24257 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
24258 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
24259 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
24260 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
24261 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
24262 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
24264 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24265 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
24266 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
24267 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
24272 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
24273 .cindex "appending to a file"
24274 .cindex "file" "appending"
24275 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
24278 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
24282 .cindex "directory creation"
24283 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
24284 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
24285 &%directory_mode%& option.
24288 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
24289 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
24293 .cindex "file" "locking"
24294 .cindex "locking files"
24295 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24296 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
24297 reliably over NFS, as follows:
24300 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
24301 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
24302 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
24304 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
24306 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
24307 Unlink the hitching post name.
24309 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
24310 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
24311 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
24312 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
24314 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
24315 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
24316 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
24317 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
24318 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
24319 it before trying again.
24323 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24324 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24325 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24328 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24329 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24330 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24331 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24332 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24333 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24334 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24335 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24336 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24340 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24341 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24342 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24343 delivery is deferred.
24346 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24347 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24348 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24352 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24353 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24354 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24357 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24358 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24359 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24362 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24363 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24364 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24365 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24366 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24367 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24368 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24369 that prevents link following.
24372 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24373 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24374 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24375 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24376 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24379 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24382 .cindex "file" "locking"
24383 .cindex "locking files"
24384 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24385 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24386 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24387 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24388 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24390 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24392 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24393 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24394 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24396 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24397 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24398 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24400 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24401 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24402 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24403 delivery is deferred.
24405 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24406 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24407 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24408 immediately. It retries up to
24410 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24412 times (rounded up).
24415 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24416 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24419 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24420 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24421 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24422 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24423 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24424 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24425 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24426 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24427 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24428 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24430 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24431 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24432 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24433 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24434 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24435 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24436 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24438 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24439 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24440 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24441 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24444 .cindex "maildir format"
24445 .cindex "mailstore format"
24446 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24447 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24448 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24449 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24450 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24452 .cindex "directory creation"
24453 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24454 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24455 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24456 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24457 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24458 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24463 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24464 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24465 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24466 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24467 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24468 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24469 &_new_& subdirectory.
24471 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24472 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24473 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24474 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24475 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24476 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24477 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24479 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24480 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24481 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24482 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24483 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24484 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24485 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24486 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24488 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24489 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24490 folders. Consider this example:
24492 maildir_format = true
24493 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24494 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24495 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24496 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24498 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24499 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24500 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24501 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24502 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24503 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24505 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24506 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24507 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24508 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24509 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24511 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24512 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24513 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24515 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24516 .cindex "maildir++"
24517 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24518 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24519 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24520 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24521 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24522 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24523 amount of space used.
24525 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24526 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24527 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24528 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24529 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24530 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24535 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24536 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24537 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24538 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24539 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24540 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24543 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24544 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24545 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24546 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24547 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24548 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24549 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24550 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24551 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24552 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24553 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24554 backwards compatibility).
24556 For one common implementation, you might set:
24558 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24560 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24562 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24563 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24564 &[stat()]& each message file.
24567 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24568 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24569 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24570 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24571 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24572 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24573 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24574 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24575 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24577 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24578 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24579 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24580 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24581 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24582 need to know the quota.
24584 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24585 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24587 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24588 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24589 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24593 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24594 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24595 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24596 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24597 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24598 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24599 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24600 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24602 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24603 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24604 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24605 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24606 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24607 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24609 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24610 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24611 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24612 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24613 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24614 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24616 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24617 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24618 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24619 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24622 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24623 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24624 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24625 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24626 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24628 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24630 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24631 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24632 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24633 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24634 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24641 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24642 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24644 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24645 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24646 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24647 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24648 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24649 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24650 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24651 to the rules in RFCs
24652 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822) and
24653 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,3834), respectively.
24655 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24656 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24657 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24658 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24659 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24662 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24663 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24664 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24665 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24666 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24668 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24669 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24670 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24671 transport is run as a consequence of a
24673 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24674 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24675 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24676 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24677 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24678 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24680 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24681 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24682 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24683 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24685 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24686 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24687 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24688 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24689 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24690 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24691 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24693 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24694 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24695 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24696 the transport defers.
24697 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24698 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24700 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24701 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24702 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24703 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24705 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24706 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24707 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24708 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24709 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24710 problems. They are just discarded.
24714 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24715 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24717 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24718 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24719 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24722 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24723 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24724 when the message is specified by the transport.
24727 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24728 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24729 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24730 string comes first.
24733 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24734 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24735 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24738 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24739 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24740 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24743 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24744 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24745 specified by the transport.
24748 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24749 This specifies additional
24750 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
24751 headers that are to be added to the message
24752 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24753 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24756 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24757 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24758 the message is specified by the transport.
24761 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24762 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24766 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24767 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24768 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24769 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24770 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24774 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24775 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24776 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24777 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24779 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24780 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24781 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24782 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24783 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24784 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24785 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24788 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24789 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24790 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24791 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24792 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24794 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24795 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24796 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24797 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24798 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24799 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24802 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24803 See &%once%& above.
24806 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24807 See &%once%& above.
24808 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24811 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24812 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24813 specified by the transport.
24816 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24817 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24818 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24819 configuration option.
24822 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24823 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24824 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24825 automatic responses. For example:
24827 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24829 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24830 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24831 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24832 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24837 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24838 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24839 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24840 the text comes first.
24843 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24844 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24845 when the message is specified by the transport.
24846 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24847 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24852 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24853 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24855 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24856 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24857 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24858 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24859 .cindex "LMTP" "over a unix-domain socket"
24860 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol
24861 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) over a pipe to a
24863 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24864 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24865 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24866 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24867 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24868 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24872 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24873 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24874 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24877 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24878 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24881 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24882 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24883 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24884 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24885 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24888 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24889 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24890 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24891 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24892 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24893 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24896 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24897 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24898 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24899 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24900 in its response to the LHLO command.
24902 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24903 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24904 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24905 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24908 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24909 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24910 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24911 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24916 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24920 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24921 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24925 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24926 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24928 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24929 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24930 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24931 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24932 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24933 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24934 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24935 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24939 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24940 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24941 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24942 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24943 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24945 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24946 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24947 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24948 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24949 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24950 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24951 that are routed to the transport.
24953 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24954 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24955 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24956 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24957 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24958 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24959 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24963 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24964 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24965 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24967 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24968 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24969 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24970 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24971 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24972 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24973 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24975 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24976 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24977 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24980 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24981 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24982 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24983 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24984 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24985 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24986 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24991 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24992 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24993 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24994 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24995 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24996 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24997 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24998 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24999 &"local delivery failed"&.
25001 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
25002 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
25003 will be sent as normal.
25005 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
25006 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
25007 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
25008 apply in this case.
25010 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
25011 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
25012 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
25013 a non-existent command may be the problem.
25015 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
25016 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
25017 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
25018 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
25019 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
25020 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
25021 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
25026 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
25027 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
25028 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
25029 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
25030 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
25033 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
25034 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
25035 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
25036 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
25038 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
25039 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
25040 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
25041 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
25042 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
25044 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
25046 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
25047 arguments. You have to write
25049 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
25051 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
25052 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
25053 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
25054 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
25055 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
25056 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
25059 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
25062 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25063 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25064 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25065 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
25066 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
25067 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
25068 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
25069 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
25070 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
25071 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
25072 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
25074 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
25075 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
25076 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
25077 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
25078 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
25079 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
25080 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
25081 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
25083 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
25084 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
25085 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
25086 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
25087 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
25088 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
25089 control what is done with it.
25091 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
25092 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
25093 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
25094 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
25095 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
25096 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
25097 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
25098 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
25099 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
25100 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
25101 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
25105 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
25106 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
25107 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
25108 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
25109 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
25110 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
25111 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
25112 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
25113 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
25114 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
25115 by potential attackers.
25117 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
25118 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
25119 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
25120 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
25121 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
25122 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
25123 &`LOGNAME `& see below
25124 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
25125 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
25126 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
25127 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
25128 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
25129 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
25130 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
25131 &`USER `& see below
25133 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
25134 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
25135 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
25136 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
25137 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
25138 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
25139 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
25142 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
25143 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
25144 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
25148 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
25149 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
25150 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
25151 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
25154 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
25155 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
25159 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
25160 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
25161 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25162 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
25163 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
25164 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
25165 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
25166 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
25167 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
25168 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
25169 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
25172 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
25174 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
25175 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
25176 &%use_shell%& is set.
25179 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
25180 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25183 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
25184 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
25185 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25188 .option check_string pipe string unset
25189 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
25190 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
25191 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
25192 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
25193 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
25194 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
25195 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
25199 .option command pipe string&!! unset
25200 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
25201 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
25202 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
25203 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
25204 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
25205 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
25207 .cindex "tainted data"
25208 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
25211 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
25212 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
25213 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
25214 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
25215 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
25216 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25217 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
25220 .option escape_string pipe string unset
25221 See &%check_string%& above.
25224 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
25225 .cindex "exec failure"
25226 .cindex "failure of exec"
25227 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
25228 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
25229 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
25230 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
25231 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
25234 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
25235 .cindex "signal exit"
25236 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
25237 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
25238 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
25239 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
25242 .option force_command pipe boolean false
25243 .cindex "force command"
25244 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
25245 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
25246 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
25247 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
25248 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
25249 command. For example:
25251 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
25255 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
25256 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
25257 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
25260 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
25261 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
25262 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
25263 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
25264 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
25265 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
25267 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
25268 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
25271 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
25272 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
25273 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
25274 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
25275 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
25276 written to the main log.
25279 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
25280 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
25281 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
25282 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
25283 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
25284 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
25288 .option log_output pipe boolean false
25289 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
25290 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
25291 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
25292 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25295 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
25296 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
25297 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
25298 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
25299 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
25300 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
25301 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
25302 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
25305 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
25306 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
25307 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
25310 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
25314 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
25315 .cindex "&""From""& line"
25316 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
25317 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
25318 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
25323 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25324 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
25327 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25328 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25329 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25330 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25334 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25335 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25338 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25339 This option is expanded and
25340 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25341 variable of the subprocess.
25342 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25343 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25344 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25347 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25348 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25349 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25350 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25351 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25352 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25353 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25354 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25355 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25358 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25359 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25360 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25361 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25362 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25363 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25364 accept the message is used.
25367 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25368 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25369 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25370 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25371 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25372 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25375 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25376 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25377 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25378 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25379 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25380 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25381 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25385 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25386 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25387 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25388 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25389 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25390 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25391 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25392 of them may be set.
25396 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25397 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25398 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25399 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25400 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25401 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25402 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25403 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25404 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25405 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25406 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25407 and 73, respectively.
25410 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25411 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25412 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25413 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25414 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25415 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25416 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25418 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25419 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25420 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25421 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25422 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25423 delivery to be deferred.
25425 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25426 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25429 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25430 .cindex "envelope sender"
25431 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25432 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25433 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25434 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25435 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25437 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25438 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25439 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25440 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25441 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25442 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25446 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25447 .cindex "carriage return"
25449 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25450 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25451 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25452 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25454 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25455 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25456 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25457 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25458 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25461 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25462 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25463 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25464 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25465 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25466 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25467 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25468 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25469 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25474 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25475 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25476 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25477 .cindex "external local delivery"
25478 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25479 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25480 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25481 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25482 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25483 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25484 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25485 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25486 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25487 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25492 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25496 check_string = "From "
25497 escape_string = ">From "
25499 user = $local_part_data
25506 transport = procmail_pipe
25508 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25509 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25510 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25511 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25512 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25513 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25515 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25519 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25520 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25523 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25524 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25525 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25526 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25527 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25530 local_delivery_cyrus:
25532 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25533 -- $local_part_data
25545 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25547 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25548 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25550 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25551 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25554 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25555 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25557 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25558 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25559 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25560 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25561 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25562 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25563 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25564 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25567 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25568 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25572 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25573 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25574 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25575 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25576 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25577 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25578 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25580 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25581 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25582 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25583 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25584 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25585 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25590 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25591 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25592 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25596 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25598 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25599 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25600 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25601 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25602 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25603 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25604 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25605 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25608 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25609 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25610 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25611 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25612 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25613 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25614 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25615 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25616 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25617 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25618 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25619 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25620 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25621 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25623 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25624 and will be removed in a future release.
25627 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25628 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25629 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25632 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25633 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25634 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25635 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25636 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25637 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25638 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25639 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25641 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25642 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25643 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25644 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25645 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25646 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25647 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25648 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25649 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25652 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25654 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25655 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25656 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25657 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25658 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25661 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25662 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25663 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25664 particular connection.
25666 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25667 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25668 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25669 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25671 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25672 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25673 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25675 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25677 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25678 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25680 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25681 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25685 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25686 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25687 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25688 authenticated as a client.
25691 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25692 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25693 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25694 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25695 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25698 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25699 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25700 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25701 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25702 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25703 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25704 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25705 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by
25706 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1123,RFC 1123).
25709 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25710 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25711 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25712 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25713 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25714 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25715 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25718 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25719 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25720 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25721 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25724 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25725 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25726 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25727 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25728 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25729 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25730 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25731 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25732 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25733 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25734 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25735 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25736 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25737 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25740 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25741 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25742 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25743 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25744 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25747 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25748 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25749 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25750 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25751 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25752 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25753 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25754 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25755 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25756 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25757 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25758 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25759 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25760 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25761 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25762 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25763 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25764 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25767 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25768 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25769 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25770 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25771 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25774 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25775 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25776 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25777 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25778 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25779 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25781 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25782 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25783 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25784 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25785 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25786 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25787 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25788 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25792 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25793 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25794 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25795 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25796 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25799 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25800 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25801 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25802 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25806 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25807 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25808 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25809 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25810 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25811 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25812 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25813 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25818 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25819 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25820 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25821 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25822 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25823 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25824 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25825 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25826 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25830 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25831 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25832 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25833 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25834 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25835 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25836 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25838 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25839 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25840 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25841 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25842 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25845 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25846 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25847 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25848 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25849 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25850 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25851 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25852 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25854 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25855 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25856 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25857 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25858 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25859 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25861 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25862 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25863 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25864 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25865 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25867 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25868 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25869 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25870 copy of the message is sent.
25872 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25873 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25874 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25875 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25879 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25880 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25881 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25882 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25885 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25886 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25887 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25888 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25889 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25890 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25892 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25893 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25894 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25895 implementations of TLS.
25897 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25898 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25899 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25900 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25901 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25902 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25903 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25908 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25909 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25910 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25911 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25912 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25913 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25914 interface address, you could use this:
25916 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25917 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25918 {$primary_hostname}}
25920 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25923 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25924 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25925 .cindex TLS resumption
25926 Some mail-accepting sites
25927 (notably Microsoft)
25928 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25929 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25930 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25931 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25933 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25934 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25935 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25937 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25938 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25941 suffices for one known case.
25943 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25944 server's EHLO response.
25946 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25947 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25948 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25949 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25951 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25952 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25954 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25955 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25956 expression for this option.
25957 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25958 will be useful for such work.
25960 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25961 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25962 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25963 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25964 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25965 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25967 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25968 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25969 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25970 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25972 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25973 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25974 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25975 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25976 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25977 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25978 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25980 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25981 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25982 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25983 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25984 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25985 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25986 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25989 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25990 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25993 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25994 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25995 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25996 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25997 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25998 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25999 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
26000 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
26001 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
26002 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
26005 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
26006 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
26007 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
26008 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
26009 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
26011 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
26012 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
26013 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
26014 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
26015 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
26016 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
26018 The retry hints database is used for the record,
26019 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
26020 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
26021 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
26022 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
26024 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
26027 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
26028 the &%helo_data%& option
26029 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
26031 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
26032 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
26033 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
26034 You have been warned.
26037 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26038 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
26039 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
26040 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26042 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26043 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
26044 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
26045 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
26046 to any host that matches this list.
26049 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
26050 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26051 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
26052 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
26053 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
26054 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
26055 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
26056 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
26059 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
26060 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
26061 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
26066 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26067 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
26068 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
26069 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26070 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
26071 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
26072 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
26073 explanation of when this might be needed.
26075 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26076 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
26077 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
26078 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26079 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
26080 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
26081 message on the same session.
26083 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
26084 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
26085 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
26086 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
26087 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
26088 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
26093 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
26094 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
26095 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
26096 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
26097 &%fallback_hosts%&.
26100 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
26101 .cindex "randomized host list"
26102 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
26103 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
26104 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
26105 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
26106 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
26107 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
26108 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
26109 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
26111 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
26112 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
26113 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
26114 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
26116 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
26118 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
26119 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
26120 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
26122 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
26123 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
26124 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
26125 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
26126 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
26127 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
26128 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
26129 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
26130 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26133 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
26134 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26135 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
26136 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26137 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26139 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
26140 or if DANE-TA us used.
26141 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
26143 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
26144 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
26146 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26147 If the TLS library supports ALPN
26148 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
26149 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
26150 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
26152 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
26153 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
26155 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
26156 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26157 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
26158 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
26159 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
26160 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
26161 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26162 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26163 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26165 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
26166 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26167 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
26168 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26169 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26171 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26172 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26173 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
26174 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26175 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
26176 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
26178 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
26179 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
26180 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26181 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
26182 connects. If authentication fails
26183 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
26184 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
26185 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26187 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
26188 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
26189 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
26190 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
26191 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26192 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
26193 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
26194 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
26196 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
26197 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26198 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
26199 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
26200 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
26201 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
26202 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
26203 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26204 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26205 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26207 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
26208 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
26209 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
26210 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
26211 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
26212 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
26213 perform a TCP Fast Open (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7413,RFC 7413).
26214 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
26215 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
26216 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
26218 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
26219 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
26221 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
26222 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
26223 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
26224 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
26225 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
26227 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
26228 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
26229 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
26230 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26231 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
26232 for multi-recipient messages.
26233 The option can usually be left as default.
26235 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
26236 .cindex "bind IP address"
26237 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
26239 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26240 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
26241 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
26242 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
26243 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
26244 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
26245 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
26246 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
26249 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
26250 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
26251 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
26252 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
26253 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
26254 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
26257 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
26259 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
26260 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
26261 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
26262 interface to use if the host has more than one.
26265 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
26266 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
26267 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
26268 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
26269 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
26270 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
26271 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
26272 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
26273 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
26274 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
26278 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
26279 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
26280 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
26281 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
26282 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
26284 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
26285 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
26288 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
26289 SMTP message transaction.
26290 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
26292 If a constant is given,
26293 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
26294 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
26297 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26298 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
26299 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26300 that value also constrains the result of this option
26301 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
26304 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
26305 .cindex "line length" limit
26306 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
26307 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
26308 (before a transport filter, if any)
26309 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
26311 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
26313 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
26314 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
26317 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
26318 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26319 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
26320 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
26321 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
26322 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26323 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26324 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26326 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26327 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26328 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26330 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26331 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26332 sent on the connection.
26334 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26335 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26336 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26337 this option is regarded as being false.
26340 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26341 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26342 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26343 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26344 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26345 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26346 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26347 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26349 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26350 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26352 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26353 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26354 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26357 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26358 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26362 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26363 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26364 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26365 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26367 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26368 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26370 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) instead of SMTP.
26371 This protocol is sometimes used for local
26372 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26373 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26375 &*Note*&: When using LMTP it should be considered whether the default values
26376 for some other features, such as DANE, are appropriate.
26378 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26379 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26380 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26381 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26382 but as of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314) it is preferred
26383 over STARTTLS for message submission
26384 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26387 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26388 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26389 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26390 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26391 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26392 addresses is not affected.
26394 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26395 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26396 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26397 Exim to use only the host name.
26398 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26401 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26402 .cindex "serializing connections"
26403 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26404 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26405 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26406 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26407 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26408 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26409 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26411 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26412 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26413 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26414 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26415 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26416 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26418 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26419 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26420 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26421 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26422 are used for ETRN serialization.
26424 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26427 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26428 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26429 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26430 .cindex "size" "of message"
26431 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26432 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26433 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26434 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26435 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26436 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26437 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26438 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26440 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26441 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26444 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26445 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26446 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26447 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26450 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26451 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26453 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26454 If this option is set
26455 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26456 the value given is used.
26458 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26459 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26463 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26464 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26465 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26467 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26468 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26469 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26470 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26471 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26474 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26475 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26476 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26477 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26481 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26482 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26483 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26484 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26485 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26488 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26489 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26490 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26491 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26492 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26493 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26496 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26499 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26500 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26502 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26503 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26504 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26505 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26506 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26507 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26508 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26509 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26512 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26513 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26514 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26516 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26517 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26518 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26519 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26520 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26521 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26522 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26523 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26524 ciphers is a preference order.
26527 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26528 .cindex TLS resumption
26529 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26530 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26534 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26535 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26537 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26538 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26539 If this option is set
26540 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26541 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26542 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26543 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26544 certificate and private key for the session.
26546 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26548 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26554 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26555 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26556 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26557 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26558 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26559 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26560 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26561 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26562 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26563 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26567 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26568 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26569 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26570 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26571 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26572 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26573 Note that unless the host is in this list
26574 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26575 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26576 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26577 certificate verification succeeds.
26580 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26581 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26582 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26583 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26584 while verifying the server certificate,
26585 checks will be included on the host name
26586 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26587 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26588 Wildcard names are permitted,
26589 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26591 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26594 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26595 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26596 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26598 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26599 The value of this option must be either the
26601 or the absolute path to
26602 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26603 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26605 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26606 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26607 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26610 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26611 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26613 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26615 either by file or directory
26616 are added to those given by the system default location.
26618 The values of &$host$& and
26619 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26620 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26622 For back-compatibility,
26623 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26624 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26625 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26628 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26629 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26630 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26631 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26632 certificate verification must succeed.
26633 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26634 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26635 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26636 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26637 that connections use TLS.
26638 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26639 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26641 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26642 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26643 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26644 If built with internationalization support,
26645 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26647 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26648 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26649 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26650 set this option to an empty string.
26651 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26656 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26658 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26659 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26660 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26661 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26662 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26665 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26666 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26667 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26668 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26671 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26672 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26673 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26675 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26676 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26677 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26678 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26679 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26681 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26682 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26683 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26684 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26685 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26686 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26687 see below for an exception).
26689 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26690 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26691 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26692 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26693 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26695 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26696 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26697 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26698 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26699 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26700 reached their retry times.
26702 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26703 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26704 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26705 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26706 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26707 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26708 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26709 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26710 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26711 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26714 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26715 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26716 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26717 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26718 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26719 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26721 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26722 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26723 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26724 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26725 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26726 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26735 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26736 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26737 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26738 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26739 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26740 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26742 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26743 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26744 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26745 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26746 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26747 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26748 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26750 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26751 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26752 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26753 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26756 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26757 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26758 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26759 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26761 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26762 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26763 facility; you do not have to use it.
26765 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26766 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26767 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26768 address to which it applies.
26770 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26771 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26772 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26773 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26774 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26775 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26778 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26779 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26780 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26781 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26784 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26785 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26786 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26787 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26788 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26791 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26792 illustrated by these examples:
26795 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26796 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26797 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26798 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26800 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26801 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26806 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26807 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26808 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26809 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26810 message's processing.
26812 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26813 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26814 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26815 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26816 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26817 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26818 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26819 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26820 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26822 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26823 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26824 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26825 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26826 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26827 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26828 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26829 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26830 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26831 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26833 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26834 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26835 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26836 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26837 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26838 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26840 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26841 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26842 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26844 .cindex "envelope from"
26845 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26846 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26847 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26848 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26849 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26850 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26851 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26852 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26853 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26855 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26856 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26862 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26863 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26864 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26865 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26866 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26867 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full
26868 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
26869 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26870 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26871 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26872 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26874 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26876 might produce the output
26878 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26879 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26880 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26881 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26882 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26883 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26884 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26885 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26887 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26888 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26889 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26890 set for a particular transport.
26893 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26894 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26895 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26898 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26900 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26901 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26902 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26903 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26905 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26906 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26907 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26908 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26911 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26912 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26913 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26915 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26916 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26917 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26918 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26919 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26920 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26921 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26923 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26924 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26925 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26926 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26927 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26931 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26932 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26935 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26936 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26937 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26938 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26939 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26940 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26941 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26942 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26943 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26945 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26946 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26947 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26949 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26950 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26951 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26952 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26953 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26954 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26955 of pattern they are set as follows:
26958 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26959 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26960 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26963 *queen@*.fict.example
26965 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26967 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26971 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26972 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26975 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26976 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26977 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26978 rewriting rule of the form
26980 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26982 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26988 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26989 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26990 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26991 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26992 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26996 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26997 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26998 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26999 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
27000 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
27002 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
27004 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
27007 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27008 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27009 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
27010 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
27011 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
27012 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
27013 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
27014 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
27015 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
27016 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
27017 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
27018 entry written to the panic log.
27022 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
27023 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
27026 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
27029 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
27031 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
27034 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
27035 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
27039 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
27041 .cindex rewriting flags
27042 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
27043 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
27044 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
27045 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
27046 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
27048 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
27049 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
27050 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
27051 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
27052 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
27053 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
27054 &`h`& rewrite all headers
27055 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
27056 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
27057 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
27059 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
27060 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
27061 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
27063 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
27064 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
27067 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
27068 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
27069 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
27070 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
27071 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
27072 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
27073 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
27074 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
27075 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
27077 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27078 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27079 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
27080 compliant with RFCs
27081 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,2821) and
27082 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822)
27083 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
27084 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
27085 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
27086 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
27087 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
27090 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
27091 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
27092 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
27093 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
27096 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
27097 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
27098 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
27100 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
27101 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
27102 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
27103 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
27105 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
27106 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
27107 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
27109 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
27110 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
27111 to the working part of the address, with any comments and
27112 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
27113 &"phrase"& left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
27115 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
27119 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
27122 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
27123 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
27124 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
27125 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete
27126 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
27127 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
27128 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
27129 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to
27130 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). The character set
27131 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
27133 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
27134 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
27138 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
27139 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
27141 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
27142 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
27143 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
27145 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
27146 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
27147 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
27148 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
27149 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
27150 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
27151 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
27152 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
27154 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
27155 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
27157 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
27159 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
27160 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
27162 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
27163 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
27164 messages that originate outside the local host:
27166 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
27167 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
27169 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
27172 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
27173 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
27174 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
27175 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
27176 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
27177 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
27178 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
27179 components. For example, the rule
27181 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
27183 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
27184 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
27185 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
27186 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
27187 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
27188 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
27189 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
27196 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27197 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27199 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
27200 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
27201 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
27202 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
27203 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
27204 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
27205 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
27206 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
27207 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
27208 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
27209 address, domain and error.
27211 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
27212 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
27213 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
27214 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
27215 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
27216 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
27217 log selector is set, the message
27218 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
27219 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
27220 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
27221 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
27223 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
27224 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
27225 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
27226 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
27227 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
27228 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
27229 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
27230 domain are maintained independently.
27232 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
27233 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
27234 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
27235 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
27236 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
27237 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
27238 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
27239 the local address is reached.
27241 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
27242 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
27243 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
27244 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
27245 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
27247 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
27248 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
27249 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
27250 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
27251 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
27252 messages that it should now be retaining.
27256 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
27257 .cindex "retry" "rules"
27258 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
27259 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
27260 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
27261 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
27262 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
27263 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
27264 message's sender, respectively.
27267 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
27268 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
27269 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
27270 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
27271 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
27272 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
27275 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27277 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
27280 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27282 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
27283 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
27286 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
27287 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
27288 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
27289 expressions work in address lists.
27291 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
27292 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
27296 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
27297 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
27298 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
27299 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
27300 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
27301 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
27302 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
27303 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
27304 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
27306 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
27307 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
27308 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
27309 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
27312 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
27313 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
27314 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
27315 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
27316 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
27317 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
27318 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
27319 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
27320 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
27321 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
27326 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
27328 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
27329 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
27330 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
27331 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
27332 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
27333 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27335 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27339 and the retry rules are
27341 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27342 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27344 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27345 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27346 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27347 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27348 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27349 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27351 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27352 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27353 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27354 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27356 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27357 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27358 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27360 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27362 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27363 textual form of the IP address.
27365 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27366 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27367 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27368 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27371 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27372 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27373 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27375 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27376 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27377 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27379 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27380 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27382 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27383 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27386 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27387 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27388 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27389 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27390 retry rule of this form:
27392 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27394 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27395 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27398 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27399 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27400 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27401 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27404 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27405 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27406 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27407 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27408 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27410 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27411 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27413 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27414 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27417 A connection was refused.
27419 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27420 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27422 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27423 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27425 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27426 A connection attempt timed out.
27428 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27429 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27430 obtained from an MX record.
27432 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27433 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27434 obtained from an MX record.
27437 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27439 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27440 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27441 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27442 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27445 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27448 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27449 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27450 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27451 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27452 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27453 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27457 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27458 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27459 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27460 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27461 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27465 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27466 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27467 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27469 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27470 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27471 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27472 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27473 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27474 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27475 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27477 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27478 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27481 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27482 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27483 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27488 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27489 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27490 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27491 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27492 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27495 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27497 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27499 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27501 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27502 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27505 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27507 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27508 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27509 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27510 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27511 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27513 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27514 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27516 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27518 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27519 list is never matched.
27525 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27526 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27527 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27528 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27530 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27532 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27533 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27534 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27535 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27536 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27538 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27539 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27540 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27541 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27542 The available algorithms are:
27545 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27548 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27549 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27550 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27552 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27553 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27554 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27555 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27556 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27557 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27558 queue processing times.
27561 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27562 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27563 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27564 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27565 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27566 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27567 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27568 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27569 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27570 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27571 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27572 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27574 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27575 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27576 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27577 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27578 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27579 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27582 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27583 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27584 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27585 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27586 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27587 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27588 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27589 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27590 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27591 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27592 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27593 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27595 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27596 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27597 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27598 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27599 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27600 deliveries that have been deferred.
27603 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27604 Here are some example retry rules:
27606 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27607 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27608 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27609 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27610 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27611 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27613 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27614 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27615 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27616 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27617 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27618 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27619 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27622 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27623 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27624 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27625 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27626 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27628 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27629 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27630 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27631 were not obtained from an MX record.
27633 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27634 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27635 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27636 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27637 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27641 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27642 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27643 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27644 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27645 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27646 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27647 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27648 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27649 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27650 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27651 failing for the first time.
27653 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27654 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27655 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27656 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27658 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27659 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27660 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27665 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27666 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27667 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27668 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27669 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27670 default retry rule:
27672 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27674 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27675 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27676 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27678 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27679 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27680 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27681 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27682 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27684 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27685 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27686 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27688 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27689 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27690 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27691 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27692 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27693 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27694 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27695 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27696 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27697 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27698 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27700 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27701 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27702 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27703 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27704 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27707 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27708 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27709 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27710 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27711 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27712 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27713 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27714 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27715 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27718 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27719 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27720 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27721 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27722 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27723 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27724 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27725 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27728 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27729 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27730 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27731 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27732 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27733 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27734 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27735 time out the address.
27737 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27738 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27739 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27740 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27741 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27742 considered immediately.
27743 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27744 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27752 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27754 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27755 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27756 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27757 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27758 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27760 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2554,RFC 2554),
27761 which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27762 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27763 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27764 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27767 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27768 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27771 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27772 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27773 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27776 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27777 the client's EHLO command.
27779 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27780 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27782 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27783 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27784 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27785 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27786 with the AUTH command.
27788 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27790 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27791 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27792 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27795 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27796 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27797 unauthenticated connection.
27800 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27801 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27802 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27803 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27805 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27806 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27807 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27808 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27809 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27810 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27811 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27812 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27817 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27818 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27819 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27820 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27821 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27822 included by setting
27825 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27829 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27834 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27835 authentication mechanism
27836 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195)),
27837 and the second provides an interface to the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27838 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27839 work via a socket interface.
27840 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27841 as defined by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
27842 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27843 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27844 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27845 supporting setting a server keytab.
27846 The seventh can be configured to support
27847 the PLAIN authentication mechanism
27848 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
27849 or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27850 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27851 The eighth authenticator
27852 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27853 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27854 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27856 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27857 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27858 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27859 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27860 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27861 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27862 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27864 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27865 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27866 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27867 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27868 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27869 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27873 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27874 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27876 client_secret = secret2
27878 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27879 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27881 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27882 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27883 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27886 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27887 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27888 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27889 authenticating data.
27891 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27892 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27893 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27894 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27895 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27896 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27897 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27898 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27899 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27900 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27903 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27904 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27905 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27906 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27910 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27911 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27912 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27914 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27915 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27916 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27917 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27918 encrypted by a setting such as:
27920 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27924 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27925 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27926 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27927 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27930 .option driver authenticators string unset
27931 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27932 authenticators is to be used.
27935 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27936 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27937 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27938 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens
27939 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)),
27940 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27941 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27944 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27945 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27946 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27947 mechanism is not advertised.
27948 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27949 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27950 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27953 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27954 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27955 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27958 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27959 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27961 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27962 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27963 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27964 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27965 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27966 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27967 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27968 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27969 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27973 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27974 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27975 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27976 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27977 out the values of variables.
27978 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27979 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27982 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27983 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27984 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27985 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27986 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27987 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27988 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27989 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27990 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27991 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27992 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27993 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27996 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27997 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27998 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27999 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
28000 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
28001 remembered for later use.
28002 How it is used is described in the following section.
28008 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
28009 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
28010 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28011 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
28012 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
28016 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
28017 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
28019 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
28021 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
28022 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
28023 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
28024 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
28025 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
28026 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
28027 given for the MAIL command.
28029 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
28030 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
28033 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
28034 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
28035 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
28036 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
28037 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
28038 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
28039 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
28044 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
28045 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
28046 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
28047 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
28049 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
28050 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
28051 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
28052 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
28053 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
28058 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
28059 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
28060 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
28061 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
28065 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
28067 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
28068 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
28071 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
28072 the mechanisms are advertised.
28074 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
28075 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
28076 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
28077 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
28078 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
28079 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
28080 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
28082 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
28084 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
28086 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
28087 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
28088 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
28091 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
28093 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28094 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
28095 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
28097 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
28098 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
28099 command. This is the case if
28102 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
28104 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
28106 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
28107 server authenticators.
28111 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
28112 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
28113 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
28115 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
28116 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
28117 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
28118 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
28119 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
28120 rejected with a 504 error.
28122 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
28123 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
28124 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
28125 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
28126 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
28127 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
28128 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
28129 no successful authentication.
28131 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
28132 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
28133 &%authresults%& expansion item.
28135 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
28136 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
28137 an event of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28138 While the event is being processed the variables
28139 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28140 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
28142 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
28143 instead of the default log line.
28144 See &<<CHAPevents>>& for details on events.
28147 .subsection "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
28148 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
28149 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
28150 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
28151 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
28152 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
28153 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
28157 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
28159 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
28160 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
28161 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
28162 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
28163 command line to run this script on such data might be
28165 encode '\0user\0password'
28167 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
28168 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
28169 whose code value is zero.
28171 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
28172 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
28173 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
28174 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
28176 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
28177 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
28178 example, a command such as
28180 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
28182 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
28184 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
28185 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
28187 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
28189 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
28190 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
28191 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
28192 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
28196 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
28197 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
28198 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
28199 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
28200 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
28201 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
28204 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
28205 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
28206 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
28207 of the authenticator.
28210 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28211 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
28212 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
28213 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
28214 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
28215 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
28216 delivery to be deferred.
28218 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
28219 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
28220 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
28224 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
28225 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
28226 an event of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28227 While the event is being processed the variable
28228 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28230 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
28231 See &<<CHAPevents>>& for details on events.
28234 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
28235 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
28236 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
28237 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
28238 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
28239 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
28240 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
28241 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
28242 deliver the message unauthenticated.
28245 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
28246 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
28247 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
28248 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
28249 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
28250 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
28251 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
28252 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
28254 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
28256 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28257 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
28258 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
28259 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
28260 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
28261 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
28262 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
28263 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
28264 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
28265 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
28266 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
28267 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
28268 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
28275 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28278 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
28279 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
28280 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
28281 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
28282 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
28283 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
28284 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
28285 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
28286 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
28287 connections as you do for login accounts.
28289 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
28290 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
28291 TLS is not being used:
28293 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
28294 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
28297 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
28298 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
28299 (including their names) have been properly verified.
28301 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
28302 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
28303 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
28305 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28306 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
28307 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
28309 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
28310 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
28311 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
28314 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
28315 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28316 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28317 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28318 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28319 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28320 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28322 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
28323 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28324 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28325 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
28326 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
28327 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
28328 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
28330 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
28331 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
28332 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28333 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28335 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
28336 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
28337 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
28339 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28340 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28341 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28342 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28343 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28344 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28345 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28346 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28347 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28348 string as the error text.
28350 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28351 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28352 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28356 .subsection "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28357 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28358 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28359 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28360 The PLAIN authentication mechanism
28361 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
28362 specifies that three strings be
28363 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28364 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28365 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28367 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28368 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28369 configured as follows:
28373 public_name = PLAIN
28375 server_condition = \
28376 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28377 server_set_id = $auth2
28379 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28380 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28381 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28382 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28384 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28385 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28386 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28387 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28391 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28393 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28395 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28396 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28400 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28401 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28403 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28404 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28405 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28406 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28407 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28409 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28410 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28411 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28413 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28414 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28415 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28416 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28417 This is an incorrect example:
28419 server_condition = \
28420 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28422 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28423 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28424 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28425 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28426 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28427 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28428 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28430 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28431 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28433 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28434 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28435 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28436 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28437 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28440 .subsection "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28441 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28442 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28443 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28444 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28445 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28446 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28450 public_name = LOGIN
28451 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28452 server_condition = \
28453 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28454 server_set_id = $auth1
28456 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28457 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28458 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28459 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28461 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28462 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28463 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28464 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28465 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28469 public_name = LOGIN
28470 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28471 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28474 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28475 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28476 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28477 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28479 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28480 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28481 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28482 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28483 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28484 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28485 uninterpreted string.
28488 .subsection "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28489 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28490 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28491 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28492 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28498 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28499 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28500 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28502 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28503 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28504 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28505 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28508 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28509 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28510 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28511 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28512 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28513 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28514 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28515 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28516 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28517 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28518 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28519 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28521 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28522 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28524 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28525 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28526 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28527 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28530 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28531 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28535 public_name = PLAIN
28536 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28538 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28539 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28540 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28541 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28545 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28549 public_name = LOGIN
28550 client_send = : username : mysecret
28552 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28553 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28555 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28556 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28561 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28564 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28565 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28566 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28567 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28568 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28569 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in
28570 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195). The server
28571 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28572 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28573 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28574 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28575 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28576 available in plain text at either end.
28579 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28580 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28581 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28582 authenticator as a server:
28584 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28585 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28586 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28587 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28588 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28589 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28590 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28591 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28592 returned to the client.
28594 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28595 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28596 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28597 numeric variables for other things.
28599 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28600 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28601 user name, authentication fails.
28605 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28606 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28607 server_set_id = $auth1
28609 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28610 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28611 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28612 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28616 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28617 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28619 server_set_id = $auth1
28621 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28622 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28624 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28625 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28626 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28631 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28632 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28633 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28634 server_set_id = $auth1
28637 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28638 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28639 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28643 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28644 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28645 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28648 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28649 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28650 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28654 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28655 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28656 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28657 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28658 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28659 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28660 send the message to the current server.
28662 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28667 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28669 client_secret = secret
28671 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28672 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28679 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28680 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28681 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28682 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28684 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28685 at A L Digital Ltd.
28687 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28688 library implementation of the
28689 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)
28690 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28691 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28692 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28693 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28695 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28696 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28697 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28698 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28700 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28701 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28702 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28703 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28704 depending on the driver you are using.
28706 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28707 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28708 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28709 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28710 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28713 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28714 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28715 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28716 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28717 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28718 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28719 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28720 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28723 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28724 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28725 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28726 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28727 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28728 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28732 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28733 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28734 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28735 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28738 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28739 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28740 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28741 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28745 driver = cyrus_sasl
28746 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28747 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28748 server_set_id = $auth1
28751 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28752 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28755 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28756 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28759 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28760 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28761 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28762 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28765 driver = cyrus_sasl
28766 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28767 server_set_id = $auth1
28770 driver = cyrus_sasl
28771 public_name = PLAIN
28772 server_set_id = $auth2
28774 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28775 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28776 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28777 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28778 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28783 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28784 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28785 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28786 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28787 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28788 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28789 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28790 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28791 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28792 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28793 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28795 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28797 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28798 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28799 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28800 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28804 public_name = PLAIN
28805 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28806 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28807 server_set_id = $auth1
28812 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28813 server_set_id = $auth1
28816 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28817 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28818 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28820 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28821 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28822 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28823 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28824 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28825 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28827 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28830 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28835 unix_listener auth-client {
28842 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28844 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28847 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28848 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28851 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28852 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28853 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28854 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28855 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28856 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28857 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28858 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28859 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28860 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28861 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28862 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28863 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28864 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28865 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28866 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28867 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28868 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28869 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28870 without code changes in Exim.
28872 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28873 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28874 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28877 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28878 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28879 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28882 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28883 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28884 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28885 by &%client_username%& option.
28886 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28887 which is the common case.
28889 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28890 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28892 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28893 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28894 the password to be used, in clear.
28896 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28897 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28898 the account name to be used.
28901 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28902 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28903 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28905 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28906 and correctly sized
28907 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28908 The value after expansion should be
28909 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28910 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28912 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28913 supplied by the server.
28914 The option is expanded before use.
28915 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28916 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28917 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28919 The intent of this option
28920 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28921 to save on recalculation costs.
28922 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28923 (eg. an empty string)
28924 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28926 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28927 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28928 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28929 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28930 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28933 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28934 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28935 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28936 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28937 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28940 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28941 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28942 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28945 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28946 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28947 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28949 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28950 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28951 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28953 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28954 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28955 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28957 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28958 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28959 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28960 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28963 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28964 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28965 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28966 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28969 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28970 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28971 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28972 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28977 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28978 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28979 server_set_id = $auth1
28983 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28984 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28985 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28986 the password itself.
28988 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28989 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28990 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28991 if available, else the empty string.
28992 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28993 else the empty string.
28995 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28997 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28998 option to be simply "true".
29001 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
29002 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
29003 Some mechanisms will use this data.
29006 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
29007 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
29008 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
29009 when this option is expanded.
29011 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
29012 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
29013 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
29014 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
29015 either the iteration count or the salt).
29016 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
29017 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
29019 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
29020 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
29021 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
29022 when this option is expanded.
29023 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
29024 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
29025 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
29026 protocol conversation.
29029 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
29030 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
29031 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
29032 to provide stored information related to a password,
29033 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
29035 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
29036 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
29038 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
29039 When this is so, the macros
29040 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
29041 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
29044 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
29046 If set, the results of expansion should for each
29047 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
29048 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
29049 &%server_password%& option.
29050 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
29052 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
29053 to generate these values.
29056 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
29057 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
29058 Some mechanisms will use this data.
29061 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
29062 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29063 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
29064 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
29066 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
29067 meanings for these variables:
29070 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
29071 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
29073 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
29074 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
29076 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
29077 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
29080 On a per-mechanism basis:
29083 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
29084 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
29085 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29087 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
29088 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
29089 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29091 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
29092 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
29093 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
29094 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29097 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
29098 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
29099 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
29102 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
29103 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
29105 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
29107 public_name = CRAM-MD5
29108 server_realm = imap.example.org
29109 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
29110 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
29111 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
29112 server_condition = yes
29116 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29117 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29119 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
29120 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
29121 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
29122 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
29123 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
29124 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
29125 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
29128 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
29129 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
29130 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
29131 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
29133 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
29134 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
29135 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
29136 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
29138 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
29139 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
29140 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
29144 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
29145 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
29146 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
29147 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
29149 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
29150 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
29151 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
29152 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
29154 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29156 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
29157 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
29159 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
29160 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
29161 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
29166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29169 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
29170 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
29171 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
29172 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
29173 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
29174 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
29175 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
29176 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
29177 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
29178 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
29179 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
29180 taken from the &url(https://www.samba.org/,Samba project). The code for the
29181 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
29185 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
29186 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
29188 The server sends back a challenge.
29190 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
29191 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
29194 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
29198 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
29199 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
29200 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
29202 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
29203 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
29204 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
29205 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
29206 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
29207 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
29208 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
29209 for other things. For example:
29214 server_password = \
29215 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
29217 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29218 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29224 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
29225 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
29226 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
29230 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
29231 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
29234 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
29235 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
29238 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
29239 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
29240 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
29246 client_username = msn/msn_username
29247 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
29248 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
29250 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
29251 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
29257 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29258 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29260 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
29261 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
29262 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
29263 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29264 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29265 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29266 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
29267 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
29268 The specification is in
29269 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
29270 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
29271 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
29272 by the server configuration.
29274 The client presents an identity in-clear.
29275 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
29276 and for clients to only attempt,
29277 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
29279 One possible use, compatible with the
29280 &url(https://k9mail.github.io/,K-9 Mail Android client)
29281 is for using X509 client certificates.
29283 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
29284 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
29285 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
29286 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
29287 client certificates only.
29289 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
29290 client-certificate authentication is being done.
29292 The client must present a certificate,
29293 for which it must have been requested via the
29294 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29295 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29296 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
29297 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
29299 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
29300 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
29301 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
29303 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
29304 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
29305 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29306 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
29307 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
29308 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29309 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29311 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
29313 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
29314 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29315 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
29316 "in &(external)& authenticator"
29317 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29318 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29320 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
29321 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
29322 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
29323 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
29324 an identity for authentication and
29325 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
29327 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
29328 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
29329 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
29330 string expansions that also use them for other things.
29332 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29333 Once an identity has been received,
29334 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
29335 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
29336 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
29337 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
29338 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
29339 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
29340 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
29341 string as the error text.
29345 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29347 public_name = EXTERNAL
29349 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29350 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29351 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29352 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29353 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29354 server_set_id = $auth1
29356 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29357 of your configured trust-anchors
29358 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29359 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29361 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29362 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29363 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29367 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29368 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29369 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29371 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29372 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29373 identity being asserted.
29379 public_name = EXTERNAL
29381 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29382 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29386 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29387 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29396 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29397 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29398 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29399 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29400 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29401 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29402 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29403 authentication based on client certificates.
29405 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29406 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29407 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29408 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29409 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29410 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29412 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29413 for which it must have been requested via the
29414 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29415 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29417 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29418 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29419 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29420 and can authenticate the connection.
29421 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29423 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29426 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29427 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29429 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29430 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29431 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29432 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29433 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29434 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29436 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29437 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29438 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29440 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29447 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29448 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29449 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29452 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29453 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29454 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29456 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29458 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29459 of your configured trust-anchors
29460 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29461 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29463 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29464 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29465 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29467 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29469 . An alternative might use
29471 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29473 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29474 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29475 . This would help for per-device use.
29477 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29478 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29480 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29481 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29484 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29485 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29486 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29490 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29493 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29494 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29495 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29496 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29497 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29500 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29501 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29502 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29503 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29504 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29505 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29506 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29507 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29508 certificates are used.
29510 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3207,RFC 3207)
29511 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29512 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29513 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29514 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29515 between them is encrypted.
29517 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29518 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29519 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29520 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29523 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29524 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29525 in order to get TLS to work.
29529 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29531 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29532 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29533 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29534 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29535 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29536 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29537 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29539 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314),
29540 the common practice of using the historically
29541 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29542 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29543 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29545 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29546 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29547 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29549 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29550 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29551 reassigned for other use.
29552 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29554 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29555 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29556 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29558 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29559 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29560 the most common use is expected to be:
29562 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29564 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29565 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29566 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29567 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29568 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29571 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29572 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29579 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29580 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29581 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29582 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29588 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29594 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29595 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29597 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29600 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29601 cannot be the path of a directory
29602 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29603 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29605 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29607 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29608 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29609 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29610 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with
29611 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2253,RFC 2253). This
29612 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29614 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29615 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29616 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29617 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29618 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29619 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29620 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29623 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29624 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29626 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29627 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29628 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29629 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29631 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29632 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29634 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29635 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29636 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29637 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29639 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29641 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29645 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29646 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29647 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29648 but not the chosen filename.
29649 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29650 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29652 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29653 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29654 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29655 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29657 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29658 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29659 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29660 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29661 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29662 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29663 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29665 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29666 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29667 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29668 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29669 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29671 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29672 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29673 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29674 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29675 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29676 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29678 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29679 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29680 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29682 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29683 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29684 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29685 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29688 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29691 # chown exim:exim new-params
29692 # chmod 0600 new-params
29693 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29694 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29695 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29696 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29697 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29698 # chmod 0400 new-params
29699 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29701 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29702 stalling is removed.
29704 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29705 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29706 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29707 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29708 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29709 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29710 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29711 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29712 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29713 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29714 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29716 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29717 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29718 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29719 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29721 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29722 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29723 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29724 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29725 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29728 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29729 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29730 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29731 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29732 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29733 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29734 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29735 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29736 directly to this function call.
29737 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29738 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29739 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29740 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29743 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29745 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29746 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29747 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29750 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29751 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29752 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29756 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29759 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29760 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29763 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29764 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29766 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29767 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29770 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29771 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29772 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29773 not be moved to the end of the list.
29776 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29779 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29780 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29783 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29784 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29785 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29786 choice of clients used:
29788 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29789 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29794 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29796 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29799 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29800 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29801 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29802 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29804 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29806 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29810 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29812 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29813 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29814 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29815 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29816 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29817 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29818 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29819 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29820 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29821 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29823 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29824 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29826 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29827 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29828 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29829 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29830 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29831 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29833 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29834 "Priority strings". This is online as
29835 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29836 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29837 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29838 then the example code
29839 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29840 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29844 # Disable older versions of protocols
29845 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29848 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29849 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29850 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29852 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29853 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29854 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29855 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29859 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29865 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29866 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29867 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29868 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29869 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29870 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29871 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29872 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29874 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29875 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29877 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29878 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29879 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29882 554 Security failure
29884 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29885 rejected with a 554 error code.
29887 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29888 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29890 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29891 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29892 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29893 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29895 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29897 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29899 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29900 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29902 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29903 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29904 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29905 that goes with it. These files need to be
29906 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29907 always be given as full path names.
29908 The key must not be password-protected.
29909 They can be the same file if both the
29910 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29911 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29912 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29913 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29914 the server's certificate.
29916 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29917 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29918 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29919 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29920 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29921 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29923 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29924 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29925 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29927 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29928 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29929 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29932 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29933 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29934 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29936 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29938 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29939 with the parameters contained in the file.
29940 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29945 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29946 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29947 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29948 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29954 for a way of generating file data.
29956 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29957 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29958 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29959 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29960 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29962 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29963 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29964 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29965 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29966 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29967 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29968 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29969 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29970 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29972 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29973 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29974 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29975 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29976 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29977 documentation for more details.
29979 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29980 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29983 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29984 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29985 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29986 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29987 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29988 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29989 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29990 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29991 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29992 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29993 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29994 an explicit file or,
29995 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29996 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29998 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
30001 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
30002 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
30003 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
30005 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
30007 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
30009 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
30010 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
30012 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
30013 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
30014 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
30015 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
30016 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
30017 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
30018 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
30019 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
30020 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
30021 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
30023 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
30024 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
30025 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
30026 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
30028 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
30029 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
30030 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
30031 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
30032 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
30033 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
30036 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
30037 .cindex certificate caching
30038 .cindex privatekey caching
30039 .cindex crl caching
30040 .cindex ocsp caching
30041 .cindex ciphers caching
30042 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
30043 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
30044 .cindex tls_certificate caching
30045 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
30046 .cindex tls_crl caching
30047 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
30048 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
30049 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
30050 .cindex caching certificate
30051 .cindex caching privatekey
30052 .cindex caching crl
30053 .cindex caching ocsp
30054 .cindex caching ciphers
30055 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
30056 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
30057 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
30058 expandable elements,
30059 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
30060 It is made available
30061 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
30063 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
30065 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
30066 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
30067 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
30069 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
30070 containing files specified by these options.
30072 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30073 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
30074 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
30075 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
30076 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
30077 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
30078 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
30079 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
30081 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
30082 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
30084 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
30085 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30091 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
30092 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
30093 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
30094 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
30095 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
30096 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
30097 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
30098 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
30099 within the &(smtp)& transport.
30101 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
30102 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
30103 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
30104 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
30105 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
30106 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
30108 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
30109 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
30110 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
30111 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
30112 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
30115 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
30116 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
30117 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
30118 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
30119 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
30120 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
30121 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
30122 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
30123 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
30124 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
30127 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
30128 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
30130 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
30132 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
30133 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
30135 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
30136 for client use (they are usable for server use).
30137 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
30138 in failed connections.
30140 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
30141 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
30143 the system default set (depending on library version),
30145 or (depending on library version) a directory.
30146 The client verifies the server's certificate
30147 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
30148 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
30149 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
30150 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
30152 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
30153 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
30154 or need not succeed respectively.
30156 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
30157 name checks are made on the server certificate.
30158 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
30159 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
30160 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
30161 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
30162 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
30163 The option defaults to always checking.
30165 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
30166 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
30167 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
30169 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
30170 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
30171 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
30174 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
30175 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
30176 for OCSP to be relevant.
30179 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
30180 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
30181 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
30182 alternative hosts, if any.
30185 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
30186 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
30187 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
30191 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
30192 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
30193 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
30194 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
30195 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
30197 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
30198 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
30199 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
30200 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
30201 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
30202 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
30203 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
30204 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
30205 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
30206 outgoing connection.
30210 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
30211 .cindex certificate caching
30212 .cindex privatekey caching
30213 .cindex crl caching
30214 .cindex ciphers caching
30215 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
30216 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
30217 .cindex tls_certificate caching
30218 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
30219 .cindex tls_crl caching
30220 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
30221 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
30222 .cindex caching certificate
30223 .cindex caching privatekey
30224 .cindex caching crl
30225 .cindex caching ciphers
30226 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
30227 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
30228 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
30229 expandable elements,
30230 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
30231 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
30232 command-line specified message delivery.
30233 It is made available
30234 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
30236 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
30238 If caching is not possible, the load
30239 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
30241 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
30242 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
30243 containing files specified by these options.
30245 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30246 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
30247 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
30248 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
30249 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
30250 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
30251 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
30252 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
30254 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
30255 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
30257 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
30258 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30264 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
30265 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
30268 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
30269 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
30270 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
30271 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
30272 extensions, documented in
30273 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6066,RFC 6066)
30274 (and before that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4366,RFC 4366)) is
30275 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
30276 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
30277 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
30280 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
30281 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
30284 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
30285 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
30286 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
30287 be of limited use in that environment.
30289 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
30290 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
30291 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
30292 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
30293 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
30295 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
30296 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
30297 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
30298 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
30299 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
30301 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
30302 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
30304 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
30305 received from a client.
30306 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
30308 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
30309 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
30310 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
30313 &%tls_certificate%&
30319 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30324 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
30325 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
30326 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
30327 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
30328 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
30329 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
30330 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
30332 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
30335 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
30336 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
30337 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
30338 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
30340 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
30341 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
30342 built, then you have SNI support).
30346 .cindex ALPN "general information"
30347 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
30348 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
30349 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
30350 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30352 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30353 the server responds with a selected one.
30354 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30355 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30356 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30357 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30358 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30360 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30361 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30362 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30363 There are no variables providing observability.
30364 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30365 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30366 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30368 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30369 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30370 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30374 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30376 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30377 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30378 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30379 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30380 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30381 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30382 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30383 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30384 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30385 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30387 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30388 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30389 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30390 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30391 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30392 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30393 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30395 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30396 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30397 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30398 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30399 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30400 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30401 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30402 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30403 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30405 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30406 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30407 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30408 information is recorded.
30410 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30411 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30412 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30417 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30418 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30419 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30420 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30421 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30422 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30424 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30425 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30426 document is currently at
30428 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30430 and their FAQ is at
30432 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30435 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30436 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30438 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30439 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30440 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30441 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30444 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30445 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30446 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30447 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30448 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30449 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30450 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30451 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30452 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30453 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30454 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30455 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30456 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30458 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30459 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30460 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30461 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30465 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30466 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30467 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30468 with OpenSSL, like this:
30469 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30470 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30472 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30475 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30476 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30477 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30478 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30479 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30480 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30481 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30483 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30484 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30485 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30486 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30487 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30488 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30490 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30491 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30492 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30493 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30494 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30495 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30496 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30497 be a sensible resolution).
30499 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30500 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30501 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30503 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30504 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30505 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30506 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30507 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30508 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30510 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30511 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30512 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30513 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30516 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30517 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30518 .cindex "revocation list"
30519 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30520 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30521 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30525 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30526 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30527 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30528 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30529 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30531 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30532 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30535 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30536 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30537 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30538 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30539 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30540 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30542 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30543 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30544 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30545 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30548 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30549 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30550 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30551 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30552 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30553 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30554 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30555 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30557 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30558 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30559 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30561 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30562 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30563 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30564 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30565 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30567 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30568 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30569 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30570 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30571 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30574 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30575 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30578 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30579 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30580 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30581 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30582 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30583 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30585 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30586 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30588 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30591 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30592 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30593 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30595 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30596 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30597 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30602 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30603 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30606 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30607 .cindex TLS resumption
30608 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30609 in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5077,RFC 5077) for 1.2).
30610 The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 (or later).
30612 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30613 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30614 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30615 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30616 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30619 Operational cost/benefit:
30621 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30622 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30624 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30625 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30626 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30627 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30628 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30629 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30632 .cindex "hints database" tls
30633 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30634 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30639 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30640 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30641 all connections using the resumed session.
30642 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30643 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30644 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30645 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30646 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30648 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30649 used for session negotiation.
30654 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30657 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30658 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30659 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30660 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30661 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30666 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30667 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30668 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30669 Commonly this can be done like this:
30671 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30673 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30674 is offered and/or accepted.
30676 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30677 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30678 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30679 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30680 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30686 In a resumed session:
30688 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30689 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30691 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30692 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30693 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30699 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30701 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30702 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30703 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30704 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30705 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30706 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30708 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30709 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30710 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30712 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30713 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30715 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30716 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30717 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30719 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30721 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30722 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30723 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30726 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30728 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30731 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30732 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30733 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30734 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30736 .subsection "DNS records"
30737 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30738 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30739 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30740 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30742 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30743 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30744 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30745 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30746 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30747 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30749 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30750 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30751 does require careful arrangement.
30752 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30753 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30754 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30755 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30756 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30758 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30759 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30761 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30762 "MTA-STS", described below.
30764 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30765 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30766 connections to you.
30767 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30768 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30769 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30770 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30771 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30772 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30774 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30775 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30776 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30777 random serial numbers.
30778 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30779 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30780 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30781 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30783 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30784 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30786 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30789 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30790 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30795 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30797 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30800 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30803 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30804 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30807 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30809 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30810 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30811 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30812 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30814 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30815 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30817 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30818 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30819 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30820 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30823 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30824 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30828 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30829 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30830 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30831 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30832 control the OCSP request.
30834 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30835 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30838 .subsection "Client configuration"
30839 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30840 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30841 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30842 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30843 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30845 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30847 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30848 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30849 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30850 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30852 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30853 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30854 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30855 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30856 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30857 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30858 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30860 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30864 tls_try_verify_hosts
30865 tls_verify_certificates
30867 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30871 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30872 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30874 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30875 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30877 .subsection Observability
30878 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30880 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30881 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30882 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30883 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30885 .cindex DANE reporting
30886 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30887 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30888 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30889 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30890 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30891 Section 4.3 of that document.
30893 .subsection General
30894 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30896 DANE is specified in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6698,RFC 6698).
30897 It decouples certificate authority trust
30898 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30900 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30902 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS
30903 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8461,RFC 8461)), which
30904 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30905 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30906 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30909 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30910 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30911 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30914 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30915 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30916 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30918 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30919 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30920 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30921 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30922 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30923 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30924 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30928 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30929 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30931 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30932 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30933 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30934 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30935 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30936 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30937 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30938 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30939 one very small ACL:
30943 accept hosts = one.host.only
30945 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30946 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30948 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30949 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30950 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30951 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30952 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30953 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30954 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30955 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30958 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30959 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30960 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30963 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30964 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30965 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30966 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30967 .cindex "ATRN" "ACL for"
30968 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30969 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30970 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30971 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30972 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30973 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30974 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30975 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30976 .cindex "QUIT" "ACL for"
30977 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30978 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30979 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30980 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30981 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30982 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30983 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30984 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30987 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30988 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30989 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30990 .irow &%acl_smtp_atrn%& "ACL for ATRN"
30991 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30992 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30993 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30994 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30995 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30996 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30997 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30998 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30999 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
31000 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
31001 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
31002 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
31003 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
31004 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
31005 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
31006 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
31007 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
31008 .irow &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
31011 For example, if you set
31013 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
31015 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
31016 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
31017 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
31018 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
31019 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
31020 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
31021 testing as possible at RCPT time.
31024 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECnonSMTP
31025 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
31026 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
31027 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
31028 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
31029 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
31030 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
31031 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
31032 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
31033 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
31034 in any of these ACLs.
31036 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
31037 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
31038 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
31039 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
31040 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
31041 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
31042 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
31043 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
31045 control = suppress_local_fixups
31047 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
31048 run, it is too late.
31050 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31051 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31053 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
31054 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
31055 temporary error for these kinds of message.
31058 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECconnectACL
31059 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
31060 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
31061 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
31062 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
31063 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
31064 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
31065 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
31066 &%smtp_banner%& option.
31068 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
31069 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
31070 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
31073 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECheloACL
31074 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
31075 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
31076 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
31077 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
31078 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
31079 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
31080 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
31081 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
31083 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
31084 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
31085 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
31087 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
31088 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
31089 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
31090 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
31094 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECdataACLS
31095 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
31096 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
31097 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
31098 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
31099 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
31100 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
31101 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
31102 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
31103 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
31105 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
31106 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
31107 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
31108 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
31109 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
31110 associated with the DATA command.
31112 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
31113 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
31114 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
31115 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
31116 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
31117 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
31118 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
31119 the data specified is received.
31121 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
31122 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
31123 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
31124 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
31125 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
31128 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
31129 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
31130 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
31131 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
31133 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
31134 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
31135 enabled (which is the default).
31137 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
31138 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
31139 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
31141 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
31142 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
31143 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
31145 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31147 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31150 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
31151 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31152 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31154 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31157 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
31158 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
31159 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
31160 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31161 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
31162 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
31163 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
31166 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
31167 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
31168 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
31169 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
31170 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
31171 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
31172 for some or all recipients.
31174 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
31175 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
31176 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
31177 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
31178 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
31180 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
31181 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
31182 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
31184 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
31185 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
31187 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31188 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
31189 the feature was not requested by the client.
31191 .subsection "The SMTP WELLKNOWN ACL" SECTWELLKNOWNACL
31192 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
31193 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_wellknown%&"
31194 The &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31195 with WELLKNOWN support enabled.
31197 The ACL determines the response to an SMTP WELLKNOWN command, using the normal
31198 accept/defer/deny verbs for the response code,
31199 and a new &"control=wellknown"& modifier.
31200 This modifier takes a single option, separated by a '/'
31201 character, which must be the name of a file containing the response
31202 cleartext. The modifier is expanded before use in the usual way before
31203 it is used. The configuration is responsible for picking a suitable file
31204 to return and, most importantly, not returning any unexpected file.
31205 The argument for the SMTP verb will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
31206 variable and can be used for building the file path.
31207 If the file path given in the modifier is empty or inacessible, the control will
31213 accept control = wellknown/\
31214 ${lookup {${xtextd:$smtp_command_argument}} \
31215 dsearch,key=path,filter=file,ret=full \
31216 {$spooldir/wellknown.d}}
31218 File content will be encoded in &"xtext"& form, and line-wrapping
31219 for line-length limitation will be done before transmission.
31220 A response summary line will be prepended, with the (pre-encoding) file size.
31222 The above example uses the expansion operator ${xtextd:<coded-string>}
31223 which is needed to decode the xtext-encoded key from the SMTP verb.
31225 Under the util directory there is a "mailtest" utility which can be used
31226 to test/retrieve WELLKNOWN items. Syntax is
31228 mailtest -h host.example.com -w security.txt
31231 WELLKNOWN is a ESMTP extension providing access to extended
31232 information about the server. It is modelled on the webserver
31233 facilities documented in
31234 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8615,RFC 8615)
31235 and can be used for a security.txt file
31236 and could be used for ACME handshaking
31237 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8555,RFC 8555)).
31239 Exim will advertise WELLKNOWN support in the EHLO response
31240 .oindex &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&
31241 (conditional on a new option &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&)
31242 and service WELLKNOWN smtp verbs having a single parameter
31243 giving a key for an item of "site-wide metadata".
31244 The verb and key are separated by whitespace,
31245 and the key is xtext-encoded
31246 (per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
31249 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
31250 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
31251 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
31252 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
31253 does not in fact control any access.
31254 For this reason, it may only accept
31255 or warn as its final result.
31257 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
31258 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
31259 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
31260 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
31262 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
31263 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
31265 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
31266 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
31269 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
31270 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
31271 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
31272 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
31273 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
31276 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
31277 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
31278 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
31279 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
31280 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
31281 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
31282 situation even worse.
31284 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
31285 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
31286 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
31289 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
31290 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
31291 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
31292 connection. The possible values are:
31294 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
31295 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
31296 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
31297 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
31298 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
31299 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
31300 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
31301 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
31302 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
31303 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
31305 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
31306 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
31307 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
31308 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
31309 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
31313 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
31314 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
31315 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
31316 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
31318 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
31319 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
31321 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
31323 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4409,RFC 4409)
31324 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and an
31325 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
31326 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
31327 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
31328 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
31330 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
31331 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
31332 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
31335 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
31336 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
31337 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
31338 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
31339 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
31340 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
31342 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
31343 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
31344 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
31346 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
31347 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
31348 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
31349 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
31351 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
31352 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
31353 matches the string.
31355 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
31356 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
31357 want to have something like
31359 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
31361 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
31362 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
31368 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
31369 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
31370 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
31371 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
31372 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
31373 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
31374 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
31375 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
31376 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
31378 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
31379 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
31380 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
31383 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
31384 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
31385 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
31386 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
31388 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
31389 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
31390 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
31391 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
31392 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
31393 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
31394 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
31396 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
31397 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
31400 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
31401 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
31402 recipients; it may create new recipients.
31406 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
31407 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
31408 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
31409 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
31410 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
31411 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
31413 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
31414 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
31415 used to accept or reject anything.
31417 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31418 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31419 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31420 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31423 For the others (&%acl_smtp_atrn%&,
31425 &%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&,
31426 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& and &%acl_smtp_wellknown%&),
31427 the action when the ACL
31428 is not defined is &"deny"&. This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be
31429 defined in order to receive any messages over an SMTP connection.
31430 For an example, see the ACL in the default configuration file.
31434 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31435 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31437 .vindex &$local_part$&
31438 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31439 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31440 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31441 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31442 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31443 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31444 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31445 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31446 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31448 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31449 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31450 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31453 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31454 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31455 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31456 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31457 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31460 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31461 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31462 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31463 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31464 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31465 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31466 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31467 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31473 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31474 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31475 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31476 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31477 When an ACL is being run for ATRN, AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31478 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31479 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31480 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31481 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31482 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31483 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31484 unencrypted connections.
31487 accept encrypted = *
31488 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31490 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31492 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31493 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31494 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31495 option to do this.)
31499 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31500 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31501 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31502 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31503 Each statement starts
31504 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31505 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31506 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31508 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31509 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31510 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31513 deny dnslists = list1.example
31514 dnslists = list2.example
31516 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31517 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31518 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31519 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31520 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31522 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31523 or a different configuration section starts.
31526 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31527 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31530 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31531 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31532 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31533 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31534 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31535 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31536 check a RCPT command:
31538 accept domains = +local_domains
31542 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31543 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31544 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31545 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31548 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31549 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31550 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31553 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31554 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31555 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31556 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31557 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31558 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31560 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31561 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31563 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31564 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31565 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31567 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31568 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31569 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31574 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31575 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31576 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31577 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31578 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31579 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31580 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31584 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31585 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31586 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31589 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31591 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31595 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31596 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31597 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31598 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31599 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31600 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31601 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31602 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31603 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31605 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31606 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31607 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31611 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31612 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31613 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31615 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31616 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31618 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31619 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31622 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31623 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31624 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31625 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31627 require message = Sender did not verify
31630 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31631 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31632 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31633 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31636 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31637 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31638 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31639 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31640 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31641 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31642 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31644 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31645 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31646 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31647 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31648 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31650 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31651 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31652 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31653 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31654 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31655 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31659 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31660 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31661 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31662 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31664 warn !verify = sender
31665 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31669 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31671 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31672 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31673 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31674 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31675 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31679 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31680 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31681 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31682 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31683 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31684 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31685 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31686 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31687 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31688 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31690 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31691 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31692 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31693 on the same SMTP connection.
31695 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31696 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31697 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31700 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31701 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31702 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31704 accept hosts = whatever
31705 set acl_m4 = some value
31706 accept authenticated = *
31707 set acl_c_auth = yes
31709 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31710 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31711 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31713 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31714 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31715 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31716 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31717 error is generated.
31719 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31720 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31723 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31724 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31725 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31726 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31728 deny domains = *.dom.example
31729 !verify = recipient
31731 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31732 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31733 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31734 two statements are equivalent:
31736 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31737 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31739 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31740 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31742 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31743 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31744 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31746 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31747 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31748 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31749 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31751 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31752 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31753 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31754 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31755 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31756 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31757 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31759 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31760 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31761 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31762 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31763 message is handled.
31765 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31766 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31767 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31768 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31770 require message = Can't verify sender
31772 message = Can't verify recipient
31774 message = This message cannot be used
31776 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31777 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31778 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31779 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31780 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31781 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31783 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31784 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31785 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31786 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31789 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31790 message = Invalid sender from client host
31792 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31793 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31797 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31798 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31799 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31802 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31803 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31804 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31805 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31807 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31808 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31809 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31810 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31811 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31812 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31813 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31814 write rather ugly lines like this:
31816 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31818 Instead, all you need is
31820 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31823 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31824 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31825 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31826 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31827 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31828 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31829 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31830 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31832 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31833 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31834 in several different ways. For example:
31836 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31837 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31838 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31842 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31844 accept ...some conditions
31847 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31848 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31851 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31853 accept ...some conditions...
31855 ...some more conditions...
31857 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31858 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31859 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31863 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31864 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31867 warn ...some conditions...
31871 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31872 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31876 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31877 &%require%& verb. For example:
31879 require control = no_multiline_responses
31883 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31884 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31886 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31887 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31888 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31889 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31890 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31891 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31893 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31896 deny ...some conditions...
31899 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31900 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31903 ...some conditions...
31905 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31906 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31908 warn ...some conditions...
31914 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31915 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31916 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31917 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31918 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31919 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31920 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31924 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31925 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31926 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31927 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31928 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31929 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31930 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31933 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31934 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31935 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31936 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31938 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31939 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31941 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31944 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31945 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31947 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31948 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31949 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31952 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31953 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31954 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31955 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31956 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31957 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31960 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31961 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31962 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31965 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31966 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31967 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31968 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31969 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31970 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31972 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31973 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31974 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31975 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31976 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31977 logging rejections.
31980 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31981 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31982 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31983 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31984 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31985 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31986 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31987 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31989 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31990 &` log_reject_target =`&
31992 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31993 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31997 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31998 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31999 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
32000 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
32001 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
32002 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
32003 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
32006 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
32007 &` control = freeze`&
32008 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
32010 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
32011 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
32012 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
32015 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
32016 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
32020 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32021 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
32022 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
32023 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
32024 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
32025 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
32026 &%accept%& for details.)
32028 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
32029 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
32030 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
32031 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
32032 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
32034 require message = Host not recognized
32037 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
32040 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
32041 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
32042 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
32043 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
32044 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
32045 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
32046 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
32047 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
32048 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
32051 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
32052 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
32053 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
32055 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
32056 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
32058 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
32059 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
32060 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
32063 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
32064 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
32066 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
32067 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
32069 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
32071 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
32072 on word boundaries if possible.
32074 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32075 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
32076 contains any message previously set.
32077 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
32079 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
32080 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
32081 However, the original message is available in the variable
32082 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
32083 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
32084 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
32085 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
32087 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
32088 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
32089 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
32090 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
32091 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
32092 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
32096 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32097 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
32098 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
32099 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
32101 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
32103 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
32104 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
32105 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
32106 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
32109 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32110 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
32111 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
32112 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
32115 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
32116 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
32117 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
32118 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
32121 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
32122 .cindex "UDP communications"
32123 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
32124 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
32125 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
32126 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
32127 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
32128 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
32129 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
32132 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
32133 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
32140 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
32141 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
32142 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
32145 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
32146 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
32147 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
32148 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
32149 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
32150 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
32151 not work without it. For example:
32153 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
32154 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
32156 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
32157 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
32158 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
32159 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
32160 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
32163 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
32164 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
32165 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
32166 .cindex "case of local parts"
32167 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32168 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
32169 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
32170 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
32171 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
32172 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
32175 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
32176 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
32177 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
32178 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
32179 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
32181 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
32182 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
32185 warn control = caseful_local_part
32186 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
32188 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
32190 control = caselower_local_part
32192 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
32193 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
32196 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
32197 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
32198 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
32199 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
32201 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
32202 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
32203 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
32204 is used for all recipients of the message,
32205 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
32206 and data is copied from one to the other.
32208 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
32209 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
32210 If a recipient-verify callout
32212 connection is subsequently
32213 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
32214 any subsequent recipients and the data,
32215 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
32217 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
32218 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
32219 Note also that headers cannot be
32220 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
32221 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
32222 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
32223 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
32224 this will affect the timestamp.
32226 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
32227 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
32228 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
32229 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
32232 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
32233 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
32234 before the entire message has been received from the source.
32235 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
32239 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
32240 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
32241 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
32242 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
32243 before the acceptance "<=" line.
32245 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
32247 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
32248 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
32249 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
32250 and does not queue the message.
32251 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
32253 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
32255 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
32258 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
32259 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
32260 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
32261 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
32262 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
32263 by default called &'debuglog'&.
32265 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
32267 Options are a slash-separated list.
32268 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
32269 an equals character.
32270 Several options are supported:
32272 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
32273 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
32274 is appended to the default name.
32276 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
32277 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
32279 stop Logging started with this control may be
32280 stopped by using this option.
32282 kill Logging started with this control may be
32283 stopped by using this option.
32284 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
32285 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
32287 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
32288 for pre-trigger debug capture.
32289 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
32290 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
32291 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
32292 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
32293 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
32295 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
32296 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
32297 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
32298 on a write to the panic log.
32301 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
32305 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
32306 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
32307 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
32308 control = debug/kill
32309 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
32310 control = debug/trigger=now
32314 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
32315 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
32316 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
32317 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
32318 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
32321 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*& &&&
32322 &*control&~=&~dmarc_enable_forensic*&
32323 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
32324 .cindex DMARC "disable verify"
32325 .cindex DMARC controls
32326 .cindex DMARC "forensic mails"
32327 These control affect DMARC processing. For details on
32328 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
32330 The &"disable"& turns off DMARC verification processing entirely.
32333 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
32334 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
32335 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
32336 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
32337 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
32338 strings or to numeric value.
32339 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
32340 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
32341 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
32343 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
32344 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
32345 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
32346 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
32347 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
32350 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
32351 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
32352 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
32353 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
32354 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
32355 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
32356 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
32357 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
32359 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
32360 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
32361 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
32362 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
32363 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
32364 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
32368 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
32369 .cindex "fake defer"
32370 .cindex "defer, fake"
32372 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
32373 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
32374 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
32375 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
32376 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
32378 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
32379 .cindex "fake rejection"
32380 .cindex "rejection, fake"
32382 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
32383 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
32384 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
32385 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
32386 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32387 the same SMTP connection.
32389 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
32390 message is supplied, the following is used:
32392 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
32393 550-kept for evaluation.
32394 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
32395 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
32397 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
32399 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
32400 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
32401 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32402 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32403 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
32404 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
32407 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
32408 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
32409 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
32410 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
32412 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
32413 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
32414 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
32415 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32416 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
32417 disables such output flushing.
32419 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
32420 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32421 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
32422 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32423 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
32424 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32426 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32427 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32428 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32429 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32430 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32431 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32432 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32433 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32434 to be useful in production.
32436 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32437 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32438 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32439 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32440 SMTP responses, despite the fact that
32441 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc821,RFC 821)
32442 defined them over 20 years ago.
32444 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32445 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32446 one long line. However,
32447 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
32448 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32449 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32450 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32451 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32454 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32455 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32456 verification failed"&) is sent.
32458 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32462 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32463 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32465 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32466 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32467 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32468 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32469 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32470 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32471 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32472 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32474 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32475 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32476 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32477 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32478 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32479 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32480 .cindex "first pass routing"
32481 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32482 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32483 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32485 If used with no options set,
32486 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32487 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32489 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32490 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32491 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32492 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32493 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32494 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32496 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32497 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32499 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32500 .cindex "message" "submission"
32501 .cindex "submission mode"
32502 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32503 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32504 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32505 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32506 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32507 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32508 late (the message has already been created).
32510 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32511 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32512 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32513 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32514 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32516 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32517 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32518 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32519 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32520 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32523 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32524 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32526 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32528 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32531 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32532 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32533 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32534 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32537 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32538 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32540 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32541 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32543 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32545 .vitem &*control&~=&~wellknown*&
32546 This control sets up a response data file for a WELLKNOWN SMTP command.
32547 It may only be used in an ACL servicing that command.
32548 For details see section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&.
32552 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32553 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32556 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32558 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32559 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32561 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32563 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32568 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32569 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32570 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32571 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32572 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32573 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32575 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32576 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32577 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32579 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32580 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32581 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32582 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32583 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32586 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32587 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32589 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32590 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32591 contains one or more newlines that
32592 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32593 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32594 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32596 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32597 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32598 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32599 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32600 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32601 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32602 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32603 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32604 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32605 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32606 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32608 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32609 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32611 until they are added to the
32612 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32613 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32614 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32615 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32616 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32617 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32618 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32620 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32622 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32623 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32625 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32626 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32628 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32629 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32631 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32632 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32633 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32634 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32637 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32638 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32639 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32640 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32641 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32642 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32643 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32646 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32647 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32648 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32649 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32650 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32652 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32653 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32654 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32655 to be a header name first.) For example:
32657 warn add_header = \
32658 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32660 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32661 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32662 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32663 up in reverse order.
32665 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32666 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32667 system filter or in a router or transport.
32671 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32672 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32673 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32674 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32675 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32676 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32678 warn message = Remove internal headers
32679 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32681 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32682 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32683 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32684 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32685 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32686 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32688 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32689 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32691 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32692 list of header specifiers.
32693 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32694 then it is treated as a header name.
32695 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32696 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32697 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32699 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32700 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32704 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32707 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32708 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32709 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32711 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32712 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32713 warn message = Remove internal headers
32714 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32716 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32717 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32718 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32719 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32720 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32721 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32722 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32723 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32724 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32725 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32726 would have been removed.
32728 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32729 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32730 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32731 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32732 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32733 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32734 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32735 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32736 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32738 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32739 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32741 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32742 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32744 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32745 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32747 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32748 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32749 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32750 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32753 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32754 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32755 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32760 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32761 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32762 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32763 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32764 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32765 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32767 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32768 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32769 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32770 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32771 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32772 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32773 The conditions are as follows:
32777 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32778 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32779 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32780 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32781 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32782 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32783 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32784 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32785 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32786 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32787 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32788 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32790 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32791 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32792 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32793 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32794 The name and values are expanded separately.
32795 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32796 will act as argument separators.
32798 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32799 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32800 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32801 conditions are tested.
32803 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32804 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32805 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32806 for different local users or different local domains.
32809 .vitem &*atrn_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32810 .cindex ATRN "checking for queued messages"
32811 This condition is only usable in the ATRN ACL.
32812 It returns true if there are any messages queued for any of the domains given
32814 The list supplied must not be tainted
32815 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
32816 and should contain only domains relevant for the authenticated user
32817 (to avoid leaking information about other users).
32820 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32821 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32822 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32823 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32824 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32825 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32826 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32831 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32832 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32833 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32834 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32835 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32836 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32837 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32838 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32839 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32840 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32841 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32842 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32845 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32846 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32847 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32848 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32849 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32850 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32851 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32852 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32854 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32855 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32856 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32857 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32858 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32859 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32860 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32861 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32862 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32863 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32865 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32866 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32867 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32868 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32869 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32870 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32871 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32872 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32873 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32876 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32877 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32880 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32881 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32882 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32883 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32884 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32885 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32886 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32892 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32893 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32894 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32895 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32896 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32897 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32898 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32900 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32902 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32903 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32904 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32906 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32907 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32908 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32909 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32910 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32911 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32913 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32914 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32916 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32917 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32919 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32920 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32921 statement can then check the IP address.
32923 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32924 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32925 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32926 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32928 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32929 message = $host_data
32931 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32933 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32934 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32935 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32936 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32937 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32938 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32939 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32940 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32941 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32942 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32944 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32945 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32946 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32947 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32948 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32949 content-scanning extension
32950 and only after a DATA command.
32951 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32952 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32954 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32955 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32956 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32957 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32958 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32959 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32960 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32963 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32964 .cindex "rate limiting"
32965 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32966 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32968 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32969 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32970 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32971 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32972 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32973 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32975 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32976 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32977 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32978 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32979 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32980 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32981 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32983 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32984 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32985 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32986 for example for greylisting.
32987 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32989 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32990 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32991 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32992 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32993 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32994 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32995 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32996 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32997 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32998 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32999 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
33000 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
33001 influence the sender checking.
33003 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
33004 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
33006 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
33007 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
33008 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
33009 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
33010 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
33011 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
33015 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
33016 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
33018 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
33019 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
33020 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
33021 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
33022 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
33023 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
33025 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
33026 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33027 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
33028 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
33029 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
33030 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
33031 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
33032 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
33033 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
33034 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
33036 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
33037 .cindex "CSA verification"
33038 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
33039 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
33040 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
33042 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
33043 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33044 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
33045 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
33046 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
33047 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33049 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33050 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
33051 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
33052 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
33054 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
33055 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
33056 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
33058 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
33059 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33060 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
33061 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
33062 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
33063 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
33064 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33065 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
33066 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
33067 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
33068 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
33069 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
33070 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
33071 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
33072 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
33074 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
33075 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
33076 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
33077 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
33080 !verify = header_sender
33081 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
33084 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
33085 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33086 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
33087 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
33088 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
33089 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33090 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
33091 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
33092 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
33093 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
33094 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
33095 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
33096 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
33099 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
33100 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
33104 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
33105 common as they used to be.
33107 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
33108 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33109 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
33110 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
33111 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
33112 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
33113 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
33114 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
33115 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
33116 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
33117 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
33118 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
33119 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
33121 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
33122 option), this condition is always true.
33125 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
33126 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
33127 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
33128 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
33129 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
33130 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
33131 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
33132 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
33133 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
33135 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
33136 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
33138 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
33139 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
33142 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
33143 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33144 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
33145 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
33146 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
33147 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
33148 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
33149 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
33150 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
33151 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
33152 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
33153 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
33154 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
33155 value for the child address.
33157 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
33158 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33159 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
33160 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
33161 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
33162 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
33163 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
33164 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
33165 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
33166 original IP address.
33168 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
33169 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
33171 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
33172 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
33174 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
33175 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33176 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
33177 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
33178 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
33179 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
33180 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
33181 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
33182 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
33184 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
33185 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
33186 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
33187 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
33188 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
33189 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
33190 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
33192 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
33193 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
33194 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
33196 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
33197 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33198 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
33199 verified as a sender.
33201 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
33202 (eg. is generated from the received message)
33203 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
33205 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
33211 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
33212 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
33213 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33214 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
33215 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
33216 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
33217 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
33218 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
33219 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
33220 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
33222 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
33223 dialups.mail-abuse.org
33225 the following records are looked up:
33227 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33228 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
33230 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
33231 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
33232 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
33233 use two separate conditions:
33235 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33236 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33238 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
33239 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
33240 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
33243 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
33244 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
33245 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
33246 following special items in the list:
33247 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
33248 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
33249 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
33250 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
33252 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
33253 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
33254 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
33255 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
33257 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
33259 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
33260 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
33262 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33263 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33264 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
33266 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
33268 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
33269 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
33270 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
33271 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
33272 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
33273 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
33275 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
33276 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
33277 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
33281 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
33282 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
33283 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
33284 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
33285 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
33287 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
33289 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
33290 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
33291 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
33292 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
33297 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
33298 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
33299 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
33300 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
33301 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
33302 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
33303 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
33305 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33306 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
33308 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
33309 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
33310 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
33311 up by this example is
33313 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
33315 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
33316 addresses. For example:
33318 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33319 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33321 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
33322 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
33327 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
33328 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
33329 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
33330 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
33331 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
33332 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
33333 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
33334 either to double the separators like this:
33336 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
33338 or to change the separator character, like this:
33340 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
33342 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
33343 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
33344 occurs. Consider this condition:
33346 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
33348 The DNS lookups that occur are:
33350 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
33351 a.domain.black.list.tld
33353 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
33354 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
33355 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
33356 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
33357 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
33358 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
33359 error for a previous item.
33361 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
33362 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
33364 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
33365 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
33367 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
33368 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
33370 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
33371 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
33372 $sender_address_domain} }} }
33373 message = The mail servers for the domain \
33374 $sender_address_domain \
33375 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
33378 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
33379 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
33380 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
33381 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
33383 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
33385 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
33386 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
33388 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
33389 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
33394 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
33395 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
33396 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
33397 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
33398 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
33399 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
33400 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
33401 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
33402 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
33403 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
33404 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
33405 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
33406 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
33407 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
33409 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
33410 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
33411 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
33413 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
33414 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
33415 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
33416 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
33419 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
33420 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
33421 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
33422 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
33423 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
33424 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
33425 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
33426 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
33427 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
33428 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
33429 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
33430 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
33431 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
33432 cases, for example:
33434 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
33436 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
33437 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
33438 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
33439 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
33441 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
33443 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
33444 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
33446 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33447 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33448 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33449 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33450 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33453 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33454 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33455 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33457 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33458 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33460 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33465 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33466 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33467 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33468 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33471 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33473 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33474 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33475 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33476 describes how multiple records are handled.
33478 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33479 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33480 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33482 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33484 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33485 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33486 first. For example:
33488 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33489 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33492 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33493 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33494 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33495 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33496 tested. For example:
33498 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33500 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33501 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33502 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33504 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33506 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33511 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33512 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33515 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33517 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33518 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33520 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33522 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33523 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33524 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33525 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33527 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33528 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33530 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33531 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33533 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33534 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33536 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33537 Consider this example:
33539 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33541 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33544 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33546 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33548 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33549 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33550 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33552 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33554 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33555 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33556 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33559 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33565 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33566 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33567 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33568 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33569 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33570 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33572 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33574 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33575 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33576 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33577 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33578 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33579 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33582 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33583 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33584 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33586 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33587 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33590 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33592 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33593 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33595 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33597 for the condition to be true.
33600 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33601 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33603 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33604 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33606 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33608 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33609 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33611 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33612 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33614 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33616 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33617 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33619 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33621 for the condition to be false.
33623 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33624 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33629 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33630 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33631 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33632 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33633 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33634 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33635 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33636 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33637 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33640 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33641 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33642 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33643 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33644 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33645 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33646 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33649 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33650 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33652 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33653 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33655 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33656 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33657 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33658 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33659 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33660 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33662 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33663 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33664 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33667 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33668 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33669 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33670 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33672 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33673 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33674 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33678 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33679 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33680 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33681 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33682 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33683 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33685 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33686 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33688 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33689 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33690 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33692 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33694 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33695 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33697 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33698 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33700 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33701 dnslists = some.list.example
33704 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33705 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33706 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33708 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33712 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33713 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33714 .cindex greylisting
33715 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33716 situation has been previously met.
33717 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33718 The syntax of the condition is:
33720 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33725 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33727 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33729 The parameters for the condition are
33730 a possible minus sign,
33732 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33733 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33734 and used for the test.
33735 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33736 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33737 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33740 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33742 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33743 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33745 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33746 no record create or update is done.
33747 If a &%write%& option is given then
33748 a record create or update is always done.
33749 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33750 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33751 a record is created.
33753 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33755 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33756 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33757 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33758 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33759 An explicit interval can be set using a
33760 &%refresh=value%& option.
33762 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33763 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33766 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33767 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33768 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33769 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33770 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33771 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33772 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33773 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33774 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33775 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33777 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33779 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33780 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33782 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33783 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33784 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33787 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33788 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33789 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33790 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33791 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33792 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33793 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33794 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33795 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33797 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33798 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33799 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33800 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33802 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33803 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33804 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33805 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33806 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33807 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33808 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33809 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33810 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33811 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33813 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33814 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33815 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33818 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33819 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33820 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33821 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33822 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33823 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33825 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33826 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33827 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33828 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33829 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33830 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33831 the &%count=%& option.
33834 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33835 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33838 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33839 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33840 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33841 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33844 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33845 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33846 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33847 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33848 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33851 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33852 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33853 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33854 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33855 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33856 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33857 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33858 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33861 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33862 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33863 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33864 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33865 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33866 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33867 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33868 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33871 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33872 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33873 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33874 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33875 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33879 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33880 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33881 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33882 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33883 multiple different commands.
33886 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33887 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33889 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33890 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33891 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33892 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33893 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33894 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33895 The count does not have to be an integer.
33898 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33899 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33903 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33904 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33905 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33906 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33907 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33909 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33910 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33912 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33913 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33914 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33915 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33919 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33920 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33921 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33924 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33925 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33926 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33929 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33930 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33931 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33932 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33933 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33934 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33937 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33938 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33939 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33940 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33941 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33944 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33945 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33946 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33947 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33948 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33949 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33952 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33953 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33954 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33955 up to the given limit.
33956 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33957 consists of refusing the message, and
33958 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33959 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33960 likely not what is wanted.
33962 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33963 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33964 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33965 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33966 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33967 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33968 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33969 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33971 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33975 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33976 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33977 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33978 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33979 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33980 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33981 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33982 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33983 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33985 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33986 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33987 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33988 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33989 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33990 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33992 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33993 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33996 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33997 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33998 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33999 required increases with larger limits.
34001 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
34002 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
34003 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
34004 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
34005 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
34006 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
34007 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
34008 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
34009 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
34013 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
34014 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
34015 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
34016 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
34017 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
34018 message. For example:
34020 # Log all senders' rates
34021 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
34022 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
34024 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
34025 # at the decimal point.
34026 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
34027 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
34028 $sender_rate_limit }s
34030 # Keep authenticated users under control
34031 deny authenticated = *
34032 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
34034 # System-wide rate limit
34035 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
34036 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
34038 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
34039 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
34040 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
34041 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
34042 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
34043 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
34044 messages per $sender_rate_period
34046 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
34047 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
34048 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
34049 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
34050 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
34051 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
34052 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
34056 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
34057 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
34058 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
34059 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
34060 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
34061 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
34062 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
34063 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
34064 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
34066 verify = sender/callout
34067 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
34069 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
34070 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
34071 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
34072 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
34073 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
34074 The available options are as follows:
34077 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
34078 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
34079 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
34081 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
34082 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
34083 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
34084 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
34086 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
34087 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
34089 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
34090 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
34091 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
34092 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
34094 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
34095 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
34096 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
34097 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
34098 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
34099 not already exceeded (otherwise).
34102 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
34103 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
34104 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
34105 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
34106 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
34107 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
34110 warn !verify = sender
34111 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
34113 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
34114 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
34115 verification failure.
34116 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
34118 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
34119 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
34122 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
34123 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
34125 &%route%&: Routing failed.
34127 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
34128 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
34129 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
34131 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
34133 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
34135 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
34138 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
34139 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
34141 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
34142 address verification to:
34145 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
34151 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
34152 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
34153 .cindex "callout" "verification"
34154 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
34155 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
34156 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
34157 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
34158 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
34159 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
34160 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
34161 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
34162 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
34165 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
34166 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
34167 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
34168 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
34169 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
34170 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
34172 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
34173 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
34174 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
34175 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
34176 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
34178 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
34179 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
34180 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
34181 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
34182 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
34183 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
34184 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
34185 supplies a host list.
34186 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
34188 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
34189 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
34190 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
34191 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
34192 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
34193 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
34194 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
34196 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
34197 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
34198 following SMTP commands are sent:
34200 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
34202 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
34205 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
34208 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
34211 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
34212 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
34213 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
34214 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
34215 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
34216 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
34218 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
34219 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
34220 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
34221 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
34222 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
34224 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
34225 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
34226 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
34227 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
34228 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
34230 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
34231 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
34232 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
34233 will assign untainted values to the
34234 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
34235 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
34240 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
34241 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
34242 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
34243 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
34245 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
34247 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
34248 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
34249 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
34253 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
34254 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
34255 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
34258 verify = sender/callout=5s
34260 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
34261 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
34262 the &%connect%& parameter.
34265 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34266 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
34267 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
34268 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
34270 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
34272 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
34274 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
34275 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
34276 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
34277 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
34278 updated in this circumstance.
34280 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
34281 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
34282 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
34283 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
34284 accordance with the specification in
34285 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821).
34286 The RFC states that the unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
34289 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34290 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
34291 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
34292 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
34293 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
34294 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
34295 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
34296 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
34297 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
34298 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
34300 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
34302 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
34305 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34306 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
34307 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
34310 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
34312 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
34313 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
34314 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
34315 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
34316 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
34319 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34320 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
34321 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
34322 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
34324 .vitem &*postmaster*&
34325 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
34326 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
34327 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
34328 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
34329 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
34330 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
34331 made, until the cache record expires.
34333 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34334 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
34335 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
34338 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
34340 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
34341 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
34343 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
34345 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
34346 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
34347 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
34348 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
34352 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
34353 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
34354 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
34355 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
34356 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
34358 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
34360 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
34361 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
34362 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
34363 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
34364 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
34366 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
34367 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
34368 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34370 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
34372 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34373 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
34374 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
34375 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
34376 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
34378 .vitem &*use_sender*&
34379 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34381 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
34383 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
34384 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
34385 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
34386 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
34387 usefulness of callout caching.
34390 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34392 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
34394 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
34395 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
34396 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
34397 when that is used for the connections.
34398 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
34399 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
34400 if the use_sender option is used,
34401 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
34402 and if no other callouts intervene.
34405 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
34406 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
34407 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
34408 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
34409 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
34410 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
34411 these circumstances.
34413 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
34414 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
34415 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
34416 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
34417 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
34418 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
34419 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
34421 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
34422 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
34423 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
34424 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
34429 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
34430 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
34431 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
34432 .cindex "caching" "callout"
34433 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
34434 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
34435 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
34436 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
34437 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
34438 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
34440 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
34441 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
34444 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
34445 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
34446 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34448 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34449 commands up to and including
34453 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34454 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34455 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34456 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34457 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34458 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34459 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34461 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34462 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34463 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34464 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34465 will eventually be noticed.
34467 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34468 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34469 behaviour will be the same.
34473 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34474 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34475 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34476 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34477 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34478 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34479 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34481 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34482 and one hour for a negative result.
34483 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34484 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34487 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34489 Possible parameters are:
34491 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34492 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34493 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34494 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34496 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34497 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34498 As above, for a negative entry.
34500 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34501 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34503 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34504 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34505 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34506 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34507 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34508 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34511 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34513 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34514 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34515 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34516 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34517 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34518 550 Sender verification failed
34520 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34521 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34522 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34523 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34526 verify = sender/no_details
34529 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34530 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34531 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34532 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34533 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34534 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34535 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34538 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34539 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34540 verification also fails.
34542 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34543 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34546 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34547 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34548 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34551 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34553 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34554 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34555 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34556 verification to succeed.
34558 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34559 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34560 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34561 option. For example:
34563 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34565 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34566 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34568 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34569 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34570 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34571 address and a report is output for each of them.
34575 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34576 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34577 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34578 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34579 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34580 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34581 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34585 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34586 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34587 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34588 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34589 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34590 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34592 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34593 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34594 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34595 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34598 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34600 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34602 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34603 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34605 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34606 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34609 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34610 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34612 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34614 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34615 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34616 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34617 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34620 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34622 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34623 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34624 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34626 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34627 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34628 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34629 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34630 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34631 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34632 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34633 of legitimate HELO domains.
34635 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34636 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34637 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34638 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34641 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34643 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34644 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34645 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34650 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34651 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34652 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34653 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34654 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34655 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34656 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34657 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34659 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34660 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34661 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34662 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34663 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34664 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34665 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34666 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34668 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34669 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34672 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34673 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34676 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34677 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34680 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34682 recipients = +batv_senders
34683 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34685 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34687 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34688 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34689 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34690 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34692 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34693 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34694 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34695 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34696 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34698 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34699 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34700 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34701 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34702 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34703 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34704 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34706 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34707 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34708 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34709 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34713 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34715 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34716 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34717 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34720 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34723 external_smtp_batv:
34725 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34726 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34727 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34728 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34731 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34735 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34736 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34737 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34738 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34739 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34740 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34741 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34742 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34743 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34744 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34746 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34747 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34748 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34749 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34750 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34751 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34753 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34755 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34756 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34757 system to arbitrary domains.
34760 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34761 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34762 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34763 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34766 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34767 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34768 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34770 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34771 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34773 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34774 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34778 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34780 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34781 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34782 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34784 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34788 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34789 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34791 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34792 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34793 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34794 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34795 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34796 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34797 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34801 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34802 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34803 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34804 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34805 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34810 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34811 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34813 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34814 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34815 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34816 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34817 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34818 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34821 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34822 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34823 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34824 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34825 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34827 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34828 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34829 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34832 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34833 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34835 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34836 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34837 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34839 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34840 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34842 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34845 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34848 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34849 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34850 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34851 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34852 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34853 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34855 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34856 temporarily created in a file called:
34858 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34860 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34861 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34862 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34863 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34864 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34866 control = no_mbox_unspool
34868 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34869 same directory by default.
34873 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34874 .cindex "virus scanning"
34875 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34876 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34877 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34878 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34879 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34880 in memory and thus are much faster.
34882 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34883 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34885 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34886 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34889 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34890 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34892 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34893 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34894 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34895 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34897 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34899 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34901 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34903 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34905 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34906 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34907 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34911 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34912 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34913 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34914 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34915 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34916 This scanner type takes one option,
34917 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34918 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34919 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34920 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34921 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34922 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34923 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34925 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34926 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34927 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34928 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34933 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34934 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34935 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34937 If you omit the argument, the default path
34938 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34940 If you use a remote host,
34941 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34942 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34943 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34945 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34951 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34952 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34953 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34955 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34956 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34957 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34958 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34959 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34962 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34967 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34968 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34969 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34970 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34971 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34973 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34974 a UNIX socket specification,
34975 a TCP socket specification,
34976 or a (global) option.
34978 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34979 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34980 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34981 and the second a port number,
34982 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34983 These per-server options are supported:
34985 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34988 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34989 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34991 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34995 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34996 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34997 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34998 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34999 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
35001 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
35003 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
35004 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
35005 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
35006 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
35008 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
35009 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
35010 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
35011 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
35012 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
35013 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
35014 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
35015 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
35016 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
35018 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
35019 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
35020 (Connection refused)
35023 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
35024 contributing the code for this scanner.
35027 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
35028 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
35029 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
35030 type takes 3 mandatory options:
35033 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
35034 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
35037 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
35038 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
35039 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
35040 the &"trigger"& expression.
35043 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
35044 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
35045 &"name"& expression.
35048 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
35050 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
35052 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
35053 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
35054 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
35055 configuration setting:
35057 av_scanner = cmdline:\
35058 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
35059 found in file:'(.+)'
35062 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
35063 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
35065 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
35066 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
35067 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
35068 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
35071 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
35072 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
35074 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
35075 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
35078 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
35079 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
35080 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
35084 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
35086 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
35088 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
35089 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
35090 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
35091 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
35094 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
35096 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
35099 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
35100 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
35101 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
35103 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
35105 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
35106 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
35108 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
35109 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
35110 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
35111 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
35112 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
35115 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
35117 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
35120 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
35121 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
35122 though some documentation was available in English.
35123 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
35124 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
35125 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
35127 The only option for this scanner type is
35128 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
35129 provided that mksd has
35130 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
35132 av_scanner = mksd:2
35134 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
35137 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
35138 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
35139 running on the local machine.
35140 There are four options:
35141 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
35142 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
35143 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
35144 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
35145 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
35148 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
35150 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
35151 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
35152 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
35153 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
35154 specify an empty element to get this.
35157 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
35158 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
35159 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
35160 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
35161 client communication. For example:
35163 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
35165 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
35169 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
35170 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
35173 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
35174 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
35175 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
35176 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
35177 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
35178 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
35181 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
35182 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
35183 The first element can then be one of
35186 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
35187 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
35190 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
35191 the condition fails immediately.
35193 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
35194 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
35195 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
35196 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
35197 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
35200 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
35201 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
35202 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
35204 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
35205 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
35208 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
35210 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
35212 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35213 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35214 is set to record the actual address used.
35216 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
35217 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
35218 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
35219 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
35222 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
35223 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
35225 Here is a very simple scanning example:
35228 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35230 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
35232 deny malware = */defer_ok
35233 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35235 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
35236 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
35238 av_scanner = $acl_m0
35240 in the main Exim configuration.
35242 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
35244 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35246 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
35248 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35252 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
35253 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
35254 .cindex "spam scanning"
35255 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
35257 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
35258 score and a report for the message.
35259 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
35261 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
35262 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
35263 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
35265 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
35267 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
35269 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
35270 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
35273 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
35274 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
35275 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
35276 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
35277 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
35278 configuration as follows (example):
35280 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
35282 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
35283 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
35284 iptables firewall, consider setting
35285 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
35286 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
35287 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
35288 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
35292 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
35294 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
35296 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
35299 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
35300 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
35301 filename instead of an address/port pair:
35303 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
35305 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
35306 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
35307 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
35308 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
35310 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
35311 192.168.2.11 783 : \
35314 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
35315 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
35316 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
35319 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
35320 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
35321 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
35322 take care to not double the separator.
35324 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
35325 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
35326 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
35327 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
35329 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
35331 The supported options are:
35333 pri=<priority> Selection priority
35334 weight=<value> Selection bias
35335 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
35336 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
35337 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
35338 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
35341 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
35342 higher values being tried first.
35343 The default priority is 1.
35345 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
35346 Within a priority set
35347 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
35348 The default value for selection bias is 1.
35350 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
35351 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
35352 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
35353 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
35355 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
35356 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
35358 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
35359 The default value is two minutes.
35361 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35362 a failed connect is made.
35363 The default is to not retry.
35365 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
35366 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
35367 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
35370 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35371 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35372 is set to record the actual address used.
35374 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
35375 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
35378 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35380 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
35381 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
35382 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
35383 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
35384 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
35387 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
35388 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
35389 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
35390 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
35391 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
35393 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
35394 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
35396 or the use of PRDR,
35397 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
35398 are needed to use this feature.
35400 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
35401 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
35402 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
35405 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
35406 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
35407 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
35410 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
35412 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35415 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
35416 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
35417 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
35418 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
35420 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
35421 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
35423 Except for &$spam_report$&,
35424 these variables are saved with the received message so are
35425 available for use at delivery time.
35428 .vitem &$spam_score$&
35429 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
35430 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
35432 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
35433 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
35434 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
35435 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
35436 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
35438 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
35439 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
35440 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
35441 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
35442 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
35443 spam bar is 50 characters.
35445 .vitem &$spam_report$&
35446 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
35447 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35448 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35449 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35450 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35451 unencoded in headers.
35453 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35454 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35455 spam score versus threshold.
35456 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35460 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35461 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35462 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35464 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35465 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35466 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35467 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35468 spam condition, like this:
35470 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35471 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35473 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35475 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35478 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35479 warn spam = nobody:true
35480 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35481 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35483 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35484 # is over threshold
35486 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35488 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35489 deny spam = nobody:true
35490 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35491 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35496 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35497 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35498 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35499 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35500 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35501 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35502 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35503 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35504 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35505 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35508 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35509 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35510 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35511 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35512 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35513 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35514 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35516 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35517 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35518 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35519 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35520 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35522 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35523 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35524 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35525 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35526 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35529 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35531 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35535 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35537 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35538 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35539 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35540 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35542 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35543 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35544 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35545 the full path and filename.
35547 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35548 filename, and the default path is then used.
35550 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35551 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages.
35552 The variable &$mime_filename$& will have the suggested name for the file.
35553 Note however that this might contain anything, and is very difficult
35554 to safely use as all or even part of the filename.
35555 If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35556 automatically unlinked.
35558 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35559 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35560 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35561 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35562 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35564 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35565 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35566 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35568 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35569 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35570 available in the MIME ACL:
35573 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35574 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35575 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35576 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35577 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35578 the detected issue.
35580 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35581 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35582 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35583 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35584 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35585 contains the empty string.
35587 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35588 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35589 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35590 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35596 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35597 case-insensitively.
35599 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35600 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35601 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35602 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35603 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35604 only used for display purposes.
35606 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35607 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35608 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35609 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35611 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35612 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35613 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35614 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35616 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35617 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35618 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35619 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35620 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35621 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35623 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35624 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35625 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35626 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35627 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35629 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35630 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35631 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35632 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35633 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35637 application/octet-stream
35641 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35644 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35645 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35646 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35647 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35648 containing the decoded data.
35653 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35654 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35655 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35656 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35657 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35658 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) or
35659 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2231,RFC 2231)
35660 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35662 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35664 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35665 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35666 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35667 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35668 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35670 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35671 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35675 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35678 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35679 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35682 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35683 and the rest are attachments.
35686 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35689 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35690 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35691 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35693 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35694 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35695 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35696 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35699 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35700 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35701 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35702 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35703 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35704 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35706 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35707 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35708 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35709 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35710 decoding is fully recursive.
35712 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35713 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35714 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35715 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35716 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35717 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35718 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35719 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35724 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35725 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35726 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35727 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35728 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35730 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35731 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35732 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35733 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35734 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35736 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35737 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35738 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35739 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35740 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35741 32K characters are checked.
35743 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35744 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35745 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35746 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35747 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35749 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35750 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35752 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35753 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35754 matching regular expression.
35755 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35756 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35758 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35766 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35767 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35769 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35770 "Local scan function"
35771 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35772 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35773 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35774 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35775 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35777 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35778 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35779 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35780 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35781 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35783 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35784 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35785 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35786 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35788 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35789 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35790 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35791 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35793 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35794 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35795 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35796 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35797 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35798 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35799 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35800 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35801 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35805 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35806 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35807 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35808 function is before building Exim, by setting
35809 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35810 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35811 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35812 directory, so you might set
35814 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35815 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35817 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35818 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35819 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35821 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35822 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35823 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35824 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35825 _src/local_scan.c_.
35827 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35828 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35830 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35832 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35837 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35838 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35839 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35840 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35843 #include "local_scan.h"
35845 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35846 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35847 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35848 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35849 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35850 strings and pointers to character strings:
35852 #define CS (char *)
35853 #define CCS (const char *)
35854 #define CSS (char **)
35855 #define US (unsigned char *)
35856 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35857 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35859 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35861 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35863 The arguments are as follows:
35866 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35867 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35868 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35870 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35871 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35872 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35873 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35874 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35875 case this changes in some future version.
35877 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35878 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35881 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35884 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35885 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35886 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35887 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35888 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35889 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35891 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35892 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35893 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35895 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35896 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35897 queued without immediate delivery.
35899 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35900 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35901 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35902 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35903 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35906 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35907 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35908 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35911 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35912 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35913 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35914 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35915 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35916 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35917 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35919 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35920 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35921 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35924 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35925 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35926 &%-oe%& command line options.
35930 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35931 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35932 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35933 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35934 want to do this, you must have the line
35936 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35938 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35939 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35940 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35943 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35944 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35945 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35946 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35947 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35948 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35950 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35951 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35953 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35954 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35955 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35958 int local_scan_options_count =
35959 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35961 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35962 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35966 my_string = some string of text...
35968 The available types of option data are as follows:
35971 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35972 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35973 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35974 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35975 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35976 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35979 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35980 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35981 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35982 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35985 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35986 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35989 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35990 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35991 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35992 printed with the suffix K or M.
35994 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35995 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35996 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35997 always output in octal.
35999 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
36000 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
36001 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
36003 .vitem &*opt_time*&
36004 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
36005 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
36008 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
36009 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
36013 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
36014 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
36015 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
36016 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
36017 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
36018 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
36019 C variables are as follows:
36022 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
36023 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
36024 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
36026 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
36027 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
36028 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
36030 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
36031 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
36032 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
36033 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
36036 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
36037 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
36038 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
36041 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
36042 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
36046 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
36047 selected, you should use code like this:
36049 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
36050 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
36052 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
36053 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
36054 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
36056 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
36057 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
36060 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
36061 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
36063 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
36064 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
36066 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
36067 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
36068 &%-bh%& command line option.
36070 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
36071 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
36072 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
36074 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
36075 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
36076 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
36077 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
36079 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
36080 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
36081 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
36083 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
36084 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36086 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
36087 The number of accepted recipients.
36089 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
36090 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
36091 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
36092 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
36093 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
36094 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
36095 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
36096 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
36097 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
36098 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
36099 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
36100 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
36102 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
36103 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
36105 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
36106 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
36107 locally-submitted messages.
36109 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
36110 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
36111 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
36113 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
36114 The name of the sending host, if known.
36116 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
36117 The port on the sending host.
36119 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
36120 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
36122 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
36123 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
36125 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
36126 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
36127 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
36131 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
36132 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
36133 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
36134 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
36139 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
36140 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
36142 .vitem &*int&~type*&
36143 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
36144 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
36145 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
36146 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
36147 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
36148 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
36150 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
36151 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
36154 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
36155 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
36156 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
36161 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
36162 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
36165 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
36166 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
36168 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
36169 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
36170 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
36171 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
36173 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
36174 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
36175 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
36176 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
36177 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
36178 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
36179 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
36180 is NULL for all recipients.
36185 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
36186 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
36187 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
36188 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
36192 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
36193 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
36195 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
36196 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
36197 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
36198 for the process in &%newumask%&.
36200 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
36201 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
36202 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
36203 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
36204 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
36206 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
36208 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
36209 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
36210 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
36211 return value is as follows:
36216 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
36222 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
36228 The process timed out.
36232 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
36235 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
36236 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
36237 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
36238 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
36239 forks a subprocess that is running
36241 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
36243 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
36244 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
36245 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
36246 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
36248 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
36249 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
36250 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
36251 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
36254 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
36255 *sender_authentication)*&
36256 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
36259 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
36261 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
36264 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
36265 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'printf()'&. The
36266 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
36267 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
36268 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
36270 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
36271 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
36274 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
36275 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
36276 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
36277 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
36278 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
36279 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
36280 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
36281 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
36283 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
36284 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
36285 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
36286 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
36287 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
36288 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
36290 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36291 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
36292 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
36293 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
36295 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
36296 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
36297 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
36298 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
36299 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
36300 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
36301 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
36302 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
36303 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
36304 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
36306 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
36307 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
36309 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
36310 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
36313 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
36314 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
36315 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
36316 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
36317 match the specification, the function does nothing.
36320 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36321 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
36322 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
36323 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
36324 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
36325 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
36327 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
36329 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
36330 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
36331 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
36332 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
36333 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
36336 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
36337 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
36338 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
36339 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
36340 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
36341 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
36342 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
36343 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
36345 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
36346 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
36347 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
36348 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
36349 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
36350 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
36351 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
36353 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
36354 inability to contact a database.
36356 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36358 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
36359 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
36360 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36362 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36364 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
36365 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
36366 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36368 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
36370 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
36373 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
36375 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
36376 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
36377 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
36378 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
36379 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
36380 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
36383 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
36385 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
36386 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
36387 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
36388 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
36389 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
36390 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
36393 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
36394 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
36395 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
36396 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
36398 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
36399 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
36400 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
36401 value afterwards. For example:
36403 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
36404 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
36405 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
36408 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
36409 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
36410 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
36411 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
36418 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
36419 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
36420 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to
36421 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). Typically
36422 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
36423 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
36424 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
36425 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
36426 binary string is returned with an error message.
36428 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
36429 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
36430 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
36432 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
36433 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
36434 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
36435 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
36436 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
36438 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
36439 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
36440 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
36442 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
36443 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
36444 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
36445 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36449 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36450 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36453 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36454 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36455 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36456 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36457 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36458 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36459 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36460 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36463 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36464 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36466 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36467 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36468 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36469 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36471 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36472 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36473 ABI version number was incremented.
36475 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36476 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36477 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36478 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36479 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36480 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36481 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36483 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36484 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36486 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36487 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36488 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36489 multiple output lines.
36491 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36493 guarantee a flush of
36494 pending output, and therefore does not test
36495 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36496 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36497 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36498 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36499 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36502 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36503 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36504 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36505 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36506 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36507 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36508 Exim bombs out if it ever
36509 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36511 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36512 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36513 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36515 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36518 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36521 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36522 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36523 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36524 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36525 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36526 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36532 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36533 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36534 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36535 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36536 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36537 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36538 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36541 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36542 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36543 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36544 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36546 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36547 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36549 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36551 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36552 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36553 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36554 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36556 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36557 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36558 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36559 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36569 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36570 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36571 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36572 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36573 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36574 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36575 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36576 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36578 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36579 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36580 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36581 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36582 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36584 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36585 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36586 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36587 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36588 .cindex retry condition
36589 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36590 prevent it happening on retries.
36592 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36593 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36594 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36595 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36596 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36597 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36598 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36599 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36602 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36603 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36604 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36605 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36606 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36607 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36608 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36610 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36611 system_filter_user = exim
36613 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36614 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36615 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36616 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36617 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36618 by the &%reply%& command.
36621 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36622 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36623 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36624 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36626 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36627 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36631 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36632 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36633 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36634 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36635 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36636 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36639 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36640 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36641 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36642 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36643 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36644 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36645 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36647 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36648 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36649 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36650 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36651 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36653 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36654 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36655 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36656 to which users' filter files can refer.
36660 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36661 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36662 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36663 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36664 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36668 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36669 .cindex "freezing messages"
36670 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36671 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36672 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36673 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36674 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36675 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36676 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36677 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36678 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36679 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36681 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36683 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36685 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36686 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36687 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36688 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36689 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36692 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36693 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36694 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36695 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36697 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36698 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36699 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36700 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36701 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36702 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36703 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36704 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36705 message. For example:
36707 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36708 because it contains attachments that we are \
36709 not prepared to receive."
36712 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36713 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36714 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36715 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36716 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36717 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36720 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36721 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36723 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36724 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36725 generated by the filter.
36727 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36729 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36730 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36736 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36737 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36742 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36743 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36744 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36745 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36746 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36748 headers add <string>
36749 headers remove <string>
36751 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36752 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36753 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to
36754 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) syntax. Leading white
36755 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36756 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36758 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36759 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36760 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36763 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36764 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36767 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36768 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36769 space after input continuations is ignored.
36771 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36772 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36773 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36774 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36775 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36777 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36778 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36779 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36780 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36781 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36782 used for all recipients of the message.
36784 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36785 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36786 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36787 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36788 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36789 until the message is actually being written (see section
36790 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36792 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36793 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36794 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36795 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36796 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36797 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36798 modified more than once.
36800 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36801 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36804 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36805 headers remove "Subject"
36806 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36807 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36812 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36813 .cindex "envelope from"
36814 .cindex "envelope sender"
36815 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36817 errors_to <some address>
36819 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36820 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36821 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36824 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36826 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36827 address if its delivery failed.
36831 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36832 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36833 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36834 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36835 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36836 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36837 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36838 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36839 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36844 domains = +local_domains
36845 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36850 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36851 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36852 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36853 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36855 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36856 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36857 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36858 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36860 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36861 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36862 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36869 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36872 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36873 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36874 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36875 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36876 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36877 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36878 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36879 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36881 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36882 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36883 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36884 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36885 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36887 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36888 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36889 loopback interface specially in any way.
36891 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36892 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36897 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36898 .cindex "message" "submission"
36899 .cindex "submission mode"
36900 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36901 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36902 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36903 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36905 control = submission
36907 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36908 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36909 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36910 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36911 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36912 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36914 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36915 control = submission
36917 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36918 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36919 is used to separate options. For example:
36921 control = submission/sender_retain
36923 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36924 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36925 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36926 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36927 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36928 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36929 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36931 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36932 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36935 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36937 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36938 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36939 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36940 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36942 accept authenticated = *
36943 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36944 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36945 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36947 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36948 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36949 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36951 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36953 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36956 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36958 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36959 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36960 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36961 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36963 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36964 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36965 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36966 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36967 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36968 spoof another's address.
36970 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36971 .cindex "line endings"
36972 .cindex "carriage return"
36974 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
36975 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36976 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36977 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36978 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36979 use CRLF or just CR.
36981 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36982 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36983 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36984 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36985 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36986 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36987 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36988 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36992 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36995 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36996 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36999 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
37000 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
37001 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
37002 people trying to play silly games.
37004 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
37005 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
37006 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
37008 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
37009 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
37016 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
37017 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
37018 .cindex "address" "qualification"
37019 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
37020 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
37021 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
37022 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
37023 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
37025 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
37026 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
37027 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
37028 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
37029 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
37031 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
37032 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
37033 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
37034 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
37035 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
37036 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
37037 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
37038 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
37043 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
37044 .cindex "&""From""& line"
37045 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
37046 .cindex "sender" "address"
37047 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
37048 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
37049 .cindex "envelope from"
37050 .cindex "envelope sender"
37051 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
37052 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
37053 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
37054 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
37056 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
37057 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
37059 This line precedes the
37060 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37061 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
37062 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
37063 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
37064 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
37065 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
37066 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
37067 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
37068 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
37069 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
37071 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
37072 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
37073 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
37074 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
37076 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37077 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
37078 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
37079 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
37081 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
37082 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
37083 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
37085 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
37086 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
37087 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
37088 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
37092 .section "Header lines"
37093 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
37095 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37096 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
37097 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
37098 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
37099 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
37100 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
37103 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
37104 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
37107 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
37108 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
37112 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
37113 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
37115 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
37116 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
37117 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
37119 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
37122 For a locally-submitted message,
37123 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
37124 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
37125 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
37126 included in log lines in this case.
37128 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
37129 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
37135 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
37136 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
37137 includes the header line:
37139 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
37142 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
37143 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
37144 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
37145 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
37146 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
37147 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
37150 .subsection Date: SECID223
37152 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
37153 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
37154 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
37156 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
37157 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
37158 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
37159 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37160 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37162 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
37163 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
37164 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
37165 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
37169 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
37170 .chindex Envelope-to:
37171 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
37172 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37173 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) header set.
37174 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
37175 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
37176 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
37177 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
37181 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
37183 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
37184 .cindex "message" "submission"
37185 .cindex "submission mode"
37186 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
37187 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
37190 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
37191 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
37193 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37194 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
37196 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37197 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37198 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37200 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
37201 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37203 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37204 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37208 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
37210 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
37211 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
37212 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
37213 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37214 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
37215 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
37216 &%qualify_domain%&.
37218 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
37219 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
37220 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
37221 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37224 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
37225 .chindex Message-ID:
37226 .cindex "message" "submission"
37227 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
37228 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
37229 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
37230 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
37231 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
37232 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
37233 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
37234 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
37235 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
37236 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
37239 .subsection Received: SECID227
37241 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
37242 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
37243 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
37245 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
37246 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
37247 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
37248 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
37250 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
37251 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
37252 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
37255 .subsection References: SECID228
37256 .chindex References:
37257 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
37258 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
37260 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37261 (which states that replies should contain such a header line),
37262 and section 3.14 of &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,RFC 3834)
37263 (which states that automatic
37264 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
37265 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
37266 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
37267 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
37268 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
37272 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
37273 .chindex Return-path:
37274 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
37275 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
37276 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
37277 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
37278 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
37279 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
37283 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
37284 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
37285 .cindex "message" "submission"
37287 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
37288 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
37289 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
37290 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37293 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
37294 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37295 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
37296 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
37297 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
37298 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
37299 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
37300 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
37301 line is added to the message.
37303 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
37304 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
37305 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
37306 options true at the same time.
37308 .cindex "submission mode"
37309 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
37310 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
37311 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
37312 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
37314 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37315 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
37316 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
37317 created as follows:
37320 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37321 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37322 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37324 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
37325 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37327 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37328 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37331 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
37332 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
37333 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
37334 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
37336 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
37337 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
37338 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
37339 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
37343 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
37344 "SECTheadersaddrem"
37345 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
37346 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
37347 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
37348 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
37349 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
37350 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
37351 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
37353 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
37354 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
37355 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
37356 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
37357 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
37358 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
37360 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
37361 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
37362 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
37364 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
37365 option must be in the form of one or more
37366 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37367 header lines, separated by newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
37369 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
37370 X-added-second: another added header line
37372 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
37374 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
37375 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
37376 Each header-line is separately expanded.
37378 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
37379 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
37380 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
37381 not part of the names. For example:
37383 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
37386 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
37387 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
37388 Each item is separately expanded.
37389 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
37390 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
37391 will act as list separators.
37393 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
37394 items are expanded at routing time,
37395 and then associated with all addresses that are
37396 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
37397 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
37398 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
37400 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
37401 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
37402 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
37403 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
37405 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
37406 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
37407 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
37410 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
37411 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
37412 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
37413 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
37414 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
37415 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
37416 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
37418 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
37419 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
37420 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
37421 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
37423 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
37424 the following consequences:
37427 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
37428 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
37429 to it, at all times.
37431 Header lines that are added by a router's
37432 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
37433 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
37435 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
37436 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
37438 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
37439 a later router or by a transport.
37441 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
37442 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
37444 headers_remove = subject
37445 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
37449 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
37450 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
37456 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
37457 .cindex "address" "constructed"
37458 .cindex "constructed address"
37459 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37462 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37466 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37468 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37469 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37470 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37471 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37472 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37473 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37474 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37475 there is no password file entry.
37478 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to
37479 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37481 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37482 characters, it is encoded as described in
37483 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047), which defines a way of
37484 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37485 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37486 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37487 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37488 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37492 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37493 .cindex "case of local parts"
37494 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37495 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37496 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37497 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37498 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37499 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37500 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37501 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37504 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37505 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37506 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37507 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37508 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37512 domains = +local_domains
37513 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37514 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37517 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37518 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37519 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37520 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37521 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37525 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37526 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37527 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37528 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37529 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37530 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37531 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37532 empty components for compatibility.
37536 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37537 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37538 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37539 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37540 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37541 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37543 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37544 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37545 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37546 example, a header such as
37550 might get rewritten as
37552 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37554 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37555 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37558 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37559 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37560 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37561 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37562 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37563 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37564 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37568 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37571 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37572 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37573 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37574 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37575 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37576 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37577 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37580 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37582 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37584 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37587 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37590 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37592 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37595 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37598 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37599 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37602 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37603 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37604 used to contain the envelope information.
37608 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37609 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37610 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37611 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37612 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37615 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37616 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37617 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37618 processing is the same in both cases.
37620 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37621 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37622 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37623 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37624 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37625 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37626 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37627 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37628 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37631 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37632 pipelining extension to SMTP
37633 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2197,RFC 2197))
37634 to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets required for the transaction.
37636 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37637 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37638 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37639 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37640 is called for verification.
37642 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37643 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37644 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37646 .cindex "carriage return"
37648 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37649 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37650 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37653 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37654 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37655 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37656 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37657 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37658 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37659 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37660 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37661 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37663 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37664 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37665 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37666 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37668 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37669 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37670 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37671 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37673 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37674 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37675 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37676 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37677 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected.
37678 If it finds one, it arranges to attempt that message on the same connection.
37680 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37681 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37683 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37684 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37685 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37686 square bracket of the IP address.
37691 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37692 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37693 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37694 .cindex "host" "error"
37695 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37696 message errors, and recipient errors.
37699 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37700 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37701 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37704 Connection refused or timed out,
37706 Any error response code on connection,
37708 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37710 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37712 I/O errors at any time,
37714 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37715 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37718 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37719 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37720 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37721 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37722 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37723 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37724 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37725 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37727 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37728 .cindex "message" "error"
37729 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37730 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37731 message errors are:
37734 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37737 Timeout after MAIL,
37739 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37740 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37741 connection at any other time.
37744 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37745 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37746 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37747 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37748 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37749 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37750 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37751 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37752 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37753 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37755 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37756 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37757 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37760 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37761 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37762 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37763 recipient errors are:
37766 Any error response to RCPT,
37768 Timeout after RCPT.
37771 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37772 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37773 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37774 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37775 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37776 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37777 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37778 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37779 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37780 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37781 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37782 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37783 the retry clock is reset.
37785 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37786 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37787 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37788 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37789 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37790 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37791 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37792 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37793 recipient's retry time.
37796 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37797 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37798 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37799 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37800 until the next delivery attempt.
37802 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37803 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37804 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37805 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37806 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37809 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37810 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37811 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37812 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37813 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37814 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37815 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37817 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37818 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37819 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37820 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37821 then to be treated as a host error.
37823 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37824 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37825 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37826 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37827 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37832 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37833 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37834 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37837 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37838 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37839 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37841 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37843 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37844 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37845 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37846 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37847 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37848 stream and exits with an error code.
37850 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37851 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37852 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37853 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37855 .cindex "carriage return"
37857 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37858 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37859 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37861 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37862 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37863 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37865 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37866 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37867 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37868 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37869 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37870 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37871 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37872 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37874 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37875 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37876 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37877 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37878 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37879 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37880 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37881 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37882 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37884 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37885 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37886 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37888 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37889 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37890 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37891 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37892 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37894 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37895 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37896 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37897 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37898 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37899 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37900 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37902 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37903 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37904 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37905 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37906 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37908 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37909 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37910 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37911 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37912 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37913 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37914 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37915 a delivery process.
37917 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37918 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37919 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37920 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37921 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37923 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37924 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37925 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37926 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37928 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37929 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37930 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37934 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37935 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37936 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37937 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37938 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37939 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37940 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37941 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37944 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37945 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37946 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37947 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37948 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37949 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37950 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37951 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37952 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37953 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37954 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37958 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37959 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37960 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37961 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37962 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37963 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37964 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37965 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37967 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37968 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37969 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37970 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37971 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37974 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37975 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37976 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37978 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37979 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37980 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37981 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37982 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37987 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37988 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37989 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
37990 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
37992 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
37993 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
37994 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37995 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37996 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37997 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37998 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37999 SMTP response codes.
38001 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
38002 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
38003 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
38004 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
38005 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
38006 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
38007 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
38008 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
38013 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
38014 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
38015 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
38016 Most modern installations never need to use this.
38017 It is used for managing messages queued for an intermittently-connecting
38018 destination (eg. one using a dialup connection).
38020 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_etrn%&"
38021 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
38022 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_etrn%& option.
38024 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1985,RFC 1985)
38025 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
38026 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
38027 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
38028 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
38029 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
38031 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
38032 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
38033 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
38034 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
38035 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
38036 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
38037 argument. For example,
38045 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
38046 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
38047 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
38048 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
38049 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
38051 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
38052 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
38053 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
38054 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
38055 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
38056 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
38057 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
38058 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
38060 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
38061 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
38062 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
38063 whatever the form of its argument. For
38066 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
38067 $sender_host_address
38069 .vindex "&$domain$&"
38070 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
38071 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
38072 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
38073 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
38074 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
38075 for it to change them before running the command.
38079 .subsection "The ATRN command, and ODMR" SECTODMR
38080 .cindex ATRN processing
38081 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ATRN
38082 .cindex ODMR provider
38083 A second method for handling
38084 On-Demand Message Reception (ODMR)
38085 for intermittently-connecting destinations is specified by
38086 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2645.html,RFC 2645).
38088 This describes an ESMTP command called ATRN which requests
38089 a swap in server/client roles of the communicating SMTP endpoints,
38090 and delivery of queued messages.
38091 Note that this supports customers having IP addresses that
38094 Exim supports both the &"provider"& and &"customer"& sides of ODMR,
38095 to use the terms of that specification.
38097 . need a sub-subsection here
38098 .subsection "ODMR provider connection" SECTODMRPRDVR
38100 In the &"provider"& use case Exim is
38101 initially an SMTP server, then transferring to an SMTP client
38102 role if an ATRN command is accepted.
38104 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_atrn%&"
38105 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
38106 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_atrn%& option.
38107 Per the standard, this should only be for a specific
38108 provider port number (386, named "odmr");
38109 Exim should be configured to listen on that port
38110 (in addition to other duties) via &%daemon_smtp_ports%&
38111 or equivalent commandline options, and restrict the
38112 advertising of the facility to the port:
38114 acl_smtp_atrn = ${if = {$received_port}{386} {check_atrn}{}}
38117 A recieved ATRN command will be rejected unless
38118 authentication has previously been done on the connection.
38120 Any arguments supplied with an ATRN command are (per standard)
38121 a comma-separated list of requested domains,
38122 and will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
38125 The ACL configured may return &"deny"& for any policy reaons
38126 (for example, the authenticated user is not permitted the facility).
38127 Otherwise it should use the ACL &"atrn_domains"& condition,
38128 which returns true if there are queued messages for any of
38129 the given list of domains.
38130 If that condition fails the ACL should return &"defer"&
38131 with a "453 You have no mail" response;
38132 else it should return &"accept"&.
38134 For example (with default domain handling, and one possible de-taint method) :
38137 warn set acl_m0 = clientdom.net
38138 deny condition = ${if def:smtp_command_argument}
38139 set acl_m0 = ${map \
38140 {<, $smtp_command_argument} \
38141 {${if inlist{$item}{clientdom.net:cl2dom.net} {$value}}} \
38143 condition = ${if !def:acl_m0}
38144 defer !atrn_domains = <, $acl_m0
38145 message = 453 You have no mail
38149 Acceptance by the ACL will result in a queue-run for messages
38150 having addresses with the given domains.
38151 A suitable router and transport must be configured for the deliveries.
38153 To access a named queue
38154 .cindex queue named
38155 the ACL should use a "queue =" modifier before the "atrn_domains"
38157 If the ACL does not accept, re-set the queue to an empty value
38158 so as to not disrupt any later SMTP operations on the connection.
38160 Use of the &"atrn_domains"& condition additionally sets up
38161 the &$atrn_host$& variable, which can be used by a manualroute
38162 router. Being otherwise empty, this router will decline in
38163 other situations so can be safely placed in a general router chain.
38169 driver = manualroute
38170 route_data = <;$atrn_host
38171 transport = call_customer
38178 Although not discssed in the specification document,
38179 Exim supports use of ATRN within a STARTTLS-
38180 or TLS-on-connect- encrypted connection
38181 (which is wise if a plaintext authentication mechanism is used).
38182 In such cases the TLS connection will remain open across the
38183 role-swap, and be used for the sending of queued messages.
38185 Note that the RFC requires that the CRAM-MD5 authentication
38186 method be supported.
38187 Exim does not enforce this, but leaves it up to the configuration;
38188 see chapter &<<CHID9>>&.
38191 .subsection "ODMR customer connection" SECTODMRCUST
38192 .cindex ODMR customer
38193 Exim supports the &"customer"& side of ODMR,
38194 with a command-line option &"-atrn"&& that requests a connection
38195 to a given host, issuance of an ATRN command then operation
38196 in SMTP server mode.
38197 The option must be followed by two arguments.
38199 The first is the name or IP of the provider to be contacted.
38201 The second, which may be empty, should be a comma-separated list
38202 of domains for which mail is to be requested.
38203 Interpretation of the list is up to the provider;
38204 an empty list is expected to result in some default being returned.
38206 The provider host is placed in &$domain$" for routing;
38207 router and transport must be configured suitably to make the connection.
38212 driver = manualroute
38213 condition = ${if eq {$atrn_mode}{C}}
38214 route_data = <;$domain
38215 transport = call_provider
38222 command_timeout = 10m
38225 Note that the specification requires a long timeout for the ATRN
38226 command, to allow for scanning of queued messages.
38228 Configuration should also include client-side authentication
38229 and processing for receiving messages.
38234 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
38235 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
38236 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
38237 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
38238 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
38239 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
38240 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
38241 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
38242 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
38243 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
38244 runs for RCPT commands:
38248 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
38252 .section "Batched SMTP" "SECTgenbatchSMTP"
38253 .subsection "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
38254 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
38255 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
38256 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
38257 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
38258 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
38259 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
38260 envelope along with the message.
38262 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
38263 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
38264 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
38265 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
38266 can be used to specify it.
38268 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
38269 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
38270 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
38271 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
38272 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
38275 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
38276 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
38277 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
38282 driver = manualroute
38283 transport = smtp_appendfile
38284 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
38288 driver = appendfile
38289 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
38294 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
38295 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
38296 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
38300 .subsection "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
38301 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
38302 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
38303 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
38304 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
38305 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
38306 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
38307 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
38308 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
38309 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
38311 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
38312 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
38314 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
38315 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
38316 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
38317 make some use of automatically, for example:
38319 554 Unexpected end of file
38320 Transaction started in line 10
38321 Error detected in line 14
38323 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
38326 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
38327 The error message was:
38329 501 '>' missing at end of address
38331 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
38332 The error was detected in line 12.
38333 The SMTP command at fault was:
38335 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
38337 1 previous message was successfully processed.
38338 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
38340 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
38341 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
38343 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
38344 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
38348 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38349 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38351 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
38352 "Customizing messages"
38353 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
38354 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
38355 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
38356 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
38357 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
38359 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
38360 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
38361 option. Exim also adds the line
38363 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
38365 to all warning and bounce messages,
38368 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
38369 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
38370 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
38371 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
38372 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
38373 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
38374 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
38376 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
38377 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
38378 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
38379 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
38380 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
38383 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
38384 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
38385 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
38386 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
38387 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
38388 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
38389 option, rounded to a whole number.
38391 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
38394 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38395 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38397 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
38398 failing addresses with their error messages.
38400 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
38401 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
38403 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
38404 The fields exist for back-compatibility
38407 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
38408 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
38409 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
38411 Subject: Mail delivery failed
38412 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38413 {: returning message to sender}}
38415 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38417 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38418 {that you sent }{sent by
38422 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
38423 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
38425 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
38427 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
38430 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
38432 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
38435 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
38436 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
38437 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
38438 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
38439 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
38443 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38444 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38446 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
38447 the delayed addresses.
38449 The third item then ends the message.
38452 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
38453 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
38455 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
38456 $warn_message_delay
38458 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38460 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
38461 {that you sent }{sent by
38465 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
38466 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
38468 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
38469 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
38470 The date of the message is: $h_date
38472 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
38474 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
38475 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
38476 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
38477 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
38478 the message will be returned to you.
38480 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
38481 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
38482 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
38483 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
38484 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
38485 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
38486 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
38487 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
38493 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38494 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38496 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
38497 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
38498 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
38502 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
38503 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
38504 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
38505 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
38506 routing explicitly:
38508 send_to_smart_host:
38509 driver = manualroute
38510 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
38511 transport = remote_smtp
38513 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
38514 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
38515 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
38516 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
38517 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
38522 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
38523 .cindex "mailing lists"
38524 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
38525 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
38526 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
38528 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
38529 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
38530 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
38531 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
38535 domains = lists.example
38536 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38539 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38542 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
38543 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
38544 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
38545 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
38547 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
38548 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
38551 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
38552 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
38553 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
38554 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
38555 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
38557 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
38558 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
38559 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
38560 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
38561 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
38562 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
38563 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
38564 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
38565 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
38569 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
38570 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
38571 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
38572 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
38573 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
38574 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
38575 addresses are not rigorously checked.
38577 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
38578 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
38579 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
38580 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
38581 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
38585 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
38586 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
38587 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
38588 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
38589 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
38590 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
38591 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
38592 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
38593 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
38594 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
38596 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
38597 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
38598 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
38599 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
38600 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
38601 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
38602 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
38603 pre-existing messages.
38605 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
38606 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
38607 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
38608 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
38609 one level of expansion anyway.
38613 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
38614 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
38615 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
38616 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
38617 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
38618 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
38620 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
38621 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
38625 domains = lists.example
38626 local_part_suffix = -request
38627 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38628 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38633 domains = lists.example
38634 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38635 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38636 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38639 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38644 domains = lists.example
38646 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38648 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38649 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38650 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38653 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38654 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38655 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38656 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38657 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38658 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38659 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38660 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38661 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38663 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38664 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38665 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38670 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38672 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38673 .cindex "envelope from"
38674 .cindex "envelope sender"
38675 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38676 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38677 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38678 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38679 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38680 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38682 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38683 .oindex &%return_path%&
38684 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38685 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38686 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38687 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38688 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38689 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38690 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38696 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38697 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38699 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38700 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38701 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38702 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38703 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38704 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38705 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38708 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38710 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38711 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38712 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38713 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38714 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38715 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38717 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38718 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38719 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38720 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38724 domains = ! +local_domains
38726 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38727 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38730 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38731 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38732 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38733 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38736 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38737 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38738 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38739 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38740 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38744 domains = ! +local_domains
38745 transport = remote_smtp
38747 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38748 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38751 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38752 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38753 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38754 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38757 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38758 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38759 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38760 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38761 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38762 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38770 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38771 .cindex "virtual domains"
38772 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38773 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38777 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38778 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38779 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38781 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38782 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38783 have login accounts on that host.
38786 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38787 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38788 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38789 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38790 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38791 to a router of this form:
38795 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38796 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38799 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38800 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38801 domain that is being processed.
38802 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38803 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38805 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38806 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38807 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38808 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38810 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38811 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38812 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38813 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38815 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38816 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38817 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38821 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38822 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38823 transport = my_mailboxes
38825 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38826 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38827 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38828 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38829 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38833 driver = appendfile
38834 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38837 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38838 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38840 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38841 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38842 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38843 information about the domains.
38847 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38848 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38849 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38850 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38851 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38852 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38853 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38854 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38855 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38856 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38857 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38858 example, consider this router:
38863 file = $home/.forward
38864 local_part_suffix = -*
38865 local_part_suffix_optional
38868 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38869 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38870 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38871 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38873 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38874 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38877 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38878 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38879 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38880 control over which suffixes are valid.
38882 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38883 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38889 local_part_suffix = -*
38890 local_part_suffix_optional
38891 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38894 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38895 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38896 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38897 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38898 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38902 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38903 .cindex "vacation processing"
38904 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38905 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38906 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38907 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38908 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38911 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38912 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38913 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38914 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38916 spqr, vacation-spqr
38919 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38920 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38921 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38922 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38923 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38927 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38928 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38932 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38933 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38934 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38935 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38936 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38937 each day's messages.
38939 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38940 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38941 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38942 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38946 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38947 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38948 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38949 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38950 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38951 permanently connected.
38953 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38954 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38955 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38958 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38959 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38960 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38961 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38962 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38963 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38964 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38965 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38967 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38968 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38969 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38970 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38971 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38972 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38975 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38976 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38977 intermittent host. For example:
38979 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38981 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38982 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38983 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38984 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38985 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38986 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38989 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
38990 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
38991 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
38992 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
38993 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
38994 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
38995 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
38999 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
39000 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
39001 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
39002 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
39003 delivered immediately.
39005 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
39006 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
39007 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
39008 .cindex "first pass routing"
39009 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
39010 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
39011 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
39012 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
39013 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
39014 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
39015 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
39016 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
39017 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
39018 single SMTP connection.
39022 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39023 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39025 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
39026 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
39027 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
39028 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
39029 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
39030 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
39031 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
39032 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
39033 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
39034 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
39037 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
39038 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
39039 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
39040 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
39041 email is not desirable.
39043 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
39044 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
39045 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
39046 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
39047 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
39048 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
39049 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
39051 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
39052 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
39053 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
39054 before sending a message to the smart host.
39056 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
39057 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
39058 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
39060 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
39061 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
39062 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
39063 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
39064 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
39065 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
39066 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
39068 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
39072 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
39073 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
39075 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
39076 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
39077 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
39078 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
39079 successful, a zero return code is given.
39081 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
39082 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
39083 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
39084 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
39085 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
39088 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
39089 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
39090 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
39092 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
39093 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
39094 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
39095 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
39096 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
39098 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
39099 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
39100 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
39102 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
39103 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
39104 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
39105 are ever generated.
39107 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
39109 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
39110 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
39111 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
39114 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
39115 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
39116 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
39117 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
39118 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
39119 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
39124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39125 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39127 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
39128 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
39129 .cindex "log" "types of"
39130 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
39135 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
39136 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
39137 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
39138 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
39139 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
39140 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
39141 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
39142 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
39144 .cindex "reject log"
39145 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
39146 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
39147 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
39148 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
39149 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
39150 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
39151 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
39152 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
39153 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
39156 .cindex "panic log"
39157 .cindex "system log"
39158 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
39159 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
39160 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
39161 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
39162 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
39163 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
39164 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
39165 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
39166 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
39169 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
39170 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
39171 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
39173 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
39176 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
39177 ways of changing this:
39180 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
39185 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
39187 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
39190 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
39194 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39195 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39196 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
39197 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
39198 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
39199 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
39204 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
39205 .cindex "log" "destination"
39206 .cindex "log" "to file"
39207 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
39209 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
39210 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
39211 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
39212 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
39213 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
39214 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
39215 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
39217 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
39218 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
39219 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
39220 references to the host name:
39222 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
39224 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
39225 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
39226 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
39227 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
39228 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
39231 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
39232 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
39233 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
39234 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
39235 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
39236 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
39237 implying the use of a default path.
39239 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
39240 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
39241 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
39242 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
39243 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
39244 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
39246 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
39248 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
39249 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
39250 that is where the logs are written.
39252 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
39253 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
39255 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
39257 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
39258 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
39259 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
39260 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
39262 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
39267 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
39268 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
39269 .cindex "cycling logs"
39270 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
39271 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
39272 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
39273 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
39274 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
39275 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
39276 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
39278 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
39279 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
39280 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
39281 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
39282 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
39283 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
39284 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
39285 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
39286 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
39287 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
39288 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
39293 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
39294 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
39295 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
39296 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
39297 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
39298 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
39299 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
39300 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
39302 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
39303 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
39304 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
39305 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
39307 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
39308 examples of names generated by the above examples:
39310 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
39311 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
39312 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
39313 /var/log/exim/main.200212
39315 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
39316 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
39317 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
39318 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
39320 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
39321 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
39322 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
39323 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
39324 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
39325 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
39328 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39329 /var/log/exim-panic.log
39330 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39331 /var/log/exim/panic
39335 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
39336 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
39337 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
39338 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
39339 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
39340 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
39341 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
39342 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
39343 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
39344 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
39345 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
39346 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
39347 the time and host name to each line.
39348 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
39351 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
39353 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
39355 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
39358 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
39359 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
39360 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
39361 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
39363 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
39364 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
39365 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
39366 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
39367 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
39368 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
39369 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
39370 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3164,RFC 3164), you should set
39372 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
39374 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
39375 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
39377 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
39378 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
39379 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
39380 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
39381 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
39382 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
39383 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
39384 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
39385 name, and pid as added by syslog:
39387 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
39388 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
39389 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
39390 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
39393 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
39396 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
39397 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
39398 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
39399 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
39401 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
39402 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
39403 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
39404 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
39405 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
39406 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
39408 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
39409 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
39410 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
39413 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
39415 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
39416 without modification.
39418 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
39419 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
39420 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
39425 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
39426 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
39427 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
39428 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
39429 timestamp. The flags are:
39430 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
39431 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
39432 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
39433 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
39434 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
39435 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
39436 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
39437 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
39438 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
39442 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
39443 .cindex "log" "reception line"
39444 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39445 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
39446 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
39448 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
39449 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
39450 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
39452 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
39453 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
39454 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
39458 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
39462 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
39463 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
39464 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
39465 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
39466 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
39467 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
39468 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
39469 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
39470 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
39471 name in parentheses.
39473 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
39474 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
39475 the log containing text like these examples:
39477 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
39478 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
39480 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
39483 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
39484 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
39487 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
39488 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
39489 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
39490 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
39491 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
39492 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
39493 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
39494 suite that was used.
39496 .cindex log protocol
39497 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
39498 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
39499 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
39500 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
39501 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
39502 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
39503 authenticator name.
39505 .cindex "size" "of message"
39506 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
39507 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
39508 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
39509 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
39512 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39513 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39517 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
39518 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
39519 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39520 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
39521 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
39522 to fit it on the page:
39524 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
39525 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
39526 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
39527 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
39528 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
39530 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
39531 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
39532 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
39533 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
39534 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
39536 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
39537 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
39538 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
39539 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
39540 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
39542 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
39543 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
39545 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
39547 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
39548 parentheses afterwards.
39550 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
39551 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
39552 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
39553 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
39554 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
39555 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
39556 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39557 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
39558 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
39559 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39560 TLS cipher information is still available.
39562 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
39563 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
39564 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
39565 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
39566 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
39568 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
39569 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
39571 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39572 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39575 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
39576 .cindex "discarded messages"
39577 .cindex "message" "discarded"
39578 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
39579 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
39580 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
39582 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
39583 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
39585 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
39586 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
39588 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
39589 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
39593 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
39594 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
39596 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
39597 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
39599 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
39600 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
39601 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
39603 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
39604 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
39606 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
39607 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
39608 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
39612 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
39613 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
39614 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
39615 following form is logged:
39617 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
39618 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
39620 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
39621 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
39623 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
39624 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
39625 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
39626 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
39627 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39629 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39630 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39631 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39632 flagged with &`**`&.
39636 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39637 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39638 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39639 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39640 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39644 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39647 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39649 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39650 at the end of its processing.
39655 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39656 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39657 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39658 the following table:
39660 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39661 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39662 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39663 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39664 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39665 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39666 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39667 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39668 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39669 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39670 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39671 &`H `& host name and IP address
39672 &`I `& local interface used
39673 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39674 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39675 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39676 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39677 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39678 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39679 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39680 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39681 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39682 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39683 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39684 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39685 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39686 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39687 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39688 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39689 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39690 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39691 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39692 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39693 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39694 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39698 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39699 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39700 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39703 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39704 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39705 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39706 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39707 during the first delivery attempt.
39709 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39710 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39711 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39713 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39714 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39715 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39716 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39717 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39720 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39721 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39724 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39725 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39727 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39728 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39730 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39731 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39732 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39736 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39739 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39740 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39741 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39748 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39749 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39750 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39751 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39752 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39755 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39757 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39758 selection marked by asterisks:
39759 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39760 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39761 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39762 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39763 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39764 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39765 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39766 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39767 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39768 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39769 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39770 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39771 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39772 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39773 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39774 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39775 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39776 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39777 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39778 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39779 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39780 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39781 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39782 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39783 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39784 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39785 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39786 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39787 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39788 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39789 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39790 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39791 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39792 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39793 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39794 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39795 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39796 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39797 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39798 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39799 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39800 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39801 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39802 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39803 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39804 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39805 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39806 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39807 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39808 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39809 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39810 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39811 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39812 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39813 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39814 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39815 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39816 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39818 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39819 section &<<SECID99>>&
39821 More details on each of these items follows:
39825 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39826 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39827 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39828 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39829 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39830 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39832 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39833 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39834 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39835 this log selector is set.
39837 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39838 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39839 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39840 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39841 such users cannot access the log).
39843 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39844 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39845 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39846 parentheses between them.
39848 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39849 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39850 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39851 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39852 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39853 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39854 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39855 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39856 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39857 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39858 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39859 between the caller and Exim.
39861 .cindex log "connection identifier"
39862 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
39863 &%connection_id%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39864 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39865 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39866 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39868 .cindex log "connection rejections"
39869 .cindex connection "rejection logging"
39870 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39871 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39873 .cindex log "delayed delivery"
39874 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39875 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39876 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39877 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39878 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39880 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39881 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39882 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39883 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39884 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39886 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39887 .cindex "size" "of message"
39888 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39889 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39891 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39892 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39893 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39894 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39896 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39897 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39898 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39899 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39900 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39902 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39903 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39904 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39905 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39906 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39909 .cindex dnssec logging
39910 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39911 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39912 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39913 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39914 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39916 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39917 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39918 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39919 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39920 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39921 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39923 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39924 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39925 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39926 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39927 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39929 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39930 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39931 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39932 client's ident port times out.
39934 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39935 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39936 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39937 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39938 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39939 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39940 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39941 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39942 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39943 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39944 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39945 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39946 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39948 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39949 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39950 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39951 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39952 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39953 on a proxied connection
39954 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39955 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39957 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39958 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39959 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39960 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39961 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39962 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39963 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39964 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39965 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39966 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39967 important with the widening use of NAT
39968 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505)).
39970 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39971 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39972 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39974 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39975 .cindex millisecond logging
39976 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39977 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39978 appended to the seconds value.
39980 .cindex "log" "message id"
39981 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39983 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39984 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39985 (submission mode) without one.
39986 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39988 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39989 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39990 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39991 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39992 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39993 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
39994 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
39995 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
39996 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39998 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
39999 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
40000 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
40001 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
40002 containing => tags) following the IP address.
40003 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
40004 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
40005 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
40006 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
40007 local port is a random ephemeral port.
40009 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
40010 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
40011 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
40012 immediately after the time and date.
40014 .cindex log pipelining
40015 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
40016 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
40017 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
40018 The field is a single "L".
40020 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
40021 the field has a minus appended.
40023 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
40024 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
40025 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
40026 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
40027 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
40030 .cindex "log" "queue run"
40031 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
40032 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
40034 .cindex "log" "queue time"
40035 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
40036 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
40038 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
40039 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
40041 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
40042 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
40043 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
40045 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
40046 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
40047 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
40048 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
40049 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
40051 .cindex "log" "recipients"
40052 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
40053 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
40054 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
40055 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
40057 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
40060 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
40061 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
40062 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
40063 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
40065 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
40066 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
40067 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
40068 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
40069 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
40071 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
40072 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
40073 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
40074 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
40077 .cindex "log" "return path"
40078 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
40079 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
40080 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
40081 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
40083 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
40084 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
40085 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
40086 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
40087 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
40089 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
40090 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
40091 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
40092 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
40095 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
40096 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
40099 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
40100 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
40101 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
40102 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
40104 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
40105 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
40106 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
40107 &"message is frozen"&.
40109 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
40110 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
40111 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
40112 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
40113 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
40114 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
40117 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
40118 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
40119 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
40120 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
40121 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
40122 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
40123 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
40124 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
40125 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
40126 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
40128 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
40129 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
40130 reset if the daemon is restarted.
40131 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
40132 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
40133 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
40134 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
40135 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
40137 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
40138 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
40139 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
40140 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
40141 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
40142 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
40144 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
40145 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
40146 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
40147 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
40148 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
40149 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
40150 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
40151 already have their own log lines.
40153 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
40154 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
40155 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
40156 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
40157 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
40158 the same logging options.
40160 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
40161 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
40165 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
40166 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
40167 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
40168 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
40169 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
40171 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
40172 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
40173 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
40174 was accepted or used.
40176 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
40177 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
40178 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
40179 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
40180 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
40181 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
40182 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
40183 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
40185 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
40186 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
40187 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
40188 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
40189 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
40190 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
40191 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
40192 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
40193 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
40195 .cindex "log" "subject"
40196 .cindex "subject, logging"
40197 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
40198 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
40199 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
40200 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
40201 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
40203 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
40205 .cindex DANE logging
40206 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
40207 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
40209 using a CA trust anchor,
40210 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
40211 and &`CV=no`& if not.
40213 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
40214 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
40215 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40216 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
40218 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
40219 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
40220 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40221 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
40222 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
40224 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
40225 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
40226 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40227 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
40228 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
40230 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
40231 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
40232 .cindex SNI logging
40233 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
40234 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
40235 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
40237 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
40238 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
40239 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
40240 a bad IP address was in the list.
40244 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
40245 .cindex "message" "log file for"
40246 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
40247 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
40248 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
40249 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
40250 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
40251 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
40252 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
40253 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
40254 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
40255 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
40256 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
40258 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
40259 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
40260 &%message_logs%& option false.
40266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40269 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
40270 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
40271 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
40272 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
40273 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
40275 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
40276 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
40277 "list what Exim processes are doing"
40278 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
40279 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
40280 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
40281 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
40283 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
40284 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
40285 "extract statistics from the log"
40286 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
40287 "check address acceptance from given IP"
40288 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
40289 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
40290 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
40291 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
40292 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
40293 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
40294 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
40297 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
40298 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
40299 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
40304 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
40305 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
40306 .cindex "process, querying"
40308 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
40309 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
40310 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
40311 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
40312 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
40313 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
40314 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
40315 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
40317 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
40318 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
40319 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
40322 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
40323 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
40324 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
40325 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
40326 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
40328 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
40329 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
40330 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
40331 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
40332 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
40334 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
40336 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
40337 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
40338 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
40339 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
40340 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
40341 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
40343 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
40344 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
40348 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
40349 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
40350 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
40351 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
40355 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
40359 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
40360 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
40363 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
40364 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40365 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
40369 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
40370 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40371 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
40373 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
40374 Match against the size field.
40376 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40377 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
40379 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40380 Match messages that are older than the given time.
40383 Match only frozen messages.
40386 Match only non-frozen messages.
40388 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
40389 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
40392 The following options control the format of the output:
40396 Display only the count of matching messages.
40399 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
40403 Display message ids only.
40406 Brief format &-- one line per message.
40409 Display messages in reverse order.
40412 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
40415 The following options give alternates for configuration:
40418 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
40419 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
40420 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
40422 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
40423 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
40424 overriding the built-in one.
40427 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
40428 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
40432 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
40433 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
40434 .cindex "queue" "summary"
40435 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
40436 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
40437 running a command such as
40439 exim -bp | exiqsumm
40441 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
40442 it, as in the following example:
40444 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
40446 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
40447 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
40448 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
40449 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
40451 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
40452 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
40453 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
40454 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
40455 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
40456 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
40459 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
40460 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
40461 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
40462 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
40463 level"& addresses).
40468 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
40470 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
40471 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
40472 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
40473 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
40474 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
40475 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
40476 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
40477 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
40478 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
40479 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
40481 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
40483 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
40485 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
40486 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
40487 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
40489 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
40490 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
40491 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
40492 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
40493 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
40495 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
40496 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
40497 regular expression.
40499 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
40500 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
40502 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
40503 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
40507 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
40508 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
40509 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
40510 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
40511 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
40512 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
40515 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
40516 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
40517 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
40518 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
40519 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
40522 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
40523 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
40524 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
40525 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
40526 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
40527 the &%--help%& option.
40530 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
40531 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
40532 .cindex "cycling logs"
40533 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
40534 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
40535 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
40536 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
40537 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
40538 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
40539 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
40541 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
40542 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
40544 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
40545 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
40546 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
40550 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
40551 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
40552 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
40553 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
40554 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
40555 logs are handled similarly.
40557 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
40558 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
40559 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
40560 any existing log files.
40562 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
40563 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
40564 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
40565 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
40566 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
40568 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
40570 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
40571 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
40575 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
40576 .cindex "statistics"
40577 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
40578 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
40579 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
40580 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
40581 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
40583 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
40584 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
40585 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
40586 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
40587 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
40589 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
40591 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
40592 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
40593 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
40594 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
40595 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
40596 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
40597 also produced per user.
40599 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
40600 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
40601 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
40602 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
40603 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
40605 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
40606 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
40607 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
40608 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
40609 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
40610 an entirely separate message.
40612 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
40613 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
40614 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
40615 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
40616 least one address that failed.
40618 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
40619 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
40620 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
40621 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
40622 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
40623 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
40624 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
40626 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
40627 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
40628 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40630 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40631 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40632 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40634 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40637 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40638 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40639 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40640 .cindex "checking access"
40641 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40642 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40643 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40644 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40645 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40646 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40648 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40649 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40651 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40653 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40654 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40655 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40656 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40659 550 Relay not permitted
40661 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40662 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40663 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40664 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40667 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40668 -f himself@there.example
40670 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40671 mandatory arguments.
40673 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40674 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40675 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40679 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40680 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40681 .cindex "building DBM files"
40682 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40683 .cindex "lower casing"
40684 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40685 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40686 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40687 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40688 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40689 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40691 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40692 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40693 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40694 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40697 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40698 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40699 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40703 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40704 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40705 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40706 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40708 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40710 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40711 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40713 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40714 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40715 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40716 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40717 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40718 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40720 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40721 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40722 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40723 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40724 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40725 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40726 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40732 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40733 .cindex "retry" "times"
40734 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40735 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40736 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40737 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40738 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40739 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40740 output. For example:
40742 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40743 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40744 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40745 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40746 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40747 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40748 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40749 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40750 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40751 past final cutoff time
40753 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40754 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40755 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40756 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40757 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40758 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40761 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40762 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40763 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40764 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40765 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40766 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40770 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40771 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40772 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40773 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40774 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40775 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40776 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40779 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40781 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40784 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40786 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40788 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40790 &'misc'&: other hints data
40793 The &'misc'& database is used for
40796 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40797 &(smtp)& transport)
40799 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40802 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40804 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40809 .subsection "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40810 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40811 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40812 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40813 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40814 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40815 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40816 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40817 For example, to dump the retry database:
40819 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40821 For the retry database
40822 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40824 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40825 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40827 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40828 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40829 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40830 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40831 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40832 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40833 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40834 and a textual description of the error.
40836 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40837 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40838 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40841 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40842 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40843 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40844 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40845 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40846 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40851 .subsection "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40852 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40853 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40854 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40855 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40856 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40857 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40858 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40859 updated sufficiently often.
40861 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40862 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40863 the retry database:
40865 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40867 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40868 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40869 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40870 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40871 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40872 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40873 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40874 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40875 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40876 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40877 whenever it removes information from the database.
40879 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40880 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40881 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40882 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40883 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40885 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40886 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40887 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40888 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40889 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40890 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40891 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40894 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40895 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40900 .subsection "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40901 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40902 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40903 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40904 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40905 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40906 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40909 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40910 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40911 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40912 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40913 by new data, for example:
40917 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40918 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40919 used as optional separators.
40921 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40922 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40928 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40929 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40930 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40931 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40932 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40933 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40934 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40935 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40936 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40937 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40938 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40939 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40940 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40944 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40947 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40950 .vitem &%-interval%&
40951 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40952 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40954 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40955 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40958 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40961 Suppress verification output.
40963 .vitem &%-retries%&
40964 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40965 the lock (default 10).
40967 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40968 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40969 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40970 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40973 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40974 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40975 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40976 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40979 Generate verbose output.
40982 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40983 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40984 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40985 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40986 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40987 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40988 more than 30 minutes old.
40990 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
40991 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
40992 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
40993 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
40994 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
40995 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
40997 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
40998 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
40999 suppresses all output except error messages.
41003 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
41005 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
41007 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
41008 <&'some commands'&>
41011 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
41012 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
41015 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
41016 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
41018 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
41019 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
41022 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
41023 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
41024 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
41025 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
41026 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
41028 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
41030 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41031 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41033 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
41034 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
41035 .cindex "X-windows"
41036 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
41037 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
41038 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
41039 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
41040 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
41041 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
41042 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
41043 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
41047 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
41048 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
41049 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
41050 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
41051 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
41052 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
41053 parameters are for.
41055 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
41056 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
41057 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
41059 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
41061 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
41062 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
41063 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
41064 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
41065 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
41067 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
41068 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
41070 Eximon*background: gray94
41072 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
41073 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
41074 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
41075 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
41076 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
41077 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
41078 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
41081 Eximon*highlight: gray
41084 .cindex "admin user"
41085 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
41086 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
41088 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
41089 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
41090 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
41091 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
41092 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
41094 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
41095 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
41096 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
41097 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
41098 different parts of the display.
41103 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
41104 .cindex "stripchart"
41105 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
41106 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
41107 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
41108 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
41109 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
41110 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
41111 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
41112 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
41113 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
41115 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
41116 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
41117 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
41118 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
41120 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
41121 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
41122 to a single partition.
41124 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
41125 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
41126 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
41127 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
41128 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
41129 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
41130 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
41135 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
41136 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
41137 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
41138 .cindex "window size"
41139 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
41140 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
41141 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
41142 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
41143 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
41144 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
41146 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
41147 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
41148 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
41149 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
41151 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
41152 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
41153 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
41154 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
41155 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
41156 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41158 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
41159 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
41160 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41164 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
41165 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
41166 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
41167 the main log is maintained.
41168 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
41169 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
41170 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
41171 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
41172 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
41174 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
41175 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
41176 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
41177 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
41178 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
41179 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
41180 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
41181 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
41182 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
41183 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
41184 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41186 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
41187 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
41188 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
41189 It cannot go further back up the log.
41191 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
41192 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
41193 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
41194 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
41195 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
41196 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
41198 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
41199 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
41200 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
41201 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
41202 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
41203 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
41205 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
41206 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
41207 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
41208 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
41209 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
41210 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
41211 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
41212 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
41213 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
41218 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
41219 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
41220 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
41221 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
41222 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
41223 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
41224 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
41225 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
41226 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
41227 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
41229 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
41230 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
41231 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
41232 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
41233 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
41234 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
41235 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
41237 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
41238 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
41239 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
41240 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
41241 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
41242 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
41243 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
41245 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
41246 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
41247 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
41248 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
41250 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
41251 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
41252 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
41253 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
41254 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
41255 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
41256 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
41259 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
41260 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
41262 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
41263 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
41264 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
41265 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
41266 display is updated.
41270 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
41271 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
41272 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
41273 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
41274 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
41277 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
41278 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
41279 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
41280 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
41281 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
41283 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
41285 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
41289 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
41290 in a new text window.
41292 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
41293 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
41294 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
41296 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
41297 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
41298 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
41299 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
41301 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
41302 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
41303 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
41304 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
41305 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
41307 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
41308 that the message be frozen.
41310 .cindex "thawing messages"
41311 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
41312 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
41313 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
41314 that the message be thawed.
41316 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
41317 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
41318 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
41319 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
41321 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
41322 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
41325 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
41326 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41327 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41328 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41329 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
41330 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
41331 which case no action is taken.
41333 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
41334 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41335 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41336 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41337 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
41338 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
41339 case no action is taken.
41341 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
41342 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
41344 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
41345 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
41346 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
41347 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
41348 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
41349 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
41350 the address is qualified with that domain.
41353 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
41354 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
41355 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
41356 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
41357 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
41358 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
41359 if no output is generated.
41361 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
41362 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
41363 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
41364 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
41366 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
41367 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
41368 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
41375 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41376 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41378 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
41379 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
41380 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
41381 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
41383 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
41384 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
41385 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
41386 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
41387 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
41388 its security as compared with other MTAs.
41390 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
41391 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
41392 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
41393 as soon as possible.
41396 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
41397 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
41398 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
41399 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
41400 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
41401 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
41404 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
41405 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
41406 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
41407 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
41408 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
41409 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
41411 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
41412 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
41413 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
41414 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
41417 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
41418 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
41419 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
41420 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
41421 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
41422 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
41423 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
41424 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
41425 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
41429 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
41430 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
41431 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
41432 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
41433 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
41434 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
41435 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
41437 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
41440 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
41441 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
41442 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
41443 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
41444 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
41449 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
41451 .cindex "root privilege"
41452 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
41453 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
41454 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
41455 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
41456 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
41457 is required for two things:
41460 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
41461 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
41464 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
41465 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
41469 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
41470 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
41471 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
41472 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
41473 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
41474 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
41475 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
41476 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
41478 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
41479 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
41480 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
41482 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
41483 uid and gid in the following cases:
41488 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
41489 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
41490 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
41491 the calling process.
41492 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
41493 option may not be used at all.
41494 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
41495 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
41496 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
41501 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
41502 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
41505 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
41506 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
41507 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
41508 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
41509 testing address verification
41512 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
41515 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
41516 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
41519 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
41522 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
41523 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
41524 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
41525 will be used during message reception.
41527 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
41528 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
41531 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution.,
41532 including while the recipient addresses in a message are being routed.
41535 However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
41536 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
41537 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
41540 Any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
41541 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid.
41544 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox.
41546 For remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used.
41549 Once all the delivery
41550 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
41551 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
41552 generating bounce and warning messages.
41555 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
41556 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
41562 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
41563 .cindex "privilege, running without"
41564 .cindex "unprivileged running"
41565 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
41566 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
41567 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
41568 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
41569 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
41570 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
41571 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
41575 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
41576 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
41577 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
41578 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
41580 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
41581 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
41582 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
41583 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
41584 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
41586 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
41587 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
41588 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
41591 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
41592 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
41593 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
41595 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
41596 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
41597 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
41598 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
41599 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
41600 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
41601 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
41602 address this problem at this time.
41604 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
41605 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
41606 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
41607 be used in the most straightforward way.
41609 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
41610 number of restrictions on what you can do:
41613 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
41614 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
41615 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
41616 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
41617 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
41619 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
41620 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
41622 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
41623 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
41624 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
41625 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
41627 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
41628 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
41631 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
41632 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
41633 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
41635 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
41636 owned by the Exim user.
41638 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
41639 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41640 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41645 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41646 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41647 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41648 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41650 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41651 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41656 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41657 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41658 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41662 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41663 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41664 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41665 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41666 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41667 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41668 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41671 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41672 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41673 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41674 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41675 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41677 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41678 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41679 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41680 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41681 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41682 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41683 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41685 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41686 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41687 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41689 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41690 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41692 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41693 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41694 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41696 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41697 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41698 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41700 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41701 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41702 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41703 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41709 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41710 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41711 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41712 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41713 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41714 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41715 are some issues to be aware of:
41718 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41720 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41722 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41723 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41724 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41725 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41726 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41727 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41730 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41731 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41732 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41734 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41735 expected to yield one result.
41741 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41742 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41743 .cindex "IP source routing"
41744 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41745 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41746 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41747 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41751 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41752 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41753 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41758 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41759 .cindex "trusted users"
41760 .cindex "admin user"
41761 .cindex "privileged user"
41762 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41763 .cindex "user" "admin"
41764 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41765 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41766 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41767 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41768 permit a remote host to be specified.
41771 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41772 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41773 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41774 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41775 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41776 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41778 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41779 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41780 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41781 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41782 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41784 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41785 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41786 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41787 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41788 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41792 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41793 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41794 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41795 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41796 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41797 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41799 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41800 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41801 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41802 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41803 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41804 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41807 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41808 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41809 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41810 This affects most of the checking options,
41811 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41814 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41815 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41816 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41817 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41818 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41819 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41823 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41824 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41825 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41826 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41827 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41832 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41833 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41834 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41835 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41840 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41841 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41842 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41843 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41844 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41848 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41849 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41850 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41854 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41855 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41856 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41857 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41858 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41859 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41860 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41862 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41863 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41868 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41869 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41870 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41871 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41875 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41876 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41877 enough to hold the result.
41878 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41886 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41887 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41888 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41889 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41890 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41891 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41892 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41893 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41894 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41895 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41896 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41897 themselves are recoverable.
41899 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41900 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41901 and should not be used as such.
41903 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41904 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41905 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41908 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41909 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41910 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41911 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41912 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41914 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41915 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41916 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41917 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41919 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41921 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41924 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41926 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41927 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41928 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41929 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41930 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41931 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41932 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41933 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41936 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41937 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41938 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41939 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41941 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41942 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41943 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41944 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41945 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41946 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41947 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41948 normally the Exim user.
41950 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41951 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41952 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41953 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41954 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41955 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41956 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41957 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41959 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41960 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41961 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41962 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41964 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41965 These contain variables, can appear in any
41966 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41968 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41969 the corresponding data is tainted.
41970 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41972 The following word specifies a variable,
41973 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41976 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41977 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41978 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41979 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41980 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41981 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41982 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41983 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41984 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41987 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41988 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41989 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
41990 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41991 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41992 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41994 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41995 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
41996 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
41997 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41998 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41999 character. It may contain internal newlines.
42001 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
42002 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
42003 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
42005 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
42006 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
42007 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
42008 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
42009 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
42011 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
42012 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
42013 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
42014 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
42015 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
42017 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
42018 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
42019 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
42021 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
42022 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
42023 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
42025 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
42026 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
42027 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
42029 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
42030 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
42031 present if the number is greater than zero.
42033 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
42034 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
42035 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
42037 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
42038 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
42039 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
42041 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
42042 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
42045 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
42046 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
42047 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
42050 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
42051 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
42052 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
42053 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
42055 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
42056 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
42057 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
42059 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
42060 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
42061 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
42062 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
42063 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
42064 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
42066 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
42067 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
42068 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
42069 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
42070 supplied by the remote host, if any.
42072 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
42073 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
42074 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
42075 generated messages.
42078 The message is from a local sender.
42080 .vitem &%-localerror%&
42081 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
42083 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
42084 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
42085 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
42086 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
42088 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
42089 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
42090 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
42093 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
42094 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
42097 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
42098 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
42099 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
42101 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
42102 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
42103 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
42105 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
42106 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
42107 of &$spam_score_int$&.
42109 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
42110 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
42111 rather than Unix-format.
42112 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
42113 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
42115 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
42116 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
42117 certificate was verified by the server.
42119 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
42120 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
42121 name of the cipher suite that was used.
42123 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
42124 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
42125 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
42129 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
42130 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
42131 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
42132 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
42133 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
42134 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
42135 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
42136 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
42137 addresses are complete.
42139 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
42140 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
42141 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
42142 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
42143 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
42144 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
42146 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
42147 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
42148 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42150 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
42151 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
42152 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
42153 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
42157 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42158 darcy@austen.fict.example
42160 alice@wonderland.fict.example
42162 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
42163 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
42164 line is of the following form:
42166 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
42167 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
42169 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
42170 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
42171 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
42172 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
42173 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
42174 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
42175 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
42176 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
42179 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
42180 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
42181 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
42182 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
42183 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
42187 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
42188 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
42189 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
42190 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
42191 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
42192 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
42193 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
42194 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
42195 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
42196 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
42199 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
42200 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
42201 typical set of headers:
42203 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
42204 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
42205 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
42206 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
42207 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
42208 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
42209 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
42210 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42211 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
42212 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42213 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
42215 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
42216 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
42217 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
42218 .ecindex IIDforspo1
42219 .ecindex IIDforspo2
42220 .ecindex IIDforspo3
42222 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
42223 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
42224 an ASCII newline character.
42225 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
42226 can have an alternate format.
42227 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
42228 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
42229 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
42230 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
42231 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
42232 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
42234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42237 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
42238 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
42240 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
42243 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
42244 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
42245 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
42246 DKIM is documented in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376).
42248 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
42249 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
42250 any original DKIM signature.
42252 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
42253 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42255 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
42257 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
42258 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
42259 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
42260 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
42261 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
42263 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
42264 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
42265 different signature contexts.
42268 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
42269 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
42270 Exim's standard controls.
42272 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
42273 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
42275 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
42276 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
42277 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
42278 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
42280 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
42281 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
42282 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
42283 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
42286 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
42287 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
42288 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
42289 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
42293 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
42294 .cindex DKIM signing
42296 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
42297 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
42298 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
42300 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42302 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
42303 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42306 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
42307 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
42308 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
42309 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
42310 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
42312 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
42313 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
42315 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
42316 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
42317 After expansion, this can be a list.
42318 Each element in turn,
42320 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
42321 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
42322 while expanding the remaining signing options.
42323 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
42324 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42326 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
42327 This sets the key selector string.
42328 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
42329 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
42330 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
42331 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
42332 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
42333 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
42334 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42336 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
42337 this could be be used:
42339 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
42340 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
42343 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
42344 This sets the private key to use.
42345 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
42346 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
42347 The result can either
42349 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
42351 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42352 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
42354 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
42357 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
42358 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
42362 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
42364 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
42365 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
42367 The result file from the first command should be retained,
42368 permissions set so that Exim can read it,
42369 and this option set to use it.
42370 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
42371 for the DNS TXT record.
42372 See section 3.6 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42373 for the record specification.
42377 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
42378 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
42381 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42383 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
42384 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42387 EC keys for DKIM are defined by
42388 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8463,RFC 8463).
42389 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
42390 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
42391 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
42392 for some transition period.
42393 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42396 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
42398 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
42399 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
42402 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
42404 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
42405 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
42408 Exim also supports an alternate format
42409 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
42410 of the standard, but not adopted.
42411 A future release will probably drop that support.
42413 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
42414 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
42416 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
42418 &`sha256`& &-- the default
42420 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
42423 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42425 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42428 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
42429 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
42430 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
42431 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
42432 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
42433 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
42435 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
42436 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
42437 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
42438 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
42439 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
42441 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
42442 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
42443 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
42444 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
42445 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
42448 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
42449 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
42450 list of header names.
42451 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
42452 in the message signature.
42453 When unspecified, the header names listed in
42454 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4871,RFC 4871) will be used,
42455 whether or not each header is present in the message.
42456 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
42457 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
42458 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
42460 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
42461 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
42462 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
42464 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
42465 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
42467 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
42468 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
42469 name will be appended.
42471 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
42472 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
42473 If not set, no such information will be included.
42474 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
42475 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
42476 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
42478 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42479 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
42482 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
42483 .cindex DKIM verification
42485 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
42486 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
42488 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
42489 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
42490 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
42491 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
42492 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
42494 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42495 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42496 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42498 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
42499 of this section can be ignored.
42501 The results of verification are made available to the
42502 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
42503 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
42504 By default, the ACL is called once for each
42505 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
42506 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
42507 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
42508 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
42510 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
42511 a large number of expansion variables
42512 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
42513 runtime of the ACL.
42515 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
42516 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
42517 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
42518 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
42520 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
42521 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
42522 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
42523 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
42524 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
42525 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
42528 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
42530 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
42531 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
42532 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
42534 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
42536 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
42537 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
42538 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
42540 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
42543 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
42544 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
42546 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
42547 (such as the From: header)
42548 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
42549 and for the domain part if identities.
42550 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
42552 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
42553 for each matching signature.
42556 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
42557 available (from most to least important):
42561 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
42562 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
42563 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
42564 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
42566 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
42567 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
42568 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
42569 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
42570 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
42571 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42573 Within the DKIM ACL,
42574 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
42576 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
42577 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42579 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
42580 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42582 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
42583 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42585 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
42588 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42589 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
42590 hash-method or key-size:
42592 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
42593 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
42594 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
42595 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
42596 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
42597 set dkim_verify_status = fail
42598 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
42601 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
42602 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
42603 "fail" or "invalid". One of
42605 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
42606 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
42608 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
42609 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
42611 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
42612 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
42613 means that the message body was modified in transit.
42615 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
42616 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
42617 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
42618 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
42621 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42623 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
42624 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
42625 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
42626 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42628 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
42629 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
42630 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
42631 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42633 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
42634 The key record selector string.
42636 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
42637 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
42638 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42639 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
42640 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42643 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42645 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42647 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42648 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42651 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42652 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42653 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42654 processing of such signatures.
42656 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42657 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42659 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42660 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42662 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42663 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42664 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42665 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42666 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42667 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42668 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42670 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42671 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42672 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42673 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42674 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42675 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42676 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42677 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42679 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42680 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42681 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42683 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42684 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42685 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42686 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42687 integer size comparisons against this value.
42688 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42690 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42691 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42693 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42694 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42696 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42697 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42699 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42700 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42703 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42704 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42707 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42708 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42710 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42711 Number of bits in the key.
42712 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42713 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42715 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42717 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42718 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42721 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42726 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42729 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42730 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42731 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42732 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42733 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42734 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42735 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42738 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42739 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42740 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42742 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42745 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42746 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42748 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42749 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42750 results against the actual result of verification,
42751 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42752 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42754 A basic verification might be:
42756 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42759 A more complex use could be
42760 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42763 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42764 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42765 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42766 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42769 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42770 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42771 for more information of what they mean.
42773 The condition is true if the status
42774 (or any of the list of status values)
42775 is any one of the supplied list.
42781 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42782 .cindex SPF verification
42784 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42785 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by
42786 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7208,RFC 7208).
42787 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42788 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42789 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42790 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42791 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42794 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42795 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42797 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42798 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42799 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42801 .cindex "dynamic modules"
42802 The support can be built as a dynamic-load module if desired;
42803 see the comments in that Makefile.
42806 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42807 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42809 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42810 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42811 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42812 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42815 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42816 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42817 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42818 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42819 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42823 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42826 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42827 domain in the envelope-from address.
42829 .vitem &%softfail%&
42830 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42834 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42837 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42838 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42839 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42841 .vitem &%permerror%&
42842 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42843 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42845 .vitem &%temperror%&
42846 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42847 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42850 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42853 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42854 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42855 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42856 short-circuit fashion.
42861 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42862 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42863 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42864 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42865 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42866 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42867 ip=$sender_host_address
42870 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42871 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42874 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42877 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42879 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42880 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42881 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42882 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42883 it for logging purposes.
42885 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42886 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42887 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42888 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42889 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42890 top of the header list, i.e. with
42892 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42894 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42896 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42897 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42899 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42900 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42901 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42902 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42903 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42905 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42906 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42907 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42908 and required in order to obtain a result.
42910 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42911 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42912 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42913 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42914 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42915 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42916 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42920 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42921 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42922 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42923 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42924 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42925 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42927 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42928 for a description of what it means.
42929 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42931 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42932 of the spf one. For example:
42935 deny spf_guess = fail
42936 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42939 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42940 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42941 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42944 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42945 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42947 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42948 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42949 &%spf_guess%& option.
42950 For example, the following:
42953 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42956 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42959 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42961 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42962 address as the key and an IP address
42967 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42970 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42971 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42977 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42978 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42979 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
42981 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42982 SPF verification does not object to them.
42983 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
42984 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
42985 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
42986 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
42988 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42989 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
42990 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
42991 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
42992 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
42995 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
42996 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
42997 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
42998 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
43001 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
43002 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43003 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
43005 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
43007 .cindex SRS excoding
43008 To encode an address use this expansion item:
43010 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
43011 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
43012 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
43013 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
43014 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
43015 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
43017 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
43018 encoding operation.
43019 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
43020 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
43021 it arrived at this system.
43022 All arguments are expanded before use.
43024 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
43028 .cindex SRS decoding
43029 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
43031 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
43032 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
43033 The second argument is the site secret.
43034 Both arguments are expanded before use.
43036 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
43038 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
43039 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
43041 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
43042 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
43043 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
43049 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
43055 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
43056 domains = ! +my_domains
43057 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
43058 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
43059 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
43064 domains = +my_domains
43065 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
43066 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
43067 data = $srs_recipient
43069 inbound_srs_failure:
43072 domains = +my_domains
43073 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
43074 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
43076 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
43078 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
43079 # and any that were not SRS'd
43082 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
43083 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
43084 remote_forwarded_smtp:
43086 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
43088 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
43089 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
43096 .section DMARC SECDMARC
43097 .cindex DMARC verification
43099 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
43100 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
43101 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
43102 should read and understand how it works by visiting the
43103 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/,DMARC website).
43105 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
43106 the libopendmarc library is used.
43108 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
43109 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/,sourceforge)
43110 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
43111 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
43112 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
43113 This description assumes
43114 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
43115 are in /usr/local/lib.
43117 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
43118 .cindex DMARC configuration
43120 There are three main-configuration options:
43121 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
43123 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
43124 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
43125 defines the location of a text file of valid
43126 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
43127 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
43128 the most current version can be downloaded
43129 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
43130 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
43131 The default for the option is unset.
43132 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
43135 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
43136 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
43137 defines the location of a file to log results
43138 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
43139 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
43140 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
43141 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
43142 directory of this file is writable by the user
43144 The default is unset.
43146 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
43147 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
43148 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
43149 forensic report detailing alignment failures
43150 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
43151 and you have configured Exim to send them.
43152 If set, this is expanded and used for the
43153 From: header line; the address is extracted
43154 from it and used for the envelope from.
43155 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
43156 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
43159 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
43160 .cindex DMARC controls
43162 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
43163 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
43164 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
43165 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
43166 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
43167 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
43169 control = dmarc_disable_verify
43171 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
43172 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
43173 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
43174 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
43175 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
43176 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
43177 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
43178 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
43179 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
43180 construction might be inadequate.
43182 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
43184 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
43185 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
43186 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
43189 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
43192 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
43193 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
43195 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
43196 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
43197 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
43198 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
43199 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
43200 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
43201 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
43203 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
43204 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
43205 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
43206 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
43207 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43208 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
43209 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
43210 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
43211 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
43212 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
43213 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
43214 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
43215 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
43217 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
43218 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
43219 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
43220 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
43221 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
43222 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
43225 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
43226 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
43227 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
43229 Performing the check sets up information used by the
43230 &%authresults%& expansion item.
43232 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
43233 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
43234 expansion variables are available:
43237 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
43238 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
43239 .cindex DMARC result
43240 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
43241 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
43242 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
43243 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
43244 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
43246 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
43247 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
43248 Slightly longer, human readable status.
43250 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
43251 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
43252 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
43254 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
43255 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
43256 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
43257 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
43258 is any error, including no DMARC record.
43261 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_spf$&
43262 .vindex &$dmarc_alignment_spf$&
43263 The result of the SPF alignment portion of the test status;
43266 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$&
43267 .vindex &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$&
43268 The result of the DKIM alignment portion of the test status;
43273 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
43274 .cindex DMARC logging
43276 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
43277 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
43278 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
43279 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
43280 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
43281 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
43282 processing or failure delivery issues).
43284 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
43285 tools, you need to:
43287 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
43289 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
43290 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
43293 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
43295 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
43297 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
43298 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
43301 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
43302 .cindex DMARC example
43307 warn domains = +local_domains
43308 hosts = +local_hosts
43309 control = dmarc_disable_verify
43311 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
43312 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
43314 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
43315 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
43318 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
43320 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
43322 warn dmarc_status = !accept
43324 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
43326 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
43328 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
43329 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
43331 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
43332 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
43333 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
43335 deny dmarc_status = reject
43337 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
43339 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
43346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43349 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
43351 .cindex "proxy support"
43352 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
43354 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
43355 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
43358 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
43359 .cindex proxy inbound
43360 .cindex proxy "server side"
43361 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
43362 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
43364 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
43365 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
43366 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
43369 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
43370 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
43372 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
43373 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
43374 to distribute load.
43375 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
43376 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
43377 There is no logging if a host passes or
43378 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
43379 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
43381 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
43382 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
43383 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
43384 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
43385 automatically determines which version is in use.
43387 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
43388 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
43389 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
43390 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
43391 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
43393 The following expansion variables are usable
43394 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
43396 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
43397 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
43398 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
43399 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
43400 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
43401 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
43403 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
43404 there was a protocol error.
43405 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
43406 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
43408 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
43409 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
43410 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
43411 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
43412 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
43413 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
43414 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
43415 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
43416 A possible solution is:
43418 # Set max number of connections per host
43420 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
43421 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
43423 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
43424 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
43429 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
43430 .cindex proxy outbound
43431 .cindex proxy "client side"
43432 .cindex proxy SOCKS
43433 .cindex SOCKS proxy
43434 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
43435 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by
43436 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1928,RFC 1928)).
43437 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
43440 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
43441 on an smtp transport.
43443 If unset (or empty after expansion) then proxying is not done.
43445 Otherwise, expansion should result in a list
43446 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
43447 Each proxy specifier is a list
43448 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
43449 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
43451 Each option is a string of form <name>=<value>.
43452 The list of options is in the following table:
43453 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
43454 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
43455 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
43456 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
43457 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
43458 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
43459 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
43460 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
43463 More details on each of these options follows:
43466 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
43467 .cindex proxy authentication
43468 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
43469 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per
43470 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1929,RFC 1929)
43471 for access to the proxy.
43472 Default is &"none"&.
43474 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
43477 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
43480 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
43483 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
43486 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
43487 higher values being tried first.
43488 The default priority is 1.
43490 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
43491 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
43492 weighted by this value.
43493 The default value for selection bias is 1.
43496 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
43497 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
43498 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
43500 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
43501 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
43502 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
43503 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
43505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43506 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43508 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
43509 "Internationalisation""
43510 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
43513 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
43515 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
43516 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
43517 Standards supported are RFCs
43518 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,2060),
43519 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5890.html,5890),
43520 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6530.html,6530) and
43521 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6533.html,6533).
43523 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
43524 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
43525 requirement, upon libidn2.
43527 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
43528 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
43529 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
43530 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
43531 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
43532 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
43533 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
43535 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
43536 international handling for the message is enabled and
43537 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
43539 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
43540 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
43541 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
43542 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
43544 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
43545 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
43546 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
43547 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
43549 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
43550 components expanded to a-label form,
43551 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
43554 .cindex log protocol
43555 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
43556 .cindex i18n logging
43557 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
43558 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
43560 The following expansion operators can be used:
43562 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
43563 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
43564 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
43565 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
43568 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
43569 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
43571 may use the following modifier:
43573 control = utf8_downconvert
43574 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
43576 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
43577 a-label form before smtp delivery.
43578 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
43579 but could be used for any message.
43581 If a value is appended it may be:
43582 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
43583 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
43584 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
43585 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
43587 If no value is given, 1 is used.
43589 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
43590 is initially set to -1.
43592 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
43593 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
43594 or an empty string.
43595 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
43596 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
43599 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
43600 Configurations supporting these should inspect
43601 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
43603 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
43604 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
43605 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
43607 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
43608 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
43612 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
43613 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
43614 the following expansion operator can be used:
43616 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
43619 The string is converted from the charset specified by
43620 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
43621 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
43623 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by
43624 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,RFC 2060),
43625 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
43626 (which has to be a single character)
43627 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
43628 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
43630 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
43631 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
43633 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
43634 by many other IMAP servers.
43638 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
43639 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
43640 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
43643 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
43644 must be representable in UTF-16.
43647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43650 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
43654 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
43655 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
43656 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
43657 processing actions.
43659 Most installations will never need to use Events.
43660 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
43661 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43663 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
43664 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
43665 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
43667 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43668 An example might look like:
43669 .cindex logging custom
43671 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43672 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43673 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43674 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43675 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43676 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43677 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43678 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43679 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43683 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43684 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43685 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43688 The current list of events is:
43689 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43690 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43691 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43692 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43693 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43694 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43695 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43696 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43697 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43698 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43699 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43700 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43701 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43702 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43703 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43704 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43705 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43706 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43707 .row smtp:fail:protocol after main "per connection"
43708 .row smtp:fail:syntax after main "per connection"
43711 New event types may be added in future.
43713 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43714 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43715 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43717 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43718 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43719 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43721 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43722 should define the event action.
43724 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43725 with the event type:
43727 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43728 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43729 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43730 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43731 .row msg:defer "error string"
43732 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43733 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43734 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43735 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43736 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43737 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43738 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43739 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43740 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43741 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43742 .row smtp:fail:protocol "error string"
43743 .row smtp:fail:syntax "error string"
43747 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43749 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43750 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43751 the course of its processing:
43753 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43756 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43757 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43759 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43760 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43762 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43763 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43764 following will be forced:
43765 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43766 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43767 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43768 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43769 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43771 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43772 no other use is made of it.
43774 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43775 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43776 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43778 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43779 chain element received on the connection.
43780 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43783 For dns:fail events from dnsdb lookups, a &"defer_never"& option does not
43784 affect the reporting of DNS_AGAIN.
43786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43789 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43790 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43791 .cindex "adding drivers"
43792 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43793 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43794 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43795 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43798 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43799 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43801 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43803 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43805 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43806 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43807 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43809 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43811 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43814 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43815 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43817 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43818 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43819 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43820 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43821 simple form that most lookups have.
43823 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43824 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43825 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43827 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43828 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43830 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43833 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43834 as for other drivers and lookups.
43837 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43838 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43839 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43840 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43841 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43843 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43844 the interface that is expected.
43849 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43850 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43852 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43853 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43854 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43855 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43857 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43862 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43863 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43867 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43868 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43869 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43872 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43873 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////